Omron F7 Frequency Converter User Manual
Omron F7 Frequency Converter User Manual
Omron F7 Frequency Converter User Manual
TOE--S616-55.2-OY
VARISPEED F7
Vector Control Frequency Inverter
USER’S MANUAL
Table of Content
Warnings ........................................................................................................VII
Safety Precautions and Instructions for Use ............................................... VIII
EMC Compatibility ......................................................................................... X
Line Filters ....................................................................................................XII
Registered Trademarks ................................................................................ XV
2 Wiring....................................................................................... 2-1
Connection Diagram ....................................................................................2-2
Circuit Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 2-3
Terminal Block Configuration ......................................................................2-4
Wiring Main Circuit Terminals ......................................................................2-5
Applicable Wire Sizes and Closed-loop Connectors ..................................................... 2-5
Main Circuit Terminal Functions .................................................................................. 2-11
Main Circuit Configurations .......................................................................................... 2-12
Standard Connection Diagrams ...................................................................................2-13
Wiring the Main Circuits ...............................................................................................2-14
Wiring Control Circuit Terminals ................................................................2-20
Wire Sizes ....................................................................................................................2-20
Control Circuit Terminal Functions ..............................................................................2-22
Control Circuit Terminal Connections .......................................................................... 2-25
Safe Disable Input Precautions ...................................................................................2-26
Control Circuit Wiring Precautions ............................................................................... 2-27
I
Wiring Check ............................................................................................. 2-28
Checks ........................................................................................................................ 2-28
Installing and Wiring Option Cards ............................................................ 2-29
Option Card Models and Specifications ...................................................................... 2-29
Installation ................................................................................................................... 2-29
PG Speed Control Card Terminals and Specifications ............................................... 2-31
PG-X2 .......................................................................................................................... 2-31
Wiring .......................................................................................................................... 2-32
Wiring Terminal Blocks ................................................................................................ 2-34
II
Motor Parameters: E ....................................................................................................5-31
Option Parameters: F .................................................................................................. 5-36
Terminal Function Parameters: H ................................................................................5-43
Protection Function Parameters: L ..............................................................................5-52
Special Adjustments: n ................................................................................................ 5-61
Digital Operator Parameters: o .................................................................................... 5-64
Speed Follower: S .......................................................................................................5-67
Monitor Parameters: U .................................................................................................5-70
Factory Settings that Change with the Control Method (A1-02) .................................. 5-77
Factory Settings that Change with the Inverter Capacity (o2-04) ................................ 5-79
Parameter Initial Values that Change With the Setting of C6-01 .................................5-81
III
Motor Overheating Protection Using PTC Thermistor Inputs ...................................... 6-53
Limiting Motor Rotation Direction and Output Phase Rotation .................................... 6-54
Automatic Restart ...................................................................................... 6-55
Restarting Automatically After Momentary Power Loss .............................................. 6-55
Speed Search .............................................................................................................. 6-56
Continuing Operation at Constant Speed when the Frequency Reference is Lost ..... 6-60
Restarting Operation After Transient Fault (Auto Restart Function) ........................... 6-61
Operation Selection After Cooling Fan Fault ............................................................... 6-62
Inverter Protection ..................................................................................... 6-63
Overheating Protection for an Inverter-Mounted Braking Resistor .............................. 6-63
Inverter Overheat Protection ....................................................................................... 6-64
Input Open Phase Protection ...................................................................................... 6-64
Output Open Phase Protection ................................................................................... 6-65
Ground Fault Protection .............................................................................................. 6-65
Cooling Fan Control .................................................................................................... 6-65
Setting the Ambient Temperature ............................................................................... 6-66
OL2 Characteristics at Low Speed .............................................................................. 6-67
Input Terminal Functions ........................................................................... 6-68
Temporarily Switching Operation between Digital Operator and
Control Circuit Terminals ............................................................................................. 6-68
Inverter Output Baseblock ........................................................................................... 6-68
OH2 (Overheat) Alarm Signal Input ............................................................................ 6-69
Multifunction Analog Input A2 Disable/Enable ............................................................ 6-69
Drive Enable/Disable ................................................................................................... 6-69
Stopping Acceleration and Deceleration (Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp Hold) ...... 6-70
Raising and Lowering Frequency References Using Digital Signals
(UP/DOWN Function) .................................................................................................. 6-71
Adding/Subtracting a Fixed Speed to an Analog Reference (Trim Control) ................ 6-73
Hold Analog Frequency Using User-set Timing .......................................................... 6-74
Switching Operation Source to Communication Option Card ..................................... 6-75
Jog Frequency with Direction Commands (FJOG/RJOG) ........................................... 6-75
Stopping the Inverter on External Device Faults (External Fault Function) ................. 6-76
Output Terminal Functions ........................................................................ 6-77
Monitor Parameters ................................................................................... 6-80
Using the Analog Monitor Outputs .............................................................................. 6-80
Using the Pulse Train Monitor Output ......................................................................... 6-81
Individual Functions .................................................................................. 6-83
Using MEMOBUS Communications ............................................................................ 6-83
Using the Timer Function ............................................................................................ 6-98
Using PID Control ........................................................................................................ 6-99
Energy-saving ........................................................................................................... 6-109
Field Weakening ........................................................................................................ 6-110
Field Forcing .............................................................................................................. 6-111
Setting Motor 1 Parameters ...................................................................................... 6-111
Setting the V/f Pattern 1 ............................................................................................ 6-113
Setting Motor 2 Parameters ...................................................................................... 6-119
Setting the V/f Pattern 2 ............................................................................................ 6-120
Torque Control .......................................................................................................... 6-121
Droop Control Function ............................................................................................. 6-128
Zero-Servo Function .................................................................................................. 6-129
Kinetic Energy Buffering ............................................................................................ 6-131
High Slip Braking (HSB) ............................................................................................ 6-132
Speed Follower Function ........................................................................................... 6-134
IV
Digital Operator Functions .......................................................................6-138
Setting Digital Operator Functions ............................................................................. 6-138
Copying Parameters ..................................................................................................6-140
Prohibiting Overwriting of Parameters ....................................................................... 6-144
Setting a Password .................................................................................................... 6-144
Displaying User-set Parameters Only ........................................................................ 6-145
Option Cards ...........................................................................................6-146
Using PG Feedback Option Cards ............................................................................6-146
Analog Reference Cards ........................................................................................... 6-149
Digital Reference Cards .............................................................................................6-149
V
Selection ...................................................................................................................... 10-2
Installation ................................................................................................................... 10-3
Settings ....................................................................................................................... 10-3
Handling ...................................................................................................................... 10-4
Motor Application Precautions .................................................................. 10-5
Using the Inverter for an Existing Standard Motor ...................................................... 10-5
Using the Inverter for Special Motors .......................................................................... 10-5
Power Transmission Mechanism (Speed Reducers, Belts and Chains) ..................... 10-6
User Parameters ....................................................................................... 10-7
VI
Warnings
CAUTION
Cables must not be connected or disconnected, nor signal tests carried out, while the power is
switched on.
The Varispeed F7 DC bus capacitor remains charged even after the power has been switched off. To
avoid an electric shock hazard, disconnect the frequency inverter from the mains before carrying out
maintenance. Then wait for at least 5 minutes after all LEDs have gone out.
Do not perform a withstand voltage test on any part of the inverter. It contains semiconductors,
which are not designed for such high voltages.
Do not remove the digital operator while the mains supply is switched on. The printed circuit board
must also not be touched while the inverter is connected to the power.
Never connect general LC/RC interference suppression filters, capacitors or overvoltage protection devices to
the inverter input or output.
To avoid unnecessary overcurrent faults, etc. being displayed, the signaling contacts of any contac-
tor or switch fitted between inverter and motor must be integrated into the inverter control logic
(e.g. baseblock).
The inverter must be operated with the appropriate line filters, following the installation instructions
in this manual and with all covers closed and terminals covered.
Only then will adequate protection be provided. Please do not connect or operate any equipment
with visible damage or missing parts. The operating company is responsible for any injuries or
equipment damage resulting from failure to heed the warnings in this manual.
VII
Safety Precautions and Instructions for Use
General
Please read these safety precautions and instructions for use thoroughly before installing and operating this
inverter. Also read all of the warning signs on the inverter and ensure they are never damaged or removed.
Live and hot inverter components may be accessible during operation. Removal of housing components, the
digital operator or terminal covers runs the risk of serious injuries or damage in the event of incorrect installa-
tion or operation. The fact that frequency inverters control rotating mechanical machine components can give
rise to other dangers.
The instructions in this manual must be followed. Installation, operation and maintenance may only be carried
out by qualified personnel. For the purposes of the safety precautions, qualified personnel are defined as indi-
viduals who are familiar with the installation, starting, operation and maintenance of frequency inverters and
have the proper qualifications for this work. Safe operation of these units is only possible if they are used
properly for their intended purpose.
The DC bus capacitors can remain live for about 5 minutes after the inverter is disconnected from the power. It
is therefore necessary to wait for this time before opening its covers. All of the main circuit terminals may still
carry dangerous voltages.
Children and other unauthorized persons must not be allowed access to these inverters.
Keep these Safety Precautions and Instructions for Use readily accessible and supply them to all persons with
any form of access to the inverters.
Intended Use
Frequency inverters are intended for installation in electrical systems or machinery.
Their installation in machinery and systems must conform to the following product standards of the Low Volt-
age Directive:
EN 50178, 1997-10,Equipping of Power Systems with Electronic Devices
EN 60204-1, 1997-12Machine Safety and Equipping with Electrical Devices
Part 1: General Requirements (IEC 60204-1:1997)/
Please note: Includes Corrigendum of September 1998
EN 61010-1, A2, 1995Safety Requirements for Information Technology Equipment
(IEC 950, 1991 + A1, 1992 + A2, 1993 + A3, 1995 + A4, 1996, modified)
CE marking is carried out to EN 50178, using the line filters specified in this manual and following the appro-
priate installation instructions.
Installation
Install and cool the inverters as specified in the documentation. The cooling air must flow in the specified
direction. The inverter may therefore only be operated in the specified position (e.g. upright). Maintain the
specified clearances. Protect the inverters against impermissible loads. Components must not be bent nor insu-
lation clearances changed. To avoid damage being caused by static electricity, do not touch any electronic
components or contacts.
VIII
Electrical Connection
Carry out any work on live equipment in compliance with the national safety and accident prevention regula-
tions. Carry out electrical installation in compliance with the relevant regulations. In particular, follow the
installation instructions ensuring electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), e.g. shielding, grounding, filter
arrangement and laying of cables. This also applies to equipment with the CE mark. It is the responsibility of
the manufacturer of the system or machine to ensure conformity with EMC limits.
Your supplier or OYMC representative must be contacted when using leakage current circuit breaker in con-
junction with frequency inverters.
In certain systems it may be necessary to use additional monitoring and safety devices in compliance with the
relevant safety and accident prevention regulations. The frequency inverter hardware must not be modified.
Notes
The VARISPEED F7 frequency inverters are certified to CE, UL, and c-UL.
IX
EMC Compatibility
Introduction
This manual was compiled to help system manufacturers using YASKAWA frequency inverters to design and
install electrical switch gear. It also describes the measures necessary to comply with the EMC Directive. The
manual's installation and wiring instructions must therefore be followed.
Our products are tested by authorized bodies using the standards listed below.
Product standard: EN 61800-3:1996
EN 61800-3; A11:2000
Laying Cables
Measures Against Line-Borne Interference:
Line filter and frequency inverter must be mounted on the same metal plate. Mount the two components as
close to each other as possible, with cables kept as short as possible.
Use a power cable with well-grounded shield. For motor cables up to 50 meters in length use shielded cables..
Arrange all grounds so as to maximize the area of the end of the lead in contact with the ground terminal (e.g.
metal plate).
Shielded Cable:
• Use a cable with braided shield.
• Ground the maximum possible area of the shield. It is advisable to ground the shield by connecting the
cable to the ground plate with metal clips (see following figure).
X
Ground clip Ground plate
The grounding surfaces must be highly conductive bare metal. Remove any coats of varnish and paint.
• Ground the cable shields at both ends.
• Ground the motor of the machine.
Further informations can be found in the document EZZ006543 which can be ordered at Omron Yaskawa
Motion Control.
XI
Line Filters
CIMR-F7Z42P2 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z43P7 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z44P0 3G3RV-PFI3018-SE B, 25 m* 18 1.3 141 x 46 x 330
CIMR-F7Z45P5 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z47P5 B, 25 m*
3G3RV-PFI3035-SE 35 2.1 206 x 50 x 355
CIMR-F7Z4011 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z4015 B, 25 m*
3G3RV-PFI3060-SE 60 4.0 236 x 65 x 408
CIMR-F7Z4018 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z4022 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI3070-SE 70 3.4 80 x 185 x 329
CIMR-F7Z4030 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z4037 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z4045 3G3RV-PFI3130-SE A, 100 m 130 4.7 90 x 180 x 366
CIMR-F7Z4055 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z4090 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI3200-SE 250 11 130 x 240 x 610
CIMR-F7Z4110 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z4132 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI3400-SE 400 18.5 300 x 160 x 610
CIMR-F7Z4160 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z4185 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI3600-SE 600 11,0 260 x 135 x 386
CIMR-F7Z4220 A, 100 m
* Class A, 100 m
Permissible emission of power drive systems for commercial and light environment (EN61800-3, A11)
(general availability, 1st environment)
XII
Inverter Model Line Filters
EN
Current Weight Dimensions
Varispeed F7 Type 55011
(A) (kg) WxDxH
Class
CIMR-F7Z20P4 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z20P7 3G3RV-PFI3010-SE B, 25 m* 10 1.1 141 x 45 x 330
CIMR-F7Z21P5 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z23P7 B, 25 m*
3G3RV-PFI2035-SE 35 1.4 141 x 46 x 330
CIMR-F7Z25P5 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z27P5 B, 25 m*
3G3RV-PFI2060-SE 60 3 206 x 60 x 355
CIMR-F7Z2011 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z2015 B, 25 m*
3G3RV-PFI2100-SE 100 4.9 236 x 80 x 408
CIMR-F7Z2018 B, 25 m*
CIMR-F7Z2022 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI2130-SE 130 4.3 90 x 180 x 366
CIMR-F7Z2030 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z2045 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI2200-SE 200 11.0 130 x 240 x 610
CIMR-F7Z2055 A, 100 m
CIMR-F7Z2075 A, 100 m
3G3RV-PFI3400-SE 400 18.5 300 x 160 x 564
CIMR-F7Z2090 A, 100 m
* Class A, 100 m
XIII
Installation of Inverters and EMC filters
L1 L3
PE L2
Ground Bonds
( remove any paint )
PE
Line
Inverter
Filter
Load L1 L3 U W
PE L2 V PE
Cable Length
as short as possible
Metal Plate
Motor cable
screened
Ground Bonds
( remove any paint )
M
3~
XIV
Registered Trademarks
XV
XVI
1
Handling Inverters
This chapter describes the checks required upon receiving or installing an Inverter.
Varispeed F7 Introduction.......................................................1-2
Confirmations upon Delivery..................................................1-4
Exterior and Mounting Dimensions ........................................1-8
Checking and Controlling the Installation Site .....................1-11
Installation Orientation and Space .......................................1-12
Removing and Attaching the Terminal Cover ......................1-13
Removing/Attaching the Digital Operator and Front Cover..1-14
Varispeed F7 Introduction
Varispeed F7 Applications
The Varispeed F7 is ideal for the following applications.
• Fan, blower, and pump applications
Varispeed F7 Models
The Varispeed F7 Series includes Inverters in two voltage classes: 200 V and 400 V. The maximum motor capacities
vary from 0.55 to 300 kW (42 models).
1-2
Specifications
Maxi-
Varispeed F7 (Always specify through the protective structure when
mum
Voltage ordering.)
Motor
Class Output Open Chassis Enclosed Wall-mounted
Capacity
Capacity Basic Model Number (IEC IP00) (IEC IP20, NEMA 1)
kW
kVA CIMR-F7Z CIMR-F7Z
1
0.55 1.4 CIMR-F7Z40P4 40P41
0.75 1.6 CIMR-F7Z40P7 40P71
1.5 2.8 CIMR-F7Z41P5 41P51
2.2 4.0 CIMR-F7Z42P2 42P21
3.7 5.8 CIMR-F7Z43P7 Remove the top and bottom 43P71
4.0 6.6 CIMR-F7Z44P0 covers from the Enclosed 44P01
5.5 9.5 CIMR-F7Z45P5 Wall-mount model. 45P51
7.5 13 CIMR-F7Z47P5 47P51
11 18 CIMR-F7Z4011 40111
15 24 CIMR-F7Z4015 40151
18.5 30 CIMR-F7Z4018 40181
400 V 22 34 CIMR-F7Z4022 40220 40221
class 30 46 CIMR-F7Z4030 40300 40301
37 57 CIMR-F7Z4037 40370 40371
45 69 CIMR-F7Z4045 40450 40451
55 85 CIMR-F7Z4055 40550 40551
75 110 CIMR-F7Z4075 40750 40751
90 140 CIMR-F7Z4090 40900 40901
110 160 CIMR-F7Z4110 41100 41101
132 200 CIMR-F7Z4132 41320 41321
160 230 CIMR-F7Z4160 41600 41601
185 280 CIMR-F7Z4185 41850 –
220 390 CIMR-F7Z4220 42200 –
300 510 CIMR-F7Z4300 43000 –
1-3
Confirmations upon Delivery
Checks
Check the following items as soon as the Inverter is delivered.
Item Method
1
Has the correct model of Inverter been
Check the model number on the nameplate on the side of the Inverter.
delivered?
Inspect the entire exterior of the Inverter to see if there are any scratches or
Is the Inverter damaged in any way?
other damage resulting from shipping.
Are any screws or other components
Use a screwdriver or other tools to check for tightness.
loose?
If you find any irregularities in the above items, contact the agency from which you purchased the Inverter or
your OYMC representative immediately.
Nameplate Information
There is a nameplate attached to the side of each Inverter. The nameplate shows the model number, specifica-
tions, lot number, serial number, and other information on the Inverter.
Example Nameplate
The following nameplate is an example for a standard domestic European Inverter: 3-phase, 400 VAC,
0.55 kW, IEC IP20 and NEMA 1 standards
Inverter
Inverter model MODEL: CIMR-F7Z40P4 specifications
Input specifications
1-4
Inverter Model Numbers
The model number of the Inverter on the nameplate indicates the specification, voltage class, and maximum
motor capacity of the Inverter in alphanumeric codes.
CIMR – F7 Z 2 0 P4
Inverter
Varispeed F7
Inverter Specifications
The Inverter specifications (“SPEC”) on the nameplate indicate the voltage class, maximum motor capacity,
the protective structure, and the revision of the Inverter in alphanumeric codes.
40P41 B
Voltage Class Revision / Version
2 200 V B Standard Inverter
4 400 V C Safety Inverter
This manual describes the functionality of the inverter software version VSF104012 (Standard
Inverter) and VSF104020 (Safety Inverter).
IMPORTANT Older software versions do not support all described functions. Check the software version before
starting to work with this manual.
1-5
Component Names
Mounting
Front cover
Digital Operator
Diecast case
(* SN SC SP A1 A2 V+ AC V- MP AC RP R+ R- M5 M6 MA MB MC
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 )0 $& $0 ,* 6 6 0 0 0 0 (*
E(G) S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 FM AC AM IG S+ S- M3 M4 M1 M2 E(G)
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
Charge Indicator
Fig 1.5 Terminal Arrangement of Standard and Safety Inverter (18.5 kW or Less)
1-6
Inverters of 22 kW or More
The external appearance and component names of the Inverter are shown in Fig 1.6. The Inverter with the ter-
minal cover removed is shown in Fig 1.7
Mounting holes
Inverter cover
Cooling fan
1
Front cover
Digital Operator
Nameplate
Terminal cover
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
BB BB1 SC
SN SC SP A1 A2 V+ AC V- MP AC RP R+ R- M5 M6 MA MB MC
E(G) S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 FM AC AM IG S+ S- M3 M4 M1 M2 E(G)
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
1-7
Exterior and Mounting Dimensions
200 V/400 V Class Inverters of 0.55 to 18.5 kW 200 V Class Inverters of 22 or 110 kW
400 V Class Inverters of 22 to 160 kW
1-8
Enclosed Wall-mounted Inverters (NEMA1)
Exterior diagrams of the Enclosed Wall-mounted Inverters (NEMA1) are shown below.
Grommet
1-9
Table 1.2 Inverter Dimensions (mm) and Masses (kg) of F7 inverters from 0.4 to 160kW
Max. Dimensions (mm) Caloric Value (W)
Appli- Protection Class IP00 Protection Class NEMA 1 / IP20 Total Cool-
Voltage cable Mount- Exter- Inter- Heat ing
Class Motor Appro Appro Gen- Metho
ing nal nal
Output W H D W1 H1 H2 D1 t1 x. W H D W1 H0 H1 H2 H3 D1 t1 x. era- d
Holes
[kW] Mass Mass tion
d*
0.55 20 39 59
1 0.75
1.5
140 280
157
126 266 7
39
5
3
140 280
157
126 280 266 7
39
5
3
M5
27
50
42
50
69
100
Natu-
ral
2.2 0 70 59 129
3.7 112 74 186
177 59 4 177 59 4
5.5 164 84 248
7.5 6 300 6 219 113 332
200 300 197 186 285 7.5 65.5 200 197 186 300 285 8 65.5
11 7 310 10 7 374 170 544
200 V 15 350 0 429 183 612
240 350 207 216 335 8 78 2.3 11 240 207 216 350 335 78 2.3 11 M6
(3-phase) 18.5 380 30 501 211 712
7.5
22 250 400 195 385 21 254 535 195 400 385 135 24 586 274 860
258 7.5 100 258 100 Fan
30 275 450 220 435 24 279 615 220 450 435 165 27 865 352 1217
37 298 100 57 298 100 62 1015 411 1426
375 600 250 575 380 809 250 600 575 209
45 328 63 328 68 1266 505 1771
12.5 3.2 12.5 3.2 M10
55 86 94 1588 619 2207
450 725 348 325 700 130 453 1027 348 325 725 700 302 130
75 87 95 2019 838 2857
90 500 850 358 370 820 108 504 1243 358 370 850 820 15 390 4.5 114 2437 997 3434
15 4.5 M12
110 575 885 378 445 855 140 150 --- 2733 1242 3975
0.55 14 39 53
Natu-
0.75 157 39 3 157 39 3 17 41 58
ral
1.5 36 48 84
2.2 140 280 126 266 7 5 140 280 126 266 266 7 5 M5 59 56 115
3.7 80 68 148
177 59 4 177 59 4
4.0 0 91 70 161
5.5 127 82 209
7.5 193 114 307
200 300 197 186 285 8 65.5 6 200 300 197 186 300 285 8 65.5 6
11 252 158 410
15 326 172 498
400 V 240 350 207 216 335 78 10 240 350 207 216 350 335 78 10
18.5 426 208 634
(3-phase)
22 2.3 2.3 M6 466 259 725
279 450 258 220 435 100 21 279 535 258 220 450 435 100 24 Fan
30 7.5 7.5 85 678 317 995
37 635 784 360 1144
45 325 550 283 260 535 105 36 329 283 260 550 535 105 40 901 415 1316
715 165
55 1203 495 1698
75 88 96 1399 575 1974
450 725 348 325 700 12.5 3.2 453 1027 348 325 725 700 12.5 302 3.2 M10
90 89 97 1614 671 2285
130 130
110 102 122 2097 853 2950
500 850 358 370 820 15 504 1243 358 370 850 820 15 393
132 4.5 120 4.5 130 M12 2388 1002 3390
160 575 916 378 445 855 45.8 140 160 579 1324 378 445 916 855 46 408 140 170 2791 1147 3938
Table 1.3 Inverter Dimensions (mm) and Masses (kg) of 400V Class Inverters of 185 kW to 300 kW
Max. Dimensions (mm) Caloric Value (W)
Applica- Protection Class IP00
Mount- Total
Voltage ble Cooling
ing Exter- Inter- Heat
Class Motor Approx. Method
W H D W1 W2 W3 H1 H2 D1 t1 Holes d nal nal Genera-
Output Mass
[kW] tion
1-10
Checking and Controlling the Installation Site
Install the Inverter in the installation site described below and maintain optimum conditions.
Installation Site
Install the Inverter under the following conditions in a pollution degree 2 environment.
Type Ambient Operating Temperature Humidity
1
Enclosed wall-mounted -10 to + 40 °C 95% RH or less (no condensation)
Open chassis -10 to + 45 °C 95% RH or less (no condensation)
Protection covers are attached to the top and bottom of the Inverter. Be sure to remove the protection covers
before installing a 200 or 400 V Class Inverter with an output of 18.5 kW or less in a panel.
Observe the following precautions when mounting the Inverter.
• Install the Inverter in a clean location which is free from oil mist and dust. It can be installed in a totally
enclosed panel that is completely shielded from floating dust.
• When installing or operating the Inverter, always take special care so that metal powder, oil, water, or other
foreign matter does not get into the Inverter.
• Do not install the Inverter on combustible material, such as wood.
• Install the Inverter in a location free from radioactive materials and combustible materials.
• Install the Inverter in a location free from harmful gasses and liquids.
• Install the Inverter in a location without excessive oscillation.
• Install the Inverter in a location free from chlorides.
• Install the Inverter in a location not in direct sunlight.
1-11
Installation Orientation and Space
Install the Inverter vertically so as not to reduce the cooling effect. When installing the Inverter, always pro-
vide the following installation space to allow normal heat dissipation.
B
A
1 Air
A B
200V class inverter, 0.55 to 90 kW
50 mm 120 mm
400V class inverter, 0.55 to 132 kW
200V class inverter, 110 kW
120 mm 120 mm
400V class inverter, 160 to 220 kW
400V class inverter, 300 kW 300 mm 300 mm
1. The same space is required horizontally and vertically for both Open Chassis (IP00) and Enclosed
Wall-mounted (IP20, NEMA 1) Inverters.
2. Always remove the protection covers before installing a 200 or 400 V Class Inverter with an output of
18.5 kW or less in a panel.
IMPORTANT
Always provide enough space for suspension eye bolts and the main circuit lines when installing a 200
or 400 V Class Inverter with an output of 22 kW or more in a panel.
1-12
Removing and Attaching the Terminal Cover
Remove the terminal cover to wire cables to the control circuit and main circuit terminals.
2
1
Fig 1.12 Removing the Terminal Cover (Model CIMR-F7Z25P5 Shown Above)
Inverters of 22 kW or More
Loosen the screws on the left and right at the top of the terminal cover, pull out the terminal cover in the direc-
tion of arrow 1 and then lift up on the terminal in the direction of arrow 2.
1
2
Fig 1.13 Removing the Terminal Cover (Model CIMR-F7Z2022 Shown Above)
1-13
Removing/Attaching the Digital Operator and
Front Cover
Fig 1.14 Removing the Digital Operator (Model CIMR-F7Z45P5 Shown Above)
1-14
Removing the Front Cover
Press the left and right sides of the front cover in the directions of arrows 1 and lift the bottom of the cover in
the direction of arrow 2 to remove the front cover as shown in the following illustration.
Fig 1.15 Removing the Front Cover (Model CIMR-F7Z45P5 Shown Above)
1-15
Mounting the Digital Operator
After attaching the terminal cover, mount the Digital Operator onto the Inverter using the following procedure.
1. Hook the Digital Operator at A (two locations) on the front cover in the direction of arrow 1 as shown in
the following illustration.
2. Press the Digital Operator in the direction of arrow 2 until it snaps in place at B (two locations)
1
1. Do not remove or attach the Digital Operator or mount or remove the front cover using methods other
than those described above, otherwise the Inverter may break or malfunction due to imperfect contact.
2. Never attach the front cover to the Inverter with the Digital Operator attached to the front cover. Imper-
fect contact can result.
IMPORTANT
Always attach the front cover to the Inverter by itself first, and then attach the Digital Operator to the
front cover.
1-16
Inverters of 22 kW or More
For inverters with an output of 22 kW or more, remove the terminal cover and then use the following proce-
dures to remove the Digital Operator and main cover.
Fig 1.17 Removing the Front Cover (Model CIMR-F7Z2022 Shown Above)
1-17
1
1-18
2
Wiring
This chapter describes wiring terminals, main circuit terminal connections, main circuit termi-
nal wiring specifications, control circuit terminals, and control circuit wiring specifications.
Short-circuit bar
1
Main Contactor
T 2 1 B1 B2
Fuses
2
PE
2
Forward Run / Stop S1
MA
Fault relay output
Reverse Run / Stop S2 MB 250 VAC, 1 A max.
30 VDC, 1 A max.
External Fault S3 MC
Fault reset S4
Multi-function M1
digital inputs Multi-step speed setting 1 S5 Relay output 1
[Factory setting] M2 [Default: Running]
Multi-step speed setting 2 S6
M3
Jog frequency selection S7 Relay output 2 Multi-function digital output
M4 [Default: Zero speed] 250 VAC, 1 A max.
Hardware Baseblock Terminals Hardware Baseblock BB 30 VDC, 1 A max.
are only available in the Inverter M5
Version with Safety Hardware Baseblock 1 BB1 Relay output 3
M6 [Default:
SN Frequency agree 1]
SC
SP 3
24 V
E(G)
Shield
terminal
2CN
0V
-V Analog input power supply
E(G)
-15 V, 20 mA Shield
terminal
Input
MP
Option Pulse train output
2CN
Adjustment,
20 kΩ
+ - Multi-function analog output 1
FM (-10 to +10 V, 2 mA / 4 to 20 mA)
Terminating FM
[Default: Output frequency, 0 to 10 V)
resistance
4 to 20 mA (20 kΩ)]
Adjustment,
R+
20 kΩ
P R- + - Multi-function analog output 2
MEMOBUS AM
AM (-10 to +10 V, 2 mA / 4 to 20 mA)
communication
S+ [Default: Output current, 0 to 10 V)
RS-485/422
P AC 4 to 20 mA (20 kΩ)]
S-
IG
Shielded Twisted-pair
P
wires shielded wires
2-2
Circuit Descriptions
Refer to the numbers indicated in Fig 2.1.
1 These circuits are hazardous and are separated from accessible surfaces by protective separation
2 These circuits are separated from all other circuits by protective separation consisting of double and
reinforced insulation. These circuits may be interconnected with SELV* (or equivalent) or non-
SELV* circuits, but not both.
3 Inverters supplied by a four-wire-system source (neutral grounded)
These circuits are SELV* circuits and are separated from all other circuits by protective separation
consisting of double and reinforced insulation. These circuits may only be interconnected with
2
other SELV* (or equivalent) circuits.
BB BB1 SN
SN SC SP A1 A2 V+ AC V- MP AC RP R+ R- M5 M6 MA MB MC
IMPORTANT
E(G ) S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 FM AC AM IG S+ S- M3 M4 M1 M2 E(G)
2. The Hardware Baseblock Terminals BB, BB1 and SN are only available in the Inverter Version with Safety.
3. The output current capability of the +V and -V terminals is 20 mA.
4. Main circuit terminals are indicated with double circles and control circuit terminals are indicated with single cir-
cles.
5. The wiring of the digital inputs S1 to S7, BB and BB1 is shown for the connection of contacts or NPN transistors
(0V common and sinking mode). This is the default setting.
For the connection of PNP transistors or for using a 24V external power supply, refer to page 2-25, Sinking/Sourc-
ing Mode.
6. The master frequency reference can be input either at terminal A1 or at terminal A2 by changing the setting of
parameter H3-13. The default setting is terminal A1.
7. The multi-function analog outputs are dedicated meter outputs for analog frequency meters, ampmeters, voltme-
ters, wattmeters, etc. Do not use these outputs for feedback control or for any other control purposes.
8. To enable the inverter both inputs, “BB” and “BB1” must be closed. If only on of the inputs is opened “BB” will be
displayed in the operator display and the inverter will not start.
9. DC reactors to improve the input power factor are built into 200 V Class Inverters from 22 up to 110 kW and 400 V
Class Inverters from 22 up to 300 kW. A DC reactor is an option only for Inverters of 18.5 kW or less. Remove the
short circuit bar when connecting a DC reactor.
2-3
Terminal Block Configuration
The terminal arrangements are shown in Fig 2.2 and Fig 2.3.
(* SN SC SP A1 A2 V+ AC V- MP AC RP R+ R- M5 M6 MA MB MC
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 )0 $& $0 ,* 6 6 0 0 0 0 (*
E(G) S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 FM AC AM IG S+ S- M3 M4 M1 M2 E(G)
2
Control Circuit Terminals
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
Charge Indicator
Fig 2.2 Terminal Arrangement of Standard and Safety Inverter (200 V/400 V Class Inverter of 0.4 kW)
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
Fig 2.3 Terminal Arrangement of Standard Inverter (200 V/400 V Class Inverter of 22 kW or more)
2-4
BB BB1 SC
SN SC SP A1 A2 V+ AC V- MP AC RP R+ R- M5 M6 MA MB MC
E(G) S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 FM AC AM IG S+ S- M3 M4 M1 M2 E(G)
Charge Indicator
Ground Terminals
Fig 2.4 Terminal Arrangement of Safety Inverter (200 V/400 V Class Inverter of 22 kW or more)
2-5
Wiring Main Circuit Terminals
2
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1, 2, B1, B2,
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1.5 to 4 2.5
F7Z20P4 M4 1.2 to 1.5 (14 to 10) (14)
Power cables,
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1, 2, B1, B2, e.g., 600 V vinyl
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 16 16 power cables
F7Z2011 M5 2.5 (6 to 4) (6)
M8 9.0 to 10.0 25 to 35 25
(4 to 2) (4)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 U/T1, M8 9.0 to 10.0 50 50
V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 (1 to 1/0) (1)
F7Z2030 10 to 16
3 M6 4.0 to 5.0 (8 to 4) -
M8 9.0 to 10.0 25 to 35 25
(4 to 2) (4)
2-6
Table 2.1 200 V Class Wire Sizes
Recom-
Inverter Termi- Tightening Possible Wire
Sizes mended Wire
Model Terminal Symbol nal Torque Wire Type
Size mm2
CIMR- Screws (N•m) mm2(AWG)
(AWG)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 U/T1, M10 17.6 to 22.5 70 to 95 70
V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 (2/0 to 4/0) (2/0)
M8 8.8 to 10.8 6 to 16 –
3 (10 to 4)
F7Z2037
35 to 70 35
M10 17.6 to 22.5
(2 to 2/0) (2)
0.5 to 4 1.5
r/l1, Δ/l2 M4 1.3 to 1.4 (20 to 10) (16)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 U/T1,
V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31
M10 17.6 to 22.5
95
(3/0 to 4/0)
95
(3/0) 2
6 to 16
3 M8 8.8 to 10.8 –
F7Z2045 (10 to 4)
50 to 70 50
M10 17.6 to 22.5 (1 to 2/0) (1)
r/l1, Δ/l2 M4 1.3 to 1.4 0.5 to 4 1.5
(20 to 10) (16)
50 to 95 50 × 2P
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 M12 31.4 to 39.2
(1/0 to 4/0) (1/0 × 2P)
90 90
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 M10 17.6 to 22.5 (4/0) (4/0)
F7Z2055 M8 8.8 to 10.8 6 to 70 –
3 (10 to 2/0)
35 to 95 50
M10 17.6 to 22.5
(3 to 4/0) (1/0)
0.5 to 4 1.5
r/l1, Δ/l2 M4 1.3 to 1.4 (20 to 10) (16)
M12 31.4 to 39.2 95 to 122 95 × 2P
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 (3/0 to 250) (3/0 × 2P)
95 95 × 2P Power cables,
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 M10 17.6 to 22.5 e.g., 600 V vinyl
(3/0 to 4/0) (3/0 × 2P)
power cables
6 to 70
F7Z2075 3 M8 8.8 to 10.8 (10 to 2/0) –
2-7
Table 2.2 400 V Class Wire Sizes
Recom-
Inverter Termi- Tightening Possible
Wire Sizes mended Wire
Model Terminal Symbol nal Torque Wire Type
Size mm2
CIMR- Screws (N•m) mm2 (AWG)
(AWG)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1, 2, B1, B2,
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1.5 to 4 2.5
F7Z40P4 M4 1.2 to 1.5
(14 to 10) (14)
2-8
Table 2.2 400 V Class Wire Sizes
Recom-
Inverter Termi- Tightening Possible
Wire Sizes mended Wire
Model Terminal Symbol nal Torque Wire Type
Size mm2
CIMR- Screws (N•m) mm2 (AWG)
(AWG)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1, U/T1, V/T2, W/ M8 9.0 to 10.0 35 to 50 35
T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 (2 to 1/0) (2)
F7Z4045 M6 4.0 to 5.0 10 to 16 -
3 (8 to 4)
25 to 35 25
M8 9.0 to 10.0
(4 to 2) (4)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1, U/T1, V/T2, 50 50
M8 9.0 to 10.0
W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 (1 to 1/0) (1)
F7Z4055 3 M6 4.0 to 5.0 10 to 16
(8 to 4)
- 2
25 to 35 25
M8 9.0 to 10.0
(4 to 2) (4)
70 to 95 70
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 M10 31.4 to 39.2 (2/0 to 4/0) (2/0)
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 M10 17.6 to 22.5 50 to 100 50
(1/0 to 4/0) (1/0)
6 to 16
F7Z4075 3 M8 8.8 to 10.8 -
(10 to 4)
35 to 70 35
M10 31.4 to 39.2 (2 to 2/0) (2)
r/l1, Δ200/l2200, Δ400/l2400 M4 1.3 to 1.4 0.5 to 4 1.5
(20 to 10) (16)
95 95
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 M10 31.4 to 39.2
(3/0 to 4/0) (4/0)
95 95
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 M10 17.6 to 22.5 (3/0 to 4/0) (4/0)
F7Z4090 M8 8.8 to 10.8 10 to 16 -
3 (8 to 4)
50 to 95 50
M10 31.4 to 39.2 Power cables,
(1 to 4/0) (1)
e.g., 600 V vinyl
r/l1, Δ200/l2200, Δ400/l2400 0.5 to 4 1.5 power cables
M4 1.3 to 1.4 (20 to 10) (16)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 50 to 95 50 × 2P
M10 31.4 to 39.2 (1/0 to 4/0) (1/0 × 2P)
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31
10 to 70
3 M8 8.8 to 10.8 -
F7Z4110 (8 to 2/0)
70 to 150 70
M12 31.4 to 39.2 (2/0 to 300) (2/0)
r/l1, Δ200/l2200, Δ400/l2400 M4 1.3 to 1.4 0.5 to 4 1.5
(20 to 10) (16)
95 95 × 2P
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 (3/0 to 4/0) (3/0 × 2P)
M10 31.4 to 39.2
75 to 95 75 × 2P
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 (2/0 to 4/0) (2/0 × 2P)
F7Z4132 M8 8.8 to 10.8 10 to 70 -
3 (8 to 2/0)
95 to 150 95
M12 31.4 to 39.2
(4/0 to 300) (4/0)
r/l1, Δ200/l2200, Δ400/l2400 0.5 to 4 1.5
M4 1.3 to 1.4 (20 to 10) (16)
95 to 185 95 × 2P
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, , 1 (4/0 to 400) (4/0 × 2P)
M12 31.4 to 39.2
95 to 185 95 × 2P
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31
(3/0 to 400) (3/0 × 2P)
10 to 70
F7Z4160 3 M8 8.8 to 10.8 (8 to 2/0) -
2-9
Table 2.2 400 V Class Wire Sizes
Recom-
Inverter Termi- Tightening Possible
Wire Sizes mended Wire
Model Terminal Symbol nal Torque Wire Type
Size mm2
CIMR- Screws (N•m) mm2 (AWG)
(AWG)
150 × 2P
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 (300 × 2P)
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L33 120 × 2P
(250 × 2P)
95 to 300 300 × 2P
M16 78.4 to 98 (4/0 to 600)
, 1 (600 × 2P)
F7Z4185
3 –
95 × 2P
Determine the wire size for the main circuit so that line voltage drop is within 2% of the rated voltage.
Line voltage drop is calculated as follows:
IMPORTANT Line voltage drop (V) = 3 x wire resistance (W/km) x wire length (m) x current (A) x 10-3
2-10
Recommended Crimp Terminals
4 M4
M4
650/4
650/4
1650/4
1650/4
GS4-6
GS4-6
2
M5 101 R/5 1650/5 GS5-6
6
M6 101 R/6 1650/6 GS6-6
2-11
Main Circuit Terminal Functions
Main circuit terminal functions are summarized according to terminal symbols in Table 2.3. Wire the terminals
correctly for the desired purposes.
Table 2.3 Main Circuit Terminal Functions (200 V Class and 400 V Class)
Model: CIMR-F7Z
Purpose Terminal Symbol
200 V Class 400 V Class
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 20P4 to 2110 40P4 to 4300
Main circuit power input
R1/L11, S1/L21, T1/L31 2022 to 2110 4022 to 4300
2 Inverter outputs U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 20P4 to 2110 40P4 to 4300
DC bus terminals 1, 20P4 to 2110 40P4 to 4300
Braking Resistor Unit con-
B1, B2 20P4 to 2018 40P4 to 4018
nection
DC reactor connection 1, 2 20P4 to 2018 40P4 to 4018
Braking Unit connection 3, 2022 to 2110 4022 to 4300
Ground 20P4 to 2110 40P4 to 4300
2-12
Main Circuit Configurations
The main circuit configurations of the Inverter are shown in Table 2.4.
2-13
Standard Connection Diagrams
Standard Inverter connection diagrams are shown in Fig 2.5. These are the same for both 200 V Class and
400 V Class Inverters. The connections depend on the Inverter capacity.
2 Braking Resistor
Unit (optional) Braking Unit (op-
tional)
Be sure to remove the short-circuit bar before connecting the DC The DC reactor is built in.
reactor.
3-phase 3-phase
200 VAC 400 VAC
The control power is supplied internally from the DC bus in all inverter models.
Fig 2.5 Main Circuit Terminal Connections
2-14
Wiring the Main Circuits
This section describes wiring connections for the main circuit inputs and outputs.
Installing Fuses
To protect the inverter, it is recommended to use semiconductor fuses like they are shown in the table below.
Table 2.5 Input Fuses
2
Rated Inverter Fuse Selection Selection Example (Ferraz)
Inverter Type Output 2 2
Current (A) Voltage (V) Current (A) I t (A s) Model Rating I2t (A2s)
20P4 3.2 240 10 12~25 A60Q12-2 600V / 12A 17
20P7 4.1 240 10 12~25 A60Q12-2 600V / 12A 17
21P5 7.0 240 15 23~55 A60Q15-2 600V / 15A 26
22P2 9.6 240 20 34~98 A60Q20-2 600V / 20A 41
23P7 15 240 30 82~220 A60Q30-2 600V / 30A 132
25P5 23 240 40 220~610 A50P50-4 500V / 50A 250
27P5 31 240 60 290~1300 A50P80-4 500V / 80A 640
2011 45 240 80 450~5000 A50P80-4 500V / 80A 640
2015 58 240 100 1200~7200 A50P125-4 500V / 125A 1600
2018 71 240 130 1800~7200 A50P150-4 500V / 150A 2200
2022 85 240 150 870~16200 A50P150-4 500V / 150A 2200
2030 115 240 180 1500~23000 A50P200-4 500V / 200A 4000
2037 145 240 240 2100~19000 A50P250-4 500V/ 250A 6200
2045 180 240 300 2700~55000 A50P300-4 500V / 300A 9000
2055 215 240 350 4000~55000 A50P350-4 500V / 350A 12000
2075 283 240 450 7100~64000 A50P450-4 500V / 450A 20000
2090 346 240 550 11000~64000 A50P600-4 500V / 600A 36000
2110 415 240 600 13000~83000 A50P600-4 500V / 600A 36000
2-15
Installing a Moulded-case Circuit Breaker
When connecting the power input terminals (R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3) to the power supply using a moulded-case
circuit breaker (MCCB) observe that the circuit breaker is suitable for the Inverter.
• Choose an MCCB with a capacity of 1.5 to 2 times of the inverter's rated current.
• For the MCCB's time characteristics, be sure to consider the inverter's overload protection (one minute at
150% of the rated output current).
Installing an AC Reactor
If the Inverter is connected to a large-capacity power transformer (600 kW or more) or a phase advancing
capacitor is switched, an excessive peak current may flow through the input power circuit, causing the inverter
unit to break down.
To prevent this, install an optional AC Reactor on the input side of the Inverter or a DC reactor to the DC reac-
tor connection terminals.
This also improves the power factor on the power supply side.
2-16
Wiring the Output Side of Main Circuit
Observe the following precautions when wiring the main output circuits.
2-17
Ground Wiring
Observe the following precautions when wiring the ground line.
• Always use the ground terminal of the 200 V Inverter with a ground resistance of less than 100 Ω and that
of the 400 V Inverter with a ground resistance of less than 10 Ω.
• Do not share the ground wire with other devices, such as welding machines or power tools.
• Always use a ground wire that complies with technical standards on electrical equipment and minimize the
length of the ground wire.
Leakage current flows through the Inverter. Therefore, if the distance between the ground electrode and the
ground terminal is too long, potential on the ground terminal of the Inverter will become unstable.
2 • When using more than one Inverter, be careful not to loop the ground wire.
OK NO
L3-04 (Stall prevention selection during deceleration) 0 (Disable stall prevention function)
(Select either of them.) 3 (Enable stall prevention function with braking resistor)
The braking resistor connection terminals are B1 and B2. Do not connect the resistor to any other termi-
nals. Otherwise the resistor and other equipment may get damaged
IMPORTANT
2-18
Connecting a Braking Resistor Unit (LKEB) and Braking Unit (CDBR)
Connect a Braking Resistor Unit and Braking Unit to the Inverter as shown in the Fig 2.8. The internal braking
resistor overheat protection must be disabled (See table below).
L8-01 (Protection selection for internal DB resistor) 0 (Disable overheat protection)
L3-04 (Stall prevention selection during deceleration) 0 (Disable stall prevention function)
(Select either of them.) 3 (Enable stall prevention function with braking resistor)
The Braking Resistor Unit will not work properly if L3-04 is set to 1 (i.e., if stall prevention is enabled for
deceleration). Hence the deceleration time may be longer than the set time (C1-02/04/06/08).
To prevent the braking unit/braking resistor from overheating, design the control circuit to turn OFF the power
supply using the thermal overload relay contacts of the units as shown in Fig 2.8.
2
200 V and 400 V Class Inverters with 0.4 to 18.5 kW Output Capacity
Thermal overload
Inverter
relay contact
Thermal overload
relay contact
Fig 2.8 Connecting the Braking Resistor and Braking Unit
2-19
Connecting Braking Units in Parallel
When connecting two or more Braking Units in parallel, use the wiring and jumper settings like shown in
Fig 2.9. There is a jumper for selecting whether each Braking Unit is to be a master or slave. Select “Master”
for the first Braking Unit only, and select “Slave” for all other Braking Units (i.e. from the second Unit
onwards).
Thermal overload relay contact Thermal overload relay contact Thermal overload relay contact
Braking Braking
2
Braking Resistor Resistor
Resistor Unit Unit
Unit (LKEB) (LKEB)
(LKEB)
Inverter
Level de-
tector
Braking Unit #1
Thermal overload relay Thermal overload relay Thermal overload relay
contact contact contact
2-20
Wiring Control Circuit Terminals
Wire Sizes
For remote operation using analog signals, keep the control line length between the Analog Operator or oper-
ation signals and the Inverter to 50 m or less, and separate the lines from main power lines or other control cir-
cuits to reduce induction from peripheral devices.
When setting frequencies from an external frequency source (and not from a Digital Operator), use shielded
twisted-pair wires and ground the shield for the largest area of contact between shield and ground.
The terminal numbers and the appropriate wire sizes are shown in Table 2.7.
Table 2.7 Terminal Numbers and Wire Sizes (Same for all Models) 2
Recom-
Termi- Tightening Possible
mended
Terminals nal Torque Wire Sizes Wire Type
Wire Size
Screws (N•m) mm2(AWG)
mm2(AWG)
FM, AC, AM, SC, SP,
SN, A1, A2, +V, –V, S1, Single wire*2:
S2, S3, S4, S5, S6, S7, 0.5 to 2.5
BB*1, BB1*1, Phoenix
0.5 to 0.6 Stranded 0.75
MA, MB, MC, M1, M2, type wire: (18) • Shielded, twisted-pair wire*3
M3, M4, M5, M6 0.5 to 1.5 • Shielded, polyethylene-cov-
MP, RP, R+, R-, S+, S-, (26 to 14) ered, vinyl sheath cable
IG
0.5 to 2.5 1
E (G) M3.5 0.8 to 1.0
(20 to 14) (12)
* 1. Terminals BB and BB1 are only available in the Inverter version with Safety.
* 2. Use shielded twisted-pair cables to input an external frequency reference.
* 3. We recommend using straight solderless terminal on signal lines to simplify wiring and improve reliability.
2-21
Wiring Method
Use the following procedure to connect wires to the terminal block.
1. Loosen the terminal screws with a thin-slot screwdriver.
2. Insert the wires from underneath the terminal block.
3. Tighten the terminal screws firmly
Control circuit
terminal block
2
Strip the end for
7 mm if no solder-
less terminal is
Solderless terminal or wire 3.5 mm max.
used. without soldering
Wires Blade thickness: 0.6 mm max.
2-22
Control Circuit Terminal Functions
The functions of the control circuit terminals are shown in Table 2.9. Use the appropriate terminals for the cor-
rect purposes.
Table 2.9 Control Circuit Terminals with Default Settings
Type No. Signal Name Function Signal Level
S1 Forward run/stop command Forward run when ON; stopped when OFF.
S2 Reverse run/stop command Reverse run when ON; stopped when OFF.
S3 External fault input*1 Fault when ON.
S4 Fault reset*1 Reset when ON 2
Multi-step speed reference Functions are
Auxiliary frequency ref-
S5 selected by set- 24 VDC, 8 mA
1*1 (Master/auxiliary switch) erence when ON. ting H1-01 to Photocoupler
Digital Multi-step speed reference Multi-step setting 2 when H1-05.
input S6
signals
2*1 ON.
S7 Jog frequency reference*1 Jog frequency when ON.
BB Hardware Baseblock *2 – –
SP Digital Input Power Supply +24VDC power supply for digital inputs 24 VDC, 250 mA max. *3
15 V
+V 15 V power output 15 V power supply for analog references
(Max. current: 20 mA)
–15 V
–V –15 V power output –15 V power supply for analog references
(Max. current: 20 mA)
A1 Frequency reference –10 to +10 V/100% –10 to +10 V(20 kΩ)
Analog
input Function is
signals 4 to 20 mA/100% 4 to 20 mA(250Ω)
A2 Multi-function analog input selected by set-
–10 V to +10 V/100% –10 V to +10 V(20kΩ)
ting H3-09.
AC Analog reference common – –
Shield wire, optional ground
E(G) – –
line connection point
M1
Running signal
Operating when ON.
(1NO contact)
M2
Relay contacts
M3 Multi-function Contact capacity:
Zero level (b2-01) or digital outputs 1 A max. at 250 VAC
Zero speed
Se- below when ON
quence M4 1 A max. at 30 VDC*4
output
signals M5 Within ±2 Hz of set fre-
Speed agreement detection
M6 quency when ON.
MA Relay contacts
MB Fault when CLOSED across MA and MC Contact capacity:
Fault output signal 1 A max. at 250 VAC
Fault when OPEN across MB and MC
MC 1 A max. at 30 VDC*4
Multi-function analog output 0 to 10 V, 10V=100% Multi-function
FM –10 to +10 V max. ±5%
(frequency output) output frequency analog output 1
Analog 2 mA max.
output AC Analog common –
signals
Multi-function analog output 0 to 10 V, 10V=200% Multi-function 4 to 20 mA current output
AM
(current monitor) Inverter's rated current analog output 2
2-23
Table 2.9 Control Circuit Terminals with Default Settings
Type No. Signal Name Function Signal Level
0 to 32 kHz (3 kΩ)
RP Pulse input*5 H6-01 (Frequency reference input) High level voltage 3.5 to
Pulse I/O 13.2 V
0 to 32 kHz
MP Pulse monitor H6-06 (Output frequency)
+15 V output (2.2 kΩ)
R+ MEMOBUS communica- Differential input, Photo-
R- tions input For 2-wire RS-485, short R+ and S+ as well coupler isolation
RS-485/ as R- and S-.
S+ MEMOBUS communica- Differential input, Photo-
2
422
S- tions output coupler isolation
IG Signal common – –
* 1. The default settings are given for terminals S3 to S7. For a 3-wire sequence, the default settings are a 3-wire sequence for S5, multi-step speed setting 1
for S6 and multi-step speed setting 2 for S7.
* 2. Terminals BB and BB1 are only available in the Inverter version with Safety.
* 3. Do not use this power supply for supplying any external equipment.
* 4. When driving a reactive load, such as a relay coil with DC power supply, always insert a flywheel diode as shown in Fig 2.12.
* 5. Pulse input specifications are given in the following table.
Flywheel diode
S1
Off On
RS422/485 Port Termination Resistance
V I Analog Input A2 Current/Voltage Signal Selection
2-24
The functions of DIP switch S1 and jumper CN15 are shown in the following table.
Internal Power Supply – Sinking Mode External Power Supply – Sinking Mode
External +24V
Internal Power Supply – Sourcing Mode External Power Supply – Sourcing Mode
External +24V
2-25
Control Circuit Terminal Connections
Connections to Inverter control circuit terminals are shown in Fig 2.14.
Fault reset S4
Multi-function M1
digital inputs Multi-step speed setting 1 S5 Relay output 1
2
[Factory setting] M2 [Default: Running]
Multi-step speed setting 2 S6
M3
Jog frequency selection S7 Relay output 2 Multi-function digital output
M4 [Default: Zero speed] 250 VAC, 1 A max.
Hardware Baseblock Terminals Hardware Baseblock BB 30 VDC, 1 A max.
are only available in the Inverter M5
Version with Safety Hardware Baseblock 1 BB1 Relay output 3
M6 [Default:
SN Frequency agree 1]
SC
SP
24 V
E(G)
Shield
terminal
2CN
0V
-V Analog input power supply
E(G)
-15 V, 20 mA Shield
terminal
Input
MP
Option Pulse train output
2CN
Adjustment,
20 kΩ
+ - Multi-function analog output 1
FM (-10 to +10 V, 2 mA / 4 to 20 mA)
Terminating FM
[Default: Output frequency, 0 to 10 V)
resistance
4 to 20 mA (20 kΩ)]
Adjustment,
R+
20 kΩ
P R- + - Multi-function analog output 2
MEMOBUS AM
AM (-10 to +10 V, 2 mA / 4 to 20 mA)
communication
S+ [Default: Output current, 0 to 10 V)
RS-485/422
P AC 4 to 20 mA (20 kΩ)]
S-
IG
Shielded Twisted-pair
P
wires shielded wires
2-26
Safe Disable Input Precautions
The Safe Disable Function (Hardware Baseblock inputs) is only available in the Inverter Version with Safety
(Inverter with spec C).
Installation
1. If the Safe Disable function is utilized, the wire link between the terminals SN, BB, and BB1 that is pre-
installed at the shipment has to be removed entirely
2. Connect the drive to an EN954-1, Safety Category 3 interrupting device so that in case of a Safe Disable
request the connection between the terminal SN and both terminals BB and BB2 are opened.
Drive Power Supply
EN954-1 24V
Safety Cat. 3 SP
Device SC
SN Controller
SN
BB
BB1
Notes:
1. To assure that the Safe Disable function appropriately fulfills the safety requirements of the application, a
throughout risk assessment shall be done according to ISO12100 for the whole safety systems at the final
installation.
2. If only one signal line from the safety device to the drive is used (“BB” and “BB1” are linked at the drive),
the drive must be installed in an enclosure with protection degree of at least IP54 in order to maintain
EN954-1, safety category 3 compliance. If two separate signal lines from the safety device to the inputs
“BB” and “BB1” are used (like shown above), the drive must not necessarily be installed in an IP54 enclo-
sure.
3. If the safety device and the drive are installed in separate cabinets, the Safe Disable wire must be installed
in a short circuit proof way.
4. The Safe Disable function does not cut the power supply to the drive and does not provide electrical isola-
tion. Before any installation or maintenance work is done, the drive’s power supply must be switched off.
5. The time from opening the Safe Disable input until the drive output is swithced off is less than 10 msec.
2-27
Control Circuit Wiring Precautions
Observe the following precautions when wiring control circuits.
• Separate control circuit wiring from main circuit wiring (terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, B1, B2, U/T1, V/T2,
W/T3, , 1, 2, and 3) and other high-power lines.
• Separate wiring for control circuit terminals MA, MB, MC, M1, M2, M3, M4, M5, and M6 (digital out-
puts) from wiring to other control circuit terminals.
• If using an optional external power supply, it shall be a UL Listed Class 2 power supply source.
2 • Use twisted-pair or shielded twisted-pair cables for control circuits to prevent operating faults.
• Ground the cable shields with the maximum contact area of the shield and ground.
• Cable shields have to be grounded on both cable ends.
2-28
Wiring Check
Checks
Check all wiring after wiring has been completed. Do not perform continuity check on control circuits. Per-
form the following checks on the wiring.
• Is all wiring correct?
• Have no wire clippings, screws, or other foreign material been left?
• Are all screws tight?
• Are any wire ends contacting other terminals?
2-29
Installing and Wiring Option Cards
2
Two phase (phase A and B), +12V inputs, max.
PG-B2 A
response frequency: 50 kHz
Three phase (phase A, B, Z), line driver inputs
PG-X2 A
(RS422), max. response frequency: 300 kHz
PG Speed Control Cards
Dual encoder PG feedback card (two times phase A,
B, Z), selectable line driver (RS422) or open collector
PG-Z2 A
inputs, max. response frequency 30 kHz (open collec-
tor) and 300 kHz (line driver)
DeviceNet SI-N1/
Option card for DeviceNet fieldbus C
communications card PDRT2
Profibus-DP
SI-P1 Option card for Profibus-DP fieldbus C
communications card
InterBus-S
SI-R1 Option card for InterBus-S fieldbus C
communications card
CANOpen
SI-S1 Option card for CANOpen fieldbus C
communications card
LonWorks
SI-J Option card for LonWorks fieldbus C
communication card
Mechatrolink II
SI-T1 Option card for Mechatrolink II fieldbus C
communication card
Modbus TCP/IP CM090 Option card for Modbus TCP/IP fieldbus C
Ethernet IP CM092 Option card for Ethernet IP fieldbus C
3G3RV-
PLC option card C
P10ST8-E
PLC option cards 3G3RV- PLC option card with DeviceNet communications
P10ST8- port (Slave) C
DRT-E
2 channel high resolution analog input card
Channel 1: 0 to 10 V (20 kΩ)
AI-14U C
Channel 2: 4 to 20 mA (250 Ω)
Resolution: 14 Bit
Analog Input Cards
3 Channel high resolution analog input card
Signal level: -10 to +10 V (20 kΩ)
AI-14B C
4 to 20 mA (250 Ω)
Resolution: 13 Bit + sign
DI-08 8 bit digital speed reference input card C
Digital Input Cards
DI-16H2 16 bit digital speed reference input card C
Installation
Before mounting an Option Card, remove the terminal cover and be sure that the charge indicator inside the
Inverter does not glow anymore. After that remove the Digital Operator and front cover and then mount the
Option Card.
2-30
Refer to documentation provided with the Option Card for the mounting instructions for option slots A and C.
2-31
Preventing C Option Card Connectors from Rising
After installing an Option Card into slot C, insert an Option Clip to prevent the side with the connector from
rising. The Option Clip can be easily removed by holding onto the protruding portion of the Clip and pulling it
out.
C Option Card
Option Clip
(To prevent raising of
C Option Card)
2-32
PG Speed Control Card Terminals and Specifications
PG-B2
The terminal specifications for the PG-B2 are given in the following table.
Table 2.13 PG-B2 Terminal Specifications
Terminal No. Contents Specifications
1 12 VDC (±5%), 200 mA max.
Power supply for pulse generator
2
2 0 VDC (GND for power supply)
3 H: +8 to 12 V (max. input frequency: 50 kHz)
TA1 Pulse input terminals phase A
4 GND pulse input phase A
5 H: +8 to 12 V (max. input frequency: 50 kHz)
Pulse input terminals phase B
6 GND pulse input phase B
1 Pulse monitor output terminals
Open collector output, 24 VDC, 30 mA max.
2 phase A
TA2
3 Pulse monitor output terminals
Open collector output, 24 VDC, 30 mA max.
4 phase B
TA3 (E) Shield connection terminal -
PG-X2
The terminal specifications for the PG-X2 are given in the following table.
2-33
Wiring
Three-phase Inverter
R/L1
2 S/L2
T/L3
Fig 2.17 PG-B2 Wiring Using the Option Cards Power Supply
• When connecting to a voltage-output-type PG (encoder), select a PG that has an output impedance with a
current of at least 12 mA to the input circuit photocoupler (diode).
• The pulse monitor dividing ratio can be changed using parameter F1-06.
2-34
PG power
supply
+12 V Pulse monitor
output phase A
A-phase
Division rate
Pulse input pulses
phase A
circuit
Pulse monitor
output phase B
2
B-phase
Pulse input pulses
phase B
PG-X2
+12 V
0V
+5 V
A-phase pulse input (+)
Pulse input phase A (–)
Pulse input phase B (+)
Pulse input phase B (–)
Pulse input phase Z (+)
Pulse input phase Z (–)
Fig 2.20 PG-X2 Wiring Using the Option Cards Power Supply
2-35
PG-X2
PG power
supply
TA1
AC
0V +12V
IP12 1
0V
IG 2
Capacitor for +12 V
IP5 3 momentary
power loss + +
A (+) 4
- PG
A (-) 5
+
B (+) 6
-
2
B (-) 7
+
Z (+) 8
-
Z (-) 9
IG 10
TA3
2-36
Cable Lug Connector Sizes and Tightening Torque
The lug sizes and tightening torques for various wire sizes are shown in Table 2.16.
2-37
2
2-38
3
Digital Operator and
Modes
This chapter describes Digital Operator displays and functions, and pro-
vides an overview of operating modes and switching between modes.
This section describes the displays and functions of the Digital Operator.
3 REF:
source than the digital operator is selected
Lights up when any other frequency reference
source than the digital operator is selected
ALARM: Lights up when an fault or alarm has occurred.
Data Display
Displays monitor data, parameter numbers,
and settings.
Keys
ESC Key Returns to the status before the DATA/ENTER key was pressed.
3-2
Table 3.1 Key Functions (Continued)
Key Name Function
Enables jog operation when the Inverter is operated from the Digital
JOG Key
Operator.
Selects the rotation direction of the motor when the Inverter is oper-
FWD/REV Key
ated from the Digital Operator.
Selects menu items, sets parameter numbers, and increments set val-
Increment Key ues.
Used to move to the next item or data.
Decrement Key
Selects menu items, sets parameter numbers, and decrements set val-
ues. 3
Used to move to the previous item or data.
There are indicators on the upper left of the RUN and STOP keys on the Digital Operator. These indicators
will light and flash to indicate operating status.
The RUN key indicator will flash and the STOP key indicator will light during initial excitation or DC brak-
ing. The relationship between the indicators on the RUN and STOP keys and the Inverter status is shown in
Fig 3.2.
Frequency setting
3-3
Modes
This section describes the Inverter's modes and switching between modes.
Inverter Modes
The Inverter's parameters and monitoring functions are organized in groups called modes that make it easier to
read and set parameters.The Inverter is equipped with 5 modes.
The 5 modes and their primary functions are shown in the Table 3.2.
Table 3.2 Modes
Mode Primary function(s)
Use this mode to start/stop the inverter, to monitor values such as the frequency ref-
Drive mode
erences or output current and for displaying fault information or the fault history.
3
Quick programming mode Use this mode to read and set the basic parameters.
Advanced programming mode Use this mode to reference and set all parameters.
Use this mode to read/set parameters that have been changed from their factory-set
Verify mode
values.
Use this mode when running a motor with unknown motor data in the vector control
Autotuning mode* modes. The motor data are measured/calculated and set automatically.
This mode can also be used to measure only the motor line-to-line resistance.
* Always perform autotuning with the motor before operating in the vector control modes.
3-4
Switching Modes
The mode selection display will appear when the MENU key is pressed. Press the MENU key from the mode
selection display to switch through the modes in sequence.
Press the DATA/ENTER key to enter a mode and to switch from a monitor display to the setting display.
Display at Startup
-DRIVE- Rdy
Frequency Ref
U1- 01=50.00Hz
U1-02=50.00Hz
U1-03=10.05A
3
-DRIVE- -DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy
** Main Menu ** Monitor RESET Frequency Ref Frequency Ref
U1 - 01=50.00Hz U1- 01=50.00Hz U1- 01=050.00Hz
Operation U1-02=50.00Hz U1-02=50.00Hz (0.00 ~ 50.00)
U1-03=10.05A U1-03=10.05A " 00.00Hz "
ESC ESC ESC
MENU
MENU
MENU
MENU
To run the inverter after viewing/changing parameters press the MENU key and the DATA/ENTER
key in sequence to enter the Drive mode. A Run command is not accepted as long as the drive is in
IMPORTANT any other mode.
3-5
Drive Mode
The Drive mode is the mode in which the Inverter can be operated. All monitor parameters (U1- ) as well
as fault information and the fault history can be displayed in this mode
When b1-01 (Reference selection) is set to 0, the frequency can be changed from the frequency setting display
using the Increment, Decrement, and Shift/RESET keys. The parameter will be written and the display returns
to the Monitor display.
Example Operations
Example key operations in drive mode are shown in the following figure.
Display at Startup
-DRIVE- Rdy
Frequency Ref
3
U1- 01=50.00Hz
U1-02=50.00Hz
U1-03=10.05A
MENU
-DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy
Monitor RESET
FAN Elapsed Time The fault name will be
-ADV- U1 - 40 = 10H U1- 40 = 10H displayed if the DATA/ENTER
** Main Menu ** U1-01=50.00Hz U1-01=50.00Hz
U1-02=50.00Hz U1-02=50.00Hz
Key is pressed while a constant
Programming ESC
is being displayed for which a
1 2 fault code is being displayed.
MENU
3 4
-VERIFY-
** Main Menu ** -DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy
Fault Trace RESET Current Fault U2 - 01= OC
Modified Consts U2 - 01=OC U2 - 01 = OC
U2-02= OV U2-02=OV Over Current
U2-03=50.00Hz ESC
U2-03=50.00Hz ESC
MENU
-A.TUNE-
-DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy Rdy
** Main Menu ** Fault Trace Last Fault
RESET
U2 - 02= OV
Auto-Tuning U2 - 02 = OV U2 - 02 = OV
U3-03=50.00Hz U3-03=50.00Hz DC Bus Overvolt
U3-04=50.00Hz ESC
U3-04=50.00Hz ESC
3 4
5 5
-DRIVE- Rdy -DRIVE- Rdy Rdy
Fault History RESET Last Fault U3 - 01= OC
U3 - 01= OC U3 - 01 = OC
U3-02= OV U3-02=OV Over Current
U3-03= OH ESC
U3-03=OH ESC
5 5
A B
3-6
Note: 1. When changing the display with the Increment / Decrement keys, the next display after the one for the last parameter number will be the one for the
first parameter number and vice versa. For example, the next display after the one for U1-01 will be U1-40. This is indicated in the figures by the let-
ters A and B and the numbers 1 to 6.
2. The display for the first monitor parameter (frequency reference) will be displayed when power is turned ON. The monitor item displayed at startup
can be set in o1-02 (Monitor Selection after Power Up).Operation cannot be started from the mode selection display.
3
Example Operations
Example key operations in quick programming mode are shown in the following figure.
Mode Selection Display Monitor Display Setting Display
MENU
-DRIVE-
** Main Menu **
Operation
A B
MENU
MENU
-QUICK- -QUICK-
Reference Source Reference Source
-ADV-
** Main Menu ** b1-01=1 *1* b1-01= 1 *1*
Terminals Terminals
Programming ESC
-QUICK- -QUICK-
MENU Run Source Run Source
b1-02=1 *1* b1-02= 1 *1*
-VERIFY- Terminals Terminals
** Main Menu ** ESC
Modified Consts
-QUICK- -QUICK-
MENU Terminal AM Gain Terminal AM Gain
H4-05 = 50% H4-05 = 0050.0%
(0.0 ~ 1000.0) (0.0 ~ 1000.0)
-A.TUNE- 50.0% 50.0%
** Main Menu ** ESC
Auto-Tuning
-QUICK- -QUICK-
MOL Fault Select MOL Fault Select
L1-01=1 *1* L1-01= 1 *1*
Std Fan Cooled Std Fan Cooled
ESC
-QUICK- -QUICK-
StallP Decel Sel StallP Decel Sel
L3-04=1 *1* L3-04= 1 *1*
Enabled Enabled
ESC
A B
3-7
Advanced Programming Mode
In advanced programming mode all Inverter parameters can be monitored and set.
A parameter can be changed from the setting displays using the Increment, Decrement, and Shift/RESET
keys. The parameter will be saved and the display will return to monitor display when the DATA/ENTER key
is pressed after changing the setting.
Refer to Chapter 5 User Parameters for details on the parameters.
Example Operations
Example key operations in advanced programming mode are shown in the following figure.
Mode Selection Display Monitor Display Setting Display
3 A B 1 2
MENU
MENU 1 2
-A.TUNE- 3 4
** Main Menu **
Auto-Tuning -ADV- -ADV- -ADV-
RESET
PID Control PID Mode PID Mode
b5-01=0 b5- 01 =0 *0* b5-01= 0 *0*
MENU
PID Mode Disabled Disabled
ESC ESC
-DRIVE-
** Main Menu **
-ADV- -ADV- -ADV-
RESET
Operation PID Control Fb los Det Time Fb los Det Time
b5 - 14= 1.0Sec b5- 14 =1.0Sec b5-14= 01.0Sec
(0.0 ~ 25.5) (0.0 ~ 1000.0)
Fb los Det Time 1.0 sec ESC 50.0%
MENU ESC
-QUICK- 3 4
** Main Menu **
Quick Setting 5 6
5 6
A B
3-8
Setting Parameters
Here the procedure to change C1-01 (Acceleration Time 1) from 10 s to 20 s is shown.
Table 3.3 Setting Parameters in Advanced Programming Mode
Step
Digital Operator Display Description
No.
-DRIVE- Rdy
Frequency Ref
1 U1- 01=50.00Hz Power supply turned ON.
U1-02=50.00Hz
U1-03=10.05A
-DRIVE-
** Main Menu **
2
Operation
-QUICK-
3
** Main Menu ** Press the MENU key 3 times to enter the advanced programming
3
Quick Setting mode.
-ADV-
** Main Menu **
4
Programming
-ADV-
Initialization
5 Press the DATA/ENTER to access the monitor display.
A1-00=1
Select Language
-ADV-
Accel / Decel Press the Increment or Decrement key to display the parameter
6 C1-00 = 10.0sec C1-01 (Acceleration Time 1).
Accel Time 1
-ADV-
Accel Time 1 Press the DATA/ENTER key to access the setting display. The cur-
7 C1-01 = 0 010.0sec
(0.0 ~ 6000.0) rent setting value of C1-01 is displayed.
"10.0 sec"
-ADV-
Accel Time 1
8 C1-01 = 000 10.0sec Press the Shift/RESET key to move the flashing digit to the right.
(0.0 ~ 6000.0)
"10.0 sec"
-ADV-
Accel Time 1
9 C1-01 = 0011 0.0sec Press the Increment key to change set value to 20.00 s.
(0.0 ~ 6000.0)
"10.0 sec"
-ADV-
Accel Time 1
10 C1-01 = 0012 0.0sec Press the DATA/ENTER key to save the set data.
(0.0 ~ 6000.0)
"10.0 sec"
-ADV-
“Entry Accepted” is displayed for 1 sec after pressing the
11 Entry Accepted
DATA/ENTER key.
-ADV-
Accel Time 1
12 C1-01
01 = 20.0sec The display returns to the monitor display for C1-01.
(0.0 ~ 6000.0)
"10.0 sec"
3-9
Verify Mode
The Verify mode is used to display any parameters that have been changed from their default settings in a pro-
gramming mode or by autotuning. If no parameter setting has been changed the display will show “None
Modified”
In Verify Mode the same procedures as in the Programming Mode can be used to change parameter settings.
The parameter A1-02 is the only parameter from the A1- group, which will be displayed in Verify Mode,
the other A1- Parameters will not be displayed as changed parameters.
Example Operations
In the example below the following settings have been changed from their default settings:
• b1-01 (Reference Selection)
3 • C1-01 (Acceleration Time 1)
• E1-01 (Input Voltage Setting)
• E2-01 (Motor Rated Current).
MENU
-ADV-
** Main Menu **
Programming
A B
MENU
MENU
-VERIFY- -VERIFY-
Accel Time 1 Accel Time 1
-A.TUNE- C1-01=200.0sec C1-01= 0 200.0sec
** Main Menu ** (0.0 ~ 6000.0) (0.0 ~ 6000.0)
"10.0sec" "10.0sec"
Auto-Tuning ESC
-VERIFY- -VERIFY-
MENU Input Voltage Input Voltage
E1-01=190VAC E1-01= 190VAC
(155~255) (155~255)
-DRIVE- "200VAC" "200VAC"
** Main Menu ** ESC
Operation
-VERIFY- -VERIFY-
Motor Rated FLA Motor Rated FLA
E2-01= 2.00A E2-01= 2.00A
MENU (0.32~6.40) (0.32~6.40)
"1.90A" "1.90A"
ESC
-QUICK-
** Main Menu **
Quick Setting
A B
MENU
3-10
Autotuning Mode
Autotuning automatically measures and sets the required motor data in order to achieve the maximum perfor-
mance. Always perform autotuning before starting operation when using the vector control modes.
When V/f control has been selected, only stationary autotuning for line-to-line resistance can be selected.
For an optimal result the Autotuning should be performed under no load condition (no machine connected to
the motor). If the motor cannot be disconnected from the load, and Open Loop or Closed Loop Vector Control
shall be used, perform stationary autotuning and make the first run with the lowest possible load.
Example of Operation
Enter the motor rated output power (in kW), rated voltage, rated current, rated frequency, rated speed and
number of poles specified on the nameplate of the motor and then press the RUN key. The motor is automati-
cally run and the measured motor data are set in the E2- parameters. 3
Always set the above items. Otherwise autotuning cannot be started, e.g. it cannot be started from the motor
rated voltage input display.
A parameter can be changed from the setting displays using the Increment, Decrement, and Shift/RESET
keys. The parameter will be saved when the DATA/ENTER key is pressed.
3-11
The following example shows the autotuning input procedure for standard rotating autotuning in Open Loop
Vector Control.
MENU
-VERIFY-
** Main Menu **
Modified Consts
MENU
MENU
-A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
3
Mtr Rated Power Mtr Rated Power
-DRIVE- T1- 02= 0.40kW T1-01= 0 00.40kW
** Main Menu ** (0.00~650.00) (0.00~650.00)
"0.40kW" "0.40kW"
Operation ESC
-A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
MENU
Rated Voltage Rated Voltage
T1- 03 = 200.0VAC T1- 03 = 200.0VAC
-QUICK- (0.0~255.0) (0.0~255.0)
"200.0VAC" "200.0VAC"
** Main Menu ** ESC
Quick Setting
-A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
Rated Current Rated Current
MENU T1- 04 = 1.90A T1- 04 = 001.90A
(0.32~6.40) (0.32~6.40)
"1.90A" "1.90A"
-ADV- ESC
** Main Menu **
Programming -A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
Rated Frequency Rated Frequency
T1- 05 = 50.0Hz T1-05 = 050.0Hz
MENU (0.0~400.0) (0.0~400.0)
"50.0Hz" "50.0Hz"
ESC
-A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
Number of Poles Number of Poles
T1- 06 = 4 T1-06 = 4
(2~48) (2~48)
"4" "4"
STOP
The display will
automatically -A.TUNE- -A.TUNE-
Tune Aborted Tune Successful
change depending
on the status of STOP key
autotuning.
3-12
4
Trial Operation
This chapter describes the procedures for trial operation of the Inverter and provides an example of trial operation.
Perform trial operation according to the following flowchart. When setting the basic parameters, always set
C6-01 (Heavy/Normal Duty Selection) according to the application.
START
Installation
Wiring
Turn ON power.
Confirm status.
Basic settings
Select operating
(Quick programming mode)
method.
4 YES
YES V/f Control with PG (A1-02=1)
PG?
NO
V/f control
Settings according
to control mode
YES
4-2
Trial Operation
Application Confirmation
For applications with quadratic torque characteristic like pumps, fans or blowers set C6-01 (Heavy/Normal
Duty selection) to 1 or 2 (Normal Duty 1 or 2). Select the Normal Duty mode (1 or 2) regarding the required
overload capability.
For applications with constant torque characteristics like conveyors etc. always set C6-01 to 0 (Heavy Duty).
The default setting is of C6-01 is 0 (Heavy Duty).
For details on the Heavy/Normal Duty selection refer to Chapter 6 Application and Overload Selections.
Connector
CHARGE indicator
4-3
Power ON
Confirm all of the following items and then turn ON the power supply.
• Check that the power supply is of the correct voltage.
200 V class: 3-phase 200 to 240 VDC, 50/60 Hz
400 V class: 3-phase 380 to 480 VDC, 50/60 Hz
• Make sure that the motor output terminals (U, V, W) and the motor are connected correctly.
• Make sure that the Inverter control circuit terminal and the control device are wired correctly.
• Set all Inverter control circuit terminals to OFF.
• When using a PG Speed Control Card, make sure that it is wired correctly.
-DRIVE- Rdy
4
Frequency Ref
U1- 01=50.00Hz The frequency reference monitor is dis-
Display for normal operation
U1-02=50.00Hz played in the data display section.
U1-03=10.05A
When a fault has occurred, the details of the fault will be displayed instead of the above display. In that case,
refer to Chapter 7 Troubleshooting. The following display shows an example of a display for faulty operation.
-DRIVE-
The display will differ depending on the
UV
Display for fault operation type of fault.
DC Bus Undervolt
A low voltage alarm is shown at left.
4-4
Basic Settings
Switch to the quick programming mode (“QUICK” will be displayed on the LCD screen) and set the follow-
ing parameters.
Refer to Chapter 3 Digital Operator and Modes for Digital Operator operating procedures and to Chapter 5
User Parameters and Chapter 6 Parameter Settings by Function for details on the parameters.
Table 4.1 Basic Parameter Settings
: Must be set. : Set as required.
Parame-
Setting Factory
Class ter Num- Name Description Page
Range Setting
ber
Sets the control method for the Inverter.
0: V/f control
Control method
A1-02 1: V/f control with PG 0 to 3 0 5-8
selection
2: Open Loop Vector control
3: Closed Loop Vector Control
Sets the frequency reference input
method.
b1-01
Reference selec-
tion
0: Digital Operator
1: Control circuit terminal
(analog input)
0 to 4 1
5-10
6-7
6-68
4
2: MEMOBUS communications 6-85
3: Option Card
4: Pulse train input
Sets the run command input method.
5-10
0: Digital Operator
Operation method 6-12
b1-02 1: Control circuit terminal (digital input) 0 to 3 1
selection 6-68
2: MEMOBUS communications
6-85
3: Option Card
Selects stopping method when stop com-
mand is sent.
Stopping method 0: Deceleration to stop 5-10
b1-03 0 to 3 0
selection 1: Coast to stop 6-14
2: DC braking stop
3: Coast to stop with timer
Sets the acceleration time in seconds for
Acceleration 5-20
C1-01 the output frequency to climb from 0% to 0.0 to 6000.0 10.0 s
time 1 6-20
100%.
Sets the deceleration time in seconds for
Deceleration 5-20
C1-02 the output frequency to fall from 100% to 0.0 to 6000.0 10.0 s
time 1 6-20
0%.
Set to Heavy Duty or Normal Duty
regarding to the applications require-
Heavy /Normal ments. 5-25
C6-01 0 or 2 0
Duty selection 0: Heavy Duty 6-2
1: Normal Duty 1
2: Normal Duty 2
d1-01 to
Frequency refer-
d1-01 to d1-16: 0.00
ences 1 to 16 and Sets the required speed references for 0 to 150.00 Hz 5-26
d1-16 and Hz
jog frequency ref- multi-step speed operation or jogging. * 6-10
d1-17 d1-17: 6.00
erence
Hz
4-5
Table 4.1 Basic Parameter Settings (Continued)
: Must be set. : Set as required.
Parame-
Setting Factory
Class ter Num- Name Description Page
Range Setting
ber
200 V
155 to 255 V (200 V
Input voltage set- Sets the Inverter's nominal input voltage (200 V class) class) 5-31
E1-01
ting in volts. 310 to 510 V 400 V 6-113
(400 V class) (400 V
class)
Setting for
general-
10% to 200% purpose 5-32
Motor rated cur-
E2-01 Sets the motor rated current. of Inverter's motor of 6-51
rent
rated current same 6-111
capacity as
Inverter
H4-02:
H4-02 Can be used to adjust the analog output
FM and AM ter- 0.0 to 100%
and when an instrument is connected to the 5-49
minal output gain 1000.0% H4-05:
4
H4-05 FM or AM terminal.
50%
Used to enable or disable the motor over-
load protection function.
0: Disabled
1: Protection for general purpose motor
Motor protection 5-52
L1-01 (fan cooled) 0 to 3 1
selection 6-51
2: Protection for frequency converter
motor (externally cooled)
3: Protection for special vector control
motor
If using the dynamic brake option (brak-
Stall prevention ing resistor, Braking Resistor Units and
5-55
L3-04 selection during Braking Units), be sure to set parameter 0 to 3 1
6-25
deceleration L3-04 to 0 (disabled) or 3 (enabled with
braking resistor).
* The setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will be
0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
4-6
Settings for the Control Methods
The usable Autotuning methods depend on the control method setting of the Inverter.
Overview of Settings
Make the required settings in quick programming mode and autotuning mode according to Fig 4.1.
4-7
Open Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 2)
Always perform autotuning. If the motor can be operated, perform rotating autotuning. If the motor cannot be
operated, perform non-rotating autotuning 1 or 2. Refer to the following section on Autotuning for details on
autotuning.
Autotuning
Autotuning sets motor parameters automatically when using Open Loop or Closed Loop Vector control, when
the cable length is long or the installation has changed.
Non-rotating Autotuning 2
Non-rotating autotuning 2 is used for Open Loop Vector control and Closed Loop Vector Control. Set T1-01 to
4 and parameter T1-09 (Motor no-load current) will be added as an input parameter. Input all data from the
4-8
motor nameplate and additiona the motor no-load current from the motor manufacturer’s motor test result and
press the RUN key on the Digital Operator.
If T1-09 is not set the value of a Yaskawa standard motor will be used.
4-9
Precautions for Rotating and Non-rotating Autotuning
• If the motor rated voltage is higher than the power supply voltage, lower the base voltage value like shown
in Fig 4.3 to prevent saturation of the Inverter’s output voltage. Use the following procedure to perform
autotuning.
1. Input the voltage of the input power supply to T1-03 (Motor rated voltage).
2. Input the results of the following formula to T1-05 (Motor base frequency):
T1-03
T1-05 = Base frequency from motor nameplate × -----------------------------------------------
Motor rated voltage
3. Perform autotuning.
After the completing autotuning, set E1-04 (Max. output frequency) to the base frequency from the motor’s
nameplate.
Output voltage
Rated voltage
from motor
name plate
4 T1-03
0 Output frequency
Base frequency from Base frequency
x T1-03
motor name plate from motor name
Rated voltage from motor plate
name plate
Fig 4.3 Motor Base Frequency and Inverter Input Voltage Setting
• When speed precision is required at high speeds (i.e., 90% of the rated speed or higher), set T1-03 (Motor
rated voltage) to the input power supply voltage × 0.9. In this case at high speeds the output current will
increase as the input power supply voltage is reduced. Be sure to provide sufficient margin in the Inverter
current.
4-10
Parameter Settings for Autotuning
The following parameters must be set before autotuning.
4-11
Application Settings
Parameters can be set as required in advanced programming mode. All the parameters which can be set in
quick programming mode are also displayed and can be set in the advanced programming mode.
Setting Examples
• The following points are examples of settings for applications.
• When using an Inverter-mounted braking resistor (ERF), set L8-01 to 1 to enable ERF braking resistor
overheating protection.
• To prevent the machine from being operated in reverse, set b1-04 to 1 to disable reverse operation.
• To increase the speed of a 50 Hz motor by 10%, set E1-04 to 55.0 Hz.
• To use a 0 to 10 V analog signal for a 50 Hz motor for variable-speed operation between 0 and 45 Hz (0%
to 90% speed deduction), set H3-02 to 90.0%.
• To limit the speed range between 20% and 80% set d2-01 to 80.0% and set d2-02 to 20.0%.
4 No-load Operation
This section describes trial operation in which the motor is in no-load state, that means the machine is not con-
nected to the motor. To avoid failures caused by the wiring of the control circuit it is recommended to use the
LOCAL mode. Press the LOCAL/REMOTE key on the Digital Operator to change to LOCAL mode (the SEQ
and REF indicators on the Digital Operator should be OFF).
Always confirm safety around the motor and machine before starting Inverter operation from the Digital
Operator. Confirm that the motor works normally and that no faults are displayed at the Inverter. For applica-
tions, at which the machine can be driven in one direction only, check the motor rotation direction.
Operation with Jog frequency reference (d1-17, default: 6.00 Hz) can be started and stopped by pressing and
releasing the JOG key on the Digital Operator. If the external control circuit prevents operation from the Digi-
tal Operator, confirm that emergency stop circuits and machine safety mechanisms are functioning, and then
start operation in REMOTE mode (i.e., with a signal from the control signal terminal). The safety precautions
must always be taken before starting the inverter and the motor connected.
Both, a RUN command (forward or reverse) and a frequency reference (or multi-step speed command)
NOTE must be provided to start Inverter operation.
Loaded Operation
4-12
Operation using the Digital Operator
• Use the Digital Operator to start operation in LOCAL mode in the same way as in no-load operation.
• If a fault occurs during operation, make sure that the STOP key on the Digital Operator is accessible easily.
• At first, set the frequency reference to a low speed, e.g. to one tenth of the normal operating speed.
4-13
Adjustment Suggestions
If hunting, vibration, or other problems originated in the control system occur during trial operation, adjust the
parameters listed in the following table according to the control method. This table lists the most commonly
used parameters only.
Table 4.4 Adjusted Parameters
Recom-
Control Name (Parameter Factory
Influence mended Adjustment Method
Method Number) Setting
Setting
• Reduce the setting if
Controlling hunting torque is insufficient for
Hunting-prevention and vibration in mid- heavy loads.
1.00 0.50 to 2.00
gain (n1-02) dle-range speeds (10 to • Increase the setting if hunt-
40 Hz) ing or vibration occurs for
light loads.
• Increase the setting if
• Reducing motor motor magnetic noise is
Carrier frequency magnetic noise Depends high.
selection • Controlling hunting on capac- 0 to default • Reduce the setting if hunt-
(C6-02) and vibration at low ity ing or vibration occurs at
speeds low to middle-range
speeds.
4 V/f control
Torque compensation
• Increasing torque
Depends
• Reduce the setting if
torque or speed response is
(A1-02 = 0 and speed response 200 to 1000
primary delay time on capac- low.
or 1) • Controlling hunting ms
constant (C4-02) ity • Increase the setting if hunt-
and vibration
ing or vibration occurs.
• Increase the setting if
• Improving torque at
torque is insufficient at
low speeds (10 Hz
Torque compensation low speeds.
or lower) 1.00 0.50 to 1.50
gain (C4-01) • Reduce the setting if hunt-
• Controlling hunting
ing or vibration occurs for
and vibration
light loads.
Middle output fre-
• Increase the setting if
quency voltage • Improving torque at Depends Default to torque is insufficient at
(E1-08) low speeds on capac- Default + low speeds.
Minimum output fre- • Controlling shock at ity and
quency voltage startup voltage 5 V* • Reduce the setting if the
shock at startup is large.
(E1-10)
• Increasing torque
• Reduce the setting if
Speed feedback detec- and speed response
torque or speed response is
tion control (AFR) • Controlling hunting
1.00 0.50 to 2.00 low.
gain and vibration in mid-
• Increase the setting if hunt-
(n2-01) dle-range speeds (10
ing or vibration occurs.
to 40 Hz)
• Reduce the setting if
• Increasing torque
Torque compensation torque or speed response is
Open Loop and speed response
primary delay time 20 ms 20 to 200 ms low.
Vector con- • Controlling hunting
constant (C4-02) • Increase the setting if hunt-
trol and vibration
ing or vibration occurs.
(A1-02 = 2)
• Increasing speed • Reduce the setting if speed
Slip compensation pri-
response 100 to response is low.
mary delay time 200 ms
• Improving speed sta- 500 ms • Increase the setting if the
(C3-02)
bility speed is not stable.
• Increase the setting if
Slip compensation • Improving speed speed response is low.
1.0 0.5 to 1.5
gain (C3-01) accuracy • Reduce the setting if the
speed is too high.
4-14
Table 4.4 Adjusted Parameters (Continued)
Recom-
Control Name (Parameter Factory
Influence mended Adjustment Method
Method Number) Setting
Setting
• Reducing motor • Increase the setting if
magnetic noise motor magnetic noise is
Depends
Carrier frequency • Controlling hunting 0 to high.
on capac-
selection (C6-02) and vibration at low default • Reduce the setting if hunt-
ity
Open Loop speeds (10 Hz or ing or vibration occurs at
Vector con- less) low speeds.
trol (A1-02 Middle output fre-
• Increase the setting if
= 2) quency voltage • Improving torque at Depends Default to torque or speed response is
(E1-08) low speeds on capac- Default + low.
Minimum output fre- • Controlling shock at ity and
quency voltage startup voltage 5 V* • Reduce the setting if shock
at startup is large.
(E1-10)
• Increase the setting if
ASR proportional gain • Torque and speed
torque or speed response is
1 (C5-01) and response 10.00 to
20.00 low.
ASR proportional gain • Controlling hunting 50.00
• Reduce the setting if hunt-
2 (C5-03) and vibration
ing or vibration occurs.
ASR integral time 1
(high-speed) (C5-02)
• Torque and speed
response 0.300 to
• Reduce the setting if
torque or speed response is 4
and 0.500 s low.
• Controlling hunting 1.000 s
ASR integral time 2 • Increase the setting if hunt-
and vibration
(low-speed) (C5-04) ing or vibration occurs.
Sets the output frequency at
Switching the ASR which to change the ASR
Closed
proportional gain and 0.0 to max. proportional gain and inte-
Loop Vec- ASR switching fre-
integral time accord- 0.0 Hz output fre- gral time when the same val-
tor control quency (C5-07)
ing to the output fre- quency ues cannot be used for high-
(A1-02 = 3)
quency speed and low-speed opera-
tion.
Increase the setting if
ASR primary delay • Controlling hunting 0.004 to
0.004 s machine rigidity is low and
time (C5-06) and vibration 0.020
the system vibrates easily.
• Increase the setting if
• Reducing motor motor magnetic noise is
magnetic noise Depends too high.
Carrier frequency 2.0 kHz to
• Controlling hunting on the • Reduce the setting if hunt-
selection (C6-02) default
and vibration at low capacity. ing or vibration occurs at
speeds (3 Hz or less) very low to middle-range
speeds.
* The setting is given for 200 V Class Inverters. Double the voltage for 400 V Class Inverters.
• Do not change the Torque Compensation Gain (C4-01) from its default setting of 1.00 when using Open
Loop Vector control.
• If speeds are inaccurate during regeneration in Open Loop Vector control, enable Slip Compensation dur-
ing regeneration (C3-04 = 1).
• Use slip compensation to improve speed control during V/f control (A1-02 = 0).
Set the Motor Rated Current (E2-01), Motor Rated Slip (E2-02), and Motor No-load Current (E2-03), and
then adjust the Slip Compensation Gain (C3-01) between 0.5 and 1.5. The default setting for V/f control is
C3-01 = 0.0 (slip compensation disabled).
• To improve speed response and stability in V/f control with a PG (A1-02 = 1), set the ASR parameters
(C5-01 to C5-05) to between 0.5 and 1.5 times the default value. (Normally it is not necessary to adjust this
setting.)
4-15
The following parameters will also affect the control system indirectly.
4-16
5
User Parameters
This chapter describes all user parameters that can be set in the Inverter.
5-2
Digital Operation Display Functions and Levels
The following figure shows the Digital Operator display hierarchy for the Inverter.
No. Function Page
U1 Status Monitor Parameters 5-70
U2 Fault Trace 5-75
MENU Drive Mode U3 Fault History 5-76
5
d4 Reference Frequency Hold 5-28
d5 Torque Control 5-29
d6 Field Weakening 5-30
E1 V/f Pattern 5-31
Verify Mode E2 Motor Setup 5-32
5-3
User Parameters Available in Quick Programming Mode
The minimum user parameters required for Inverter operation can be monitored and set in quick programming
mode. The user parameters displayed in quick programming mode are listed in the following table. These, and
all other user parameters, are also displayed in advanced programming mode.
5-4
Param- Change Control Methods MEMO
Name
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed BUS
Description
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Regis-
ber Display tion ter
PG Vector Vector
Frequency
d1-01 reference 1 Sets the master frequency reference. 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 280H
Reference 1
Frequency Sets the frequency reference when
d1-02 reference 2 multi-step speed command 1 is ON for a 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 281H
Reference 2 multi-function input.
Jog fre-
quency ref- Sets the frequency reference when
erence multi-function inputs „Jog Frequency
d1-17 6.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 292H
Command“, „FJOG command“, or
Jog Refer- „RJOG command“is ON.
ence
Input volt-
Sets the inverter input voltage. This set 155 to
age setting 200 V
E1-01 value will be the basis for the protection 255 No Q Q Q Q 300H
Input *3 *3
functions.
Voltage
5
V/f pattern
0 to E: Select from 15 preset patterns.
selection
E1-03 F: Custom user-set pattern (Applicable 0 to F F No Q Q No No 302H
V/f
for the setting of E1-04 to E1-10).
Selection
Max. output
frequency 40.0 to
E1-04 (FMAX) 150.0 50.0 Hz No Q Q Q Q 303H
Max *2
Frequency
Max. voltage 0.0 to
200.0 V
E1-05 (VMAX) 255.0 No Q Q Q Q 304H
*3
Max Voltage *3
Base fre-
quency (FA) 0.0 to
E1-06 150.0 50.0 Hz No Q Q Q Q 305H
Base Fre- *2
quency
Min. output
frequency 0.0 to 0.5 Hz
E1-09 (FMIN) 150.0 *4 No Q Q Q A 308H
Min Fre- *2
quency
Base voltage 0.0 to
Sets the output voltage at the base fre- 0.0 V
E1-13 (VBASE) 255.0 *5 No A A Q Q 30CH
quency (E1-06).
Base Voltage *3
5-5
Param- Change Control Methods MEMO
Name
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed BUS
Description
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Regis-
ber Display tion ter
PG Vector Vector
Motor rated
power 0.00 to 0.40
Sets the rated output power of the motor.
E2-11 650.00 kW No Q Q Q Q 318H
Mtr Rated It is an input data for autotuning
kW *7
Power
PG constant
Sets the number of PG pulses (pulse 0 to
F1-01 PG Pulses/ 1024 No No Q Q Q 380H
generator or encoder). 60000
Rev
5-6
Param- Change Control Methods MEMO
Name
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed BUS
Description
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Regis-
ber Display tion ter
PG Vector Vector
Sets the Speed Follower operatoin mode
0: Disabled
Follower Follower mode is disabled and the
Mode Selec- drive runs from the normal fre-
toin quency reference.
1: Speed - Both Directions
The drive follows the master encoder
S1-01 speed in both directions. 0 to 3 0 No Q Q Q Q 680H
2: Speed - Forward Direction
The drive follows the master encoder
Follower speed in the forward direction only.
Mode 3: Speed - Absolute Value
The drive follows the master encoder
speed but ignores the master encoder
direction (always forward direction)
Master
encoder PPR 20 to
S1-02 Sets the master drive encoder PPR. 1024 No Q Q Q Q 681H
Master PG 60000
PPR
Ratio
Numerator
(Upper 4 Sets the upper 4 digits of the primary 0 to
S1-03 Digits) 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q 682H
gear ratio numerator. 9999
Ratio Num
High
Ratio
Denomina-
5
tor (Upper 4 Sets the upper 4 digits of the primary 0 to
S1-04 Digits) 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q 683H
gear ratio denominator 9999
Ratio Den
High
* 1. The setting ranges for acceleration/deceleration times depends on the setting C1-10 (Acceleration/deceleration time setting unit). If C1-10 is set to 0, the
setting range is 0.00 sto 600.00 sec.
* 2. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range
will be 0.0 to 400.0Hz.
* 3. The values are for a 200 V class Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 4. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (Open Loop Vector control factory settings are given.)
* 5. After autotuning, E1-13 will contain the same value as E1-05.
* 6. The setting range depends on the Inverter capacity (The value for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.)
* 7. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (The value for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.)
5-7
User Parameter Tables
Setup Settings: A
Initialize Mode: A1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Language Used to select the language
selection for displayed on the Digital Oper-
Digital ator (JVOP-160 only).
Operator 0: English
display 1: Japanese
2: German
A1-00 0 to 6 0 Yes A A A A 100H –
3: French
4: Italian
Select 5: Spanish
Language 6: Portuguese
This parameter is not changed
by the initialize operation.
Used to set the parameter
Parameter access level (set/read.)
access level 0: Monitoring only
(Monitoring drive mode
and setting A1-01 and A1-
04.)
1: Used to select user param-
5 A1-01
eters (Only parameters set
in A2-01 to A2-32 can be
0 to 2 2 Yes A A A A 101H 6-144
5-8
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Password input when a pass-
Password word has been set in A1-05.
This function write-protects
some parameters of the initial-
ize mode.
0 to
A1-04 If the password is changed, 0 No A A A A 104H 6-144
9999
Enter Pass- A1-01 to A1-03 and A2-01 to
word A2-32 parameters can no
longer be changed. (Program-
ming mode parameters can be
changed.)
Password Used to set a four digit num-
setting ber as the password.
Usually this parameter is not
displayed. When the Password 0 to
A1-05 0 No A A A A 105H 6-144
Select Pass- (A1-04) is displayed, hold 9999
word down the RESET key and
press the Menu key. The pass-
word will be displayed.
User-set Parameters: A2
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
5
ber Display tion PG Vector Vector
User speci- Used to select the function for
fied parame- each of the user specified
A2-01 ters parameters. User parameters b1-01
106H to
to are the only accessible parame- to – No A A A A 6-145
125H
A2-32 User Param ters if Parameter Access Level S2-05
1 to 32 is set to user parameters
(A1-01=1)
5-9
Application Parameters: b
5 Stopping
method
selection
method used when a stop
command is input.
0: Deceleration to stop
1: Coast to stop
2: DC injection braking stop
4-5
b1-03 (Stops faster than coast to 0 to 3 0 No Q Q Q Q 182H
6-14
stop, no regenerative
Stopping operation.)
Method 3: Coast to stop with timer
(Run commands are
disregarded during
deceleration.)
Prohibition 0: Reverse enabled
A A A A
of reverse 1: Reverse disabled
operation 0 to 2
b1-04 2: Output Phase Rotation 0 No 183H 6-54
*2
Reverse (both rotational directions A No A No
Oper are enabled)
Operation Used to set the method of
selection for operation when the
setting fre- frequency reference input
quencies is less than the minimum
equal or output frequency (E1-09).
lower than 0: Run at frequency reference
b1-05 E1-09 (E1-09 not effective). 0 to 3 0 No No No No A 184H 6-14
1: STOP (coast to stop)
2: Run at min. frequency.
Zero-Speed (E1-09)
Oper 3: Run at zero speed (Fre-
quencies below E1-09 are
zero)
Control Used to set the responsiveness
input scan of the control inputs (forward/
reverse and multi-function
inputs.)
b1-06 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 185H –
Cntl Input 0: Fast reading
Scans 1: Normal reading (Can be
used for possible
malfunction due to noise.)
5-10
Param- Name Change Control Methods
MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Display Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Operation Used to set the operation
selection mode when switching to the
after switch- Remote mode using the Local/
ing to Remote Key.
remote mode 0: Run signals that are input
during mode switching are
b1-07 disregarded. (Input Run 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 186H -
signals after switching the
LOC/REM mode.)
RUN Sel 1: Run signals become
effective immediately after
switching to the Remote
mode.
Run com- Used to set an operation prohi-
mand selec- bition in programming modes.
tion in 0: Operation prohibited.
program- 1: Operation permitted
ming modes (Disabled when Digital
b1-08 Operator is the selected 0 or 2 0 No A A A A 187H -
Run command source
RUN CMD (b1-02 = 0)).
at PRG 2: Prohibit entering
Programming Mode
during Run
* 1. The setting range is 0 or 1 for Closed Loop Vector control.
* 2. The setting range is 0 or 1 for Closed Loop Vector control an V/f control with PG
5
DC Injection Braking: b2
Param- Name Change Control Methods
MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Display Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Zero speed Used to set the frequency at
level (DC which DC injection braking
injection starts when b1-03 is set to 0
braking (deceleration to stop). 0.0 to 6-14
b2-01 starting fre- 0.5 Hz No A A A A 189H
When b2-01 is less than E1- 10.0 6-17
quency) 09, E1-09 becomes the DC
DCInj Start injection braking starting fre-
Freq quency.
DC injec-
tion braking Sets the DC injection braking
current 0 to 6-14
b2-02 current as a percentage of the 50% No A A A No 18AH
100 6-17
DCInj inverter rated current.
Current
DC injec- Used to set the time to per-
tion braking form DC injection braking at
time at start start in units of 1 second. 0.00
b2-03 Used to stop coasting motor to 0.00 s No A A A A 18BH 6-17
DCInj and restart it. When the set 10.00
Time@Start value is 0, DC injection brak-
ing at start is not performed.
DC injec- Used to set the time to per-
tion braking form DC injection braking at
time at stop stop in units of 1 second.
0.00
Used to prevent coasting after 6-14
b2-04 to 0.50 s No A A A A 18CH
the stop command has been 6-17
DCInj 10.00
input. When the set value is
Time@Stop 0.00, DC injection braking at
stop is not performed.
5-11
Speed Search: b3
Param- Name Change Control Methods
MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Display Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Speed Enables/disables the speed
search search function for the RUN
selection command and sets the speed
(current search method.
detection or 0: Disabled, speed calculation
speed cal- 1: Enabled, speed calculation
culation) 2: Disabled, current detection
3: Enabled, current detection
Speed Calculation:
When the search is started, the
motor speed is calculated and
b3-01 acceleration/deceleration is per- 0 to 3 2* 1 No A A A No 191H 6-56
formed from the calculated
speed to the specified frequency
SpdSrch at (motor direction is also
Start searched).
Current Detection:
The speed search is started from
the frequency when power was
momentarily lost or the maxi-
mum frequency. The speed is
detected by observing the cur-
rent.
5 Speed
search
Sets the speed search operation
current as a percentage, taking
operating the Inverter rated current as
current 100%. 0 to 100%* 2
b3-02 (current No A No A No 192H 6-56
Usually not necessary to set. 200
detection) When restarting is not possible
SpdSrch with the factory settings, reduce
Current the value.
Speed
search Sets the output frequency decel-
decelera- eration time during speed search
tion time in 1-second units.
0.1 to
b3-03 (current Sets the time for deceleration 2.0 s No A No A No 193H 6-56
10.0
detection) from the maximum output fre-
quency to the minimum output
SpdSrch frequency.
Dec Time
Speed When a speed search is per-
search wait formed after recovering from a
time (cur- momentary power loss, the
rent detec- search operation is delayed for
tion or 0.0 to
b3-05 the time set here. 0.2 s No A A A A 195H 6-56
speed cal- 20.0
If e.g. a contactor is used at the
culation) output side of the inverter set
Search this parameter to the contactor
Delay delay time or more.
Speed
Search
Compensa-
tion Gain Sets the gain, which is applied to
(speed cal- 1.00 to
b3-10 the estimated speed before the 1.10 No A No No No 19AH 6-56
culation 1.20
motor is restarted.
only)
Srch Detect
Comp
5-12
Param- Name Change Control Methods
MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Display Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Speed Selects the direction for the
Search Speed Search operation.
Rotating 0: Speed Search is started using
Selection the rotation direction from
Direction the frequency reference
b3-14 0 or 1 1 No A A A No 19EH 6-56
signal
1: Speed Search is started using
Bidir the rotation direction from
Search Sel the estimated speed during
speed search.
Speed
search Sets the current level to retry a
retrial cur-speed search as a percentage,
b3-17 rent level 0 to 200 150% No A No A No 1F0H 6-60
taking the Inverter rated current
SrchRestart as 100%.
Lvl
Speed
search
retrial Sets the time for detection in a
detection 0.00 to
b3-18 speed search retrial in units of 0.01s No A No A No 1F1H 6-60
time 1.00
seconds.
SrchRestart
Time
Number of
b3-19
speed
search retri- Sets the number of times that a
als speed search can be retried.
0 to 10 0 No A No A No 1F2H 6-60
5
Num of
SrchRestr
* 1. The factory setting will change when the control mode is changed (V/f control mode factory settings are given).
* 2. The given factory setting is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the factory
setting will be 120%.
Timer Function: b4
Control Methods
Param- Name Change
Close MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open
Description d BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop
Display Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector
Vector
Timer func- Sets the timer function output
tion ON- ON-delay time (dead time) for
delay time 0.0 to
b4-01 the timer function input. 0.0 s No A A A A 1A3H 6-98
3000.0
Delay-ON Enabled when a timer function
Timer is set in H1- and H2- .
5-13
PID Control: b5
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
5 Differential
(D) time
Sets D-control differential
time 0.00 to
b5-05 0.00 s Yes A A A A 1A9H 6-99
D-control is not performed 10.00
PID D Time when the setting is 0.00.
PID limit Sets the limit after PID-con-
0.0 to
b5-06 trol as a percentage of the 100.0% Yes A A A A 1AAH 6-99
PID Limit 100.0
maximum output frequency.
PID offset Sets the offset after PID-con- -100.0
b5-07 adjustment trol as a percentage of the to 0.0% Yes A A A A 1ABH 6-99
PID Offset maximum output frequency. +100.0
PID delay
time con- Sets the time constant for low
stant pass filter for PID-control out- 0.00 to
b5-08 0.00 s Yes A A A A 1ACH 6-99
put. 10.00
PID Delay Usually not necessary to set.
Time
PID output
characteris- Selects forward/reverse direc-
b5-09 tics selection tion for PID output. 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 1ADH 6-99
0: Normal PID output
Output 1: Reverse PID output
Level Sel
PID output
gain 0.0 to
b5-10 Sets output gain. 1.0 No A A A A 1AEH 6-99
25.0
Output Gain
PID reverse 0: Limit to 0 when PID
output selec- output is negative.
tion 1: Reverses when PID output
b5-11 is negative. 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 1AFH 6-99
Output Rev Limit to 0 is also active when
Sel reverse prohibit is selected by
using b1-04.
5-14
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Selection of 0: No detection of a feedback
PID feed- loss.
back signal 1: Detection of a feedback
loss detec- loss. (feedback under
tion detection level)
Operation continues
during detection, the fault
output is not operated.
2: Detection of a feedback
loss. (feedback under
detection level)
The motor coasts to stop at
detection, and the fault
b5-12 0 to 4 0 No A A A A 1B0H 6-99
output operates.
3: Detection of a feedback
Fb Los Det loss. (feedback over detec-
Sel tion level)
Operation continues
during detection, the fault
output is not operated.
4: Detection of a feedback
loss. (feedback over detec-
tion level)
The motor coasts to stop at
detection, and the fault
output operates.
PID feed-
back loss Sets the PID feedback loss
5
detection detection level as a percentage
b5-13 level 0 to 100 0% No A A A A 1B1H 6-99
using the maximum output
Fb los Det frequency as 100%.
Lvl
PID feed-
back loss
detection Sets the PID feedback loss 0.0 to
b5-14 time 1.0 s No A A A A 1B2H 6-99
detection time. 25.5
Fb los Det
Time
PID sleep
function
operation 0.0 to
Sets the PID sleep function
b5-15 level 150.0 0.0 Hz No A A A A 1B3H 6-99
start level as a frequency.
*
PID Sleep
Level
PID sleep
operation
delay time Sets the delay time until the 0.0 to
b5-16 0.0 s No A A A A 1B4H 6-99
PID sleep function starts. 25.5
PID Sleep
Time
Accel/decel
time for PID
reference Sets the accel/decel time for 0.0 to
b5-17 0.0 s No A A A A 1B5H 6-99
PID reference. 6000.0
PID Acc/
Dec Time
PID Set-
point Selec-
tion 0: Disabled
b5-18 0 to 1 0 No A A A A 1DCH 6-99
1: Enabled
PID Set-
point Sel
5-15
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
PID Setpoint 0 to
b5-19 PID-target value 0 No A A A A 1DDH 6-99
PID Setpoint 100.0%
Square root
Feedback
Gain Sets the gain for the PID 0.00 to
b5-29 1.00 No A A A A 1EBH 6-99
square root feedback function. 2.00
PID Fd SqRt
Gain
PID feed- Selects one of the inverters
back moni- monitor items (U1- ) as
PID feedback signal. The set-
tor selection
b5-31 0 to 18 0 No A A A A 1EDH 6-99
ting number is equal to the
PID Fb Mon monitor item which has to be
Sel the feedback value.
PID monitor
feedback
gain Sets the gain for the PID feed- 0.0 to
b5-32 100.0% No A A A A 1EEH 6-99
back signal. 1000.0
PID Fb Mon
Gain
5 PID monitor
feedback
bias Sets the bias for the PID feed-
-100.0
b5-33 to 0.0% No A A A A 1EFH 6-99
back value
PID Fb Mon 100.0
Bias
* The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will
be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
5-16
Dwell Functions: b6
Chang Control Methods
Param Name
Set- Fac- e dur- MEMO-
eter V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory ing BUS Page
Num- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Range Setting Opera- Register
ber PG Vector Vector
tion
Dwell fre-
quency at 0.0 to
b6-01 start 150.0 0.0 Hz No A A A A 1B6H 6-23
Dwell Ref *
@ Start
Dwell
time at
start Run command ON 0.0 to
b6-02 OFF 0.0 s No A A A A 1B7H 6-23
Dwell Output frequency 10.0
Time
@ Start
b6-01 b6-03
Dwell fre- Time
b6-02 b6-04
quency at 0.0 to
b6-03 stop 150.0 0.0 Hz No A A A A 1B8H 6-23
Dwell Ref *
The dwell function can be used to hold
@ Stop
the output frequency temporarily when
Dwell driving a motor with a heavy load.
time at
stop 0.0 to
b6-04 0.0 s No A A A A 1B9H 6-23
Dwell 10.0
Time
@ Stop
* The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will
5
be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz
Droop Control: b7
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Droop Con- Sets the Droop quantity at the
trol Gain rated speed and rated load as 0.0 to
b7-01 0.0% Yes No No No A 1CAH 6-128
Droop percentage of the maximum 100.0
Quantity output frequency.
Droop Con-
trol Delay Sets the Droop Control delay
Time time constant. 0.03 to
b7-02 0.05 s No No No No A 1CBH 6-128
Increase the value if hunting 2.00
Droop Delay occurs.
Time
5-17
Energy Saving: b8
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Energy-sav-
ing mode Select whether to enable or
selection disable energy-saving control.
b8-01 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 1CCH 6-109
0: Disable
Energy Save 1: Enable
Sel
Energy-sav-
ing gain Sets the energy-saving gain 0.7
0.0 to
b8-02 for Open Loop and Closed *1 Yes No No A A 1CDH 6-109
Energy Save Loop Vector control. 10.0
Gain
Energy-sav-
ing filter Sets the energy-saving filter
time con- time constant for Open Loop 0.00 to 0.50 s
b8-03 stant *2 Yes No No A A 1CEH 6-109
and Closed Loop Vector con- 10.0
Energy Save trol.
F.T
Energy-sav- Sets the energy-saving coeffi-
ing coeffi- cient depending on the setting
cient in E2-11 (motor rated current). 0.0 to 288.20
b8-04 *3 No A A No No 1CFH 6-109
Adjust the value in 5% steps 655.00
Energy Save until the output power
COEF becomes minimal.
Power detec-
5 b8-05
tion filter
time con- Sets the time constant for out- 0 to
20 ms No A A No No 1D0H 6-109
stant put power detection. 2000
kW Filter
Time
Search oper-
ation volt- Sets the limit of the voltage
age limiter control range during search
b8-06 0 to 100 0% No A A No No 1D1H 6-109
operation. 100% is the moni-
Search V tor rated voltage.
Limit
* 1. The factory setting is given for Open Loop Vector control. The closed Loop Vector control factory setting is 1.0.
* 2. The factory setting is 2.00 s when Inverter capacity is 55 kW
* 3. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (The setting for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4kW is given).
5-18
Zero Servo Control: b9
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Zero Servo Adjust the strength of the
Gain zero-servo lock.
Enabled when the “zero-servo
command” is set for a multi-
function input. When the zero-
servo command has been
input and the frequency refer-
b9-01 0 to 100 5 No No No No A 1DAH 6-129
Zero Servo ence drops below DC Injec-
Gain tion level (b2-01), a position
control loop is created and the
motor stops. Increasing the
zero-servo gain increases the
strength of the lock but might
cause oscillations.
Zero-Servo Sets the bandwidth of the Zero
completion Servo completion output.
bandwidth Enabled when the “zero-servo
completion (end)” is set for a
multi-function output. The
zero-servo completion signal
0 to
b9-02 is ON when the current posi- 10 No No No No A 1DBH 6-129
16383
Zero Servo tion is within the range (the
Count zero-servo position + zero-
servo completion width.)
Set b9-02 to 4 times of the
allowable displacement pulse
amount at the PG.
5
5-19
Tuning Parameters: C
Acceleration/Deceleration: C1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Acceleration Sets the acceleration time to
4-5
C1-01 time 1 accelerate from 0 Hz to the Yes Q Q Q Q 200H
6-20
Accel Time 1 maximum output frequency.
Deceleration Sets the deceleration time to
4-5
C1-02 time 1 decelerate from the maximum Yes Q Q Q Q 201H
6-20
Decel Time 1 output frequency to 0 Hz.
Acceleration Sets the acceleration time when
C1-03 time 2 the multi-function input “accel/ Yes A A A A 202H 6-20
Accel Time 2 decel time 1” is set to ON.
Deceleration Sets the deceleration time when
C1-04 time 2 the multi-function input “accel/ Yes A A A A 203H 6-20
Decel Time 2 decel time 1” is set to ON.
Acceleration Sets the acceleration time when
C1-05 time 3 the multi-function input “accel/ 0.0 to No A A A A 204H 6-20
Accel Time 3 decel time 2” is set to ON. 6000.0 10.0 s
*1
Deceleration
5
Sets the deceleration time when
C1-06 time 3 the multi-function input “accel/ No A A A A 205H 6-20
Decel Time 3 decel time 2” is set to ON.
Acceleration Sets the acceleration time when
time 4 the multi-function input “accel/
C1-07 No A A A A 206H 6-20
decel time 1” and “accel/decel
Accel Time 4 time 2” are set to ON.
Fast stop
time Sets the deceleration time when
C1-09 the multi-function input “Fast No A A A A 208H 6-20
Fast Stop Stop” is set to ON.
Time
Accel/decel
time setting
0: 0.01-second units
C1-10 unit 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 209H 6-20
1: 0.1-second units
Acc/Dec
Units
Accel/decel Sets the frequency for auto-
time switch- matic acceleration/decelera-
ing fre- tion switching.
quency If the output frequency is
below the set frequency: Accel/ 0.0 to
decel time 4 150.0
C1-11 0.0 Hz No A A A A 20AH 6-20
If the output frequency is above *2
Acc/Dec SW the set frequency: Accel/decel
Freq time 1
The multi-function input
“accel/decel time 1” or “accel/
decel time 2” has priority.
* 1. The setting range for acceleration/deceleration times will depends on the setting for C1-10. When C1-10 is set to 0, the setting range for acceler-
ation/deceleration times becomes 0.00 to 600.00 seconds.
* 2. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting
range will be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz
5-20
S-Curve Acceleration/Deceleration: C2
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
Display Range Setting
ber tion PG Vector Vector
S-curve
character-
istic time 0.00
C2-01 at acceler- to 0.20 s No A A A A 20BH 6-22
ation start 2.50
SCrv Acc
@ Start
S-curve When the S-curve characteristic time
character- is set, the accel/decel times will
istic time increase by only half of the S-curve 0.00
C2-02 at acceler- characteristic times at start and end. to 0.20 s No A A A A 20CH 6-22
ation end 2.50
SCrv Acc Run command
@ End ON
OFF
Output frequency
S-curve
character- C2-02 C2-03
istic time C2-04
at deceler- C2-01
0.00
C2-03 ation start Time to 0.20 s No A A A A 20DH 6-22
Taccel = C2-01 + C1-01 + C2-02 2.50
2 2
SCrv Dec
@ Start Tdecel = C2-03 + C1-02 + C2-04
2 2
S-curve
character-
istic time
5
at deceler- 0.00
C2-04 ation end to 0.00 s No A A A A 20EH 6-22
2.50
SCrv Dec
@ End
5-21
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
5 Output volt-
resistor unit or braking unit.)
* 1. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed (The Open Loop Vecctor control factory settings are given.)
5-22
Torque Compensation: C4
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Sets the torque compensation
gain.
Torque com- Usually changing this setting
pensation is not necessary.
gain Adjust it under the following
circumstances:
• When the cable is long
increase the set value.
• When the motor capacity is
smaller than the Inverter
capacity (Max. applicable
motor capacity), increase 0.00 to 4-14
C4-01 1.00 Yes A A A No 215H
the set values. 2.50 6-38
• When the motor is oscillat-
Torq Comp ing, decrease the set values.
Gain Adjust the torque compensa-
tion gain so that at minimum
speed the output current does
not exceed the Inverter rated
output current.
Do not alter the torque com-
pensation gain from its default
(1.00) when using Open Loop
Vector control.
Torque com-
pensation
delay time
The torque compensation
delay time is set in ms units.
Usually changing this setting
5
constant is not necessary.
Adjust it under the following
0 to 200 ms 4-14
C4-02 circumstances: No A A A No 216H
10000 * 6-38
• When the motor is oscillat-
Torq Comp ing, increase the set values.
Time • When the responsiveness of
the motor is low, decrease
the set values.
Starting
torque com-
pensation Sets the torque compensation
0.0 to
C4-03 (FWD) value at start in FWD direc- 0.0% No No No A No 217H 6-38
200.0%
tion
FTorqCmp
@ Start
Starting
torque com-
pensation
Sets the torque compensation -200.0
C4-04 (REV) 0.0% No No No A No 218H 6-38
value at start in REV direction to 0.0%
RTorqCmp
@ Start
Starting
torque com-
pensation Sets starting torque start-up
time con- time.
C4-05 0 to 200 10 ms No No No A No 219H 6-38
stant When 0 ~ 4 ms is set, it is
operated without filter.
TorqCmp-
DelayT
* The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (V/f control factory settings are given.)
5-23
Speed Control (ASR): C5
Param Name Change Control Methods
Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Display Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Range Setting Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
ASR pro-
portional 0.00 to
Sets the proportional gain of the 20.00
C5-01 (P) gain 1 300.00 *2 Yes No A No A 21BH 6-39
speed loop (ASR) *1
ASR P
Gain 1
ASR inte-
gral (I) 0.000
Sets the integral time of the speed 0.500 s
C5-02 time 1 to Yes No A No A 21CH 6-39
loop (ASR). *2
ASR I 10.000
Time 1
ASR pro-
portional Usually changing this setting is not 0.00 to
20.00
C5-03 (P) gain 2 necessary. 300.00 Yes No A No A 21DH 6-39
*2
ASR P *1
Gain 2 P,I
P = C5-01
I = C5-02
ASR inte-
gral (I) P = C5-03
0.000
I = C5-04 0.500 s
C5-04 time 2 to Yes No A No A 21EH 6-39
0 E1-04 Motor *2
ASR I speed (Hz) 10.000
Time 2
ASR limit
Sets the upper limit for the compen-
5
sation frequency for the speed con- 0.0 to
C5-05 5.0% No No A No No 21FH 6-39
ASR Limit trol loop (ASR) as a percentage of 20.0
the maximum output frequency.
ASR delay
time Sets the filter time constant; the time
0.000
from the speed loop to the torque 0.004
C5-06 ASR to No No No No A 220H 6-39
command output. Usually changing ms
Delay 0.500
this setting is not necessary.
Time
ASR
switching Sets the frequency for switching 0.0 to
C5-07 frequency between Proportion Gain 1, 2 and 150.0 0.0 Hz No No No No A 221H 6-39
Integral Time 1, 2. *3
ASR Gain
SW Freq
ASR inte-
gral (I) Set the parameter to a small value to
prevent any radical load change. A 0 to
C5-08 limit 400% No No No No A 222H 6-39
setting of 100% is equal to the maxi- 400
ASR I mum output frequency.
Limit
* 1. The setting range is 1.00 to 300.00 if Closed Looop Vector control is used.
* 2. When the control method is changed, these values are reset to factory setting for the selectred control mode. (The Closed Loop Vector control
factory settings are given.)
* 3. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-06=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01= 1 or 2) the setting
range will be 0.0 to 400.0Hz.
5-24
Carrier Frequency: C6
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
Display Range Setting
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Heavy/
Normal
Duty selec- 0: Heavy Duty
4-5
C6-01 tion 1: Normal Duty 1 0 to 2 0 No Q Q Q Q 223H
6-2
Heavy/ 2: Normal Duty 2
Normal
Duty
Carrier fre- Selects the carrier frequency.
quency Select F to enable detailed settings
selection using parameters C6-03 to C6-05.
0: Low carrier, low noise
1: 2 kHz 4-5
C6-02 2: 5 kHz 0 to F 1 No Q Q Q Q 224H 4-14
Carrier 3: 8 kHz 6-2
Freq Sel 4: 10 kHz
5: 12.5 kHz
6: 15 kHz
F: User setting
Carrier fre-
quency Sets the carrier frequency upper limit 2.0 to
upper limit and lower limit in kHz units. 15.0 2.0
C6-03 No A A A A 225H 6-2
The carrier frequency gain is set as *1*2 kHz
Carrier follows:
Freq Max In the Open Loop and Closed Loop
Carrier fre- Vector control, the upper limit of the
quency carrier frequency is fixed with C6- 0.4 to
5
2.0
C6-04 lower limit 03. 15.0 No A A No No 226H 6-2
kHz
Carrier *1 *2
Freq Gain Carrier frequency
Carrier fre-
quency
propor-
tional gain Output frequency x (C6-05) x
Output
frequency
(Max. output frequency) 00 to
C6-05 99 00 No A A No No 227H 6-2
K is a coefficient that depends on the *2
Carrier setting of C6-03.
Freq Sel C6-03 ≥ 10.0 kHz: K = 3
10.0 kHz > C6-03 ≥ 5.0 kHz: K = 2
5.0 kHz > C6-03: K = 1
5-25
Reference Parameters: d
Preset Reference: d1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Frequency
reference 1 4-5
d1-01 Sets the frequency reference. 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 280H
6-10
Reference 1
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 2 when multi-step speed com- 4-5
d1-02 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 281H
mand 1 is ON for a multi- 6-10
Reference 2 function input.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 3 when multi-step speed com- 4-5
d1-03 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 282H
mand 2 is ON for a multi- 6-10
Reference 3 function input.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 4 when multi-step speed com- 4-5
d1-04 0.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q 283H
mands 1 and 2 are ON for 6-10
Reference 4 multi-function inputs.
Frequency Sets the frequency when
reference 5 multi-step speed command 3
d1-05 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 284H 6-10
is ON for a multi-function
5 Reference 5
Frequency
input.
Sets the frequency reference
0 to
reference 6 when multi-step speed com-
d1-06 FMAX 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 285H 6-10
mands 1 and 3 are ON for
Reference 6 (E1-04)
multi-function inputs.
*1*2
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 7 when multi-step speed com-
d1-07 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 286H 6-10
mands 2 and 3 are ON for
Reference 7 multi-function inputs.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 8 when multi-step speed com-
d1-08 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 287H 6-10
mands 1, 2, and 3 are ON for
Reference 8 multi-function inputs.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 9 when multi-step speed com-
d1-09 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 288H 6-10
mand 4 is ON for a multi-
Reference 9 function input.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 10 when multi-step speed com-
d1-10 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 28BH 6-10
Reference mands 1 and 4 are ON for
10 multi-function inputs.
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 11 when multi-step speed com-
d1-11 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 28CH 6-10
mands 2 and 4 are ON for a
Reference 11 multi-function inputs.
5-26
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Frequency Sets the frequency reference
reference 12 when multi-step speed com-
d1-12 0.00 Hz Yes A A A A 28DH 6-10
Reference mands 1, 2, and 4 are ON for
12 multi-function inputs.
Reference Limits: d2
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Frequency
reference Sets the frequency reference
upper limit 0.0 to 6-32
d2-01 upper limit as a percentage of 100.0% No A A A A 289H
110.0 6-71
Ref Upper the max. output frequency.
Limit
Frequency
reference Sets the frequency reference
lower limit lower limit as a percentage of 0.0 to 6-32
d2-02 0.0% No A A A A 28AH
the maximum output fre- 110.0 6-71
Ref Lower quency.
Limit
Master
speed refer- Sets the master speed refer-
ence lower ence lower limit as a percent- 0.0 to 6-32
d2-03 limit 0.0% No A A A A 293H
age of the max. output 110.0 6-71
Ref1 Lower frequency.
Limit
5-27
Jump Frequencies: d3
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Jump fre- Set the center values of the
d3-01 quency 1 jump frequencies in Hz. 0.0 Hz No A A A A 294H 6-29
This function is disabled when
Jump Freq 1
the jump frequency is set to 0
Jump fre- Hz. Always ensure that the
quency 2 0.0 to
d3-02 following applies: 0.0 Hz No A A A A 295H 6-29
150.0
Jump Freq 2 d3-01 ≥ d3-02 ≥ d3-03
*
Operation in the jump fre-
Jump fre-
quency range is prohibited but
quency 3
d3-03 during acceleration and decel- 0.0 Hz No A A A A 296H 6-29
eration, the speed changes
Jump Freq 3
smoothly without jumping
Jump fre- Sets the jump frequency band-
quency width in Hz.
width 0.0 to
d3-04 The jump frequency range 1.0 Hz No A A A A 297H 6-29
20.0
Jump will be the jump frequency ±
Bandwidth d3-04.
* The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will
be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz
5 Param-
eter
Num-
Name
Display
Description
Setting
Range
Factory
Setting
Change
during
Opera- V/f
Control Methods
V/f
with
Open Closed
Loop Loop
MEMO-
BUS
Register
Page
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Frequency Sets whether the frequency
reference reference value on hold or
hold func- power loss will be recorded or
tion selec- not.
tion 0: Disabled (when operation
is stopped or the power is
turned on again the fre-
quency reference is set to
0.)
d4-01 1: Enabled (when operation 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 298H 6-70
is stopped or the power is
MOP Ref turned on again the
Memory inverter starts at the
previous hold frequency.)
This function is available
when the multi-function
inputs “Accel/Decel Ramp
Hold” or “Up/Down” com-
mands are set.
5-28
Torque Control: d5
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Torque con- 0: Speed control (C5-01 to
trol selection C5-07)
1: Torque control
2: Torque control 2
This function is available in
Closed Loop Vector control
mode only. To use the function
d5-01 for switching between speed 0 or 2 0 No No No No A 29AH 6-121
Torq Con- and torque control, set d5-01
trol Sel to 0 and set the multi-function
input to “speed/torque control
change.”
When set to 2 and d5-03=2,
analogue input A1 becomes
the torque compensation
Torque ref- Sets the torque reference delay
erence delay time.
time It can be used to prevent oscil-
lations caused by signal noise
0 to
d5-02 or to increase or decrease the 0 ms No No No No A 29BH 6-121
1000
Torq Ref Fil- responsiveness.
ter When oscillation occurs dur-
ing torque control, increase
the set value.
Speed limit
selection
Sets the speed limit reference
source for the torque control 5
mode.
d5-03 1: The analog input limit 1 or 2 1 No No No No A 29CH 6-121
Speed Limit from a frequency reference
Sel 2: Limited by d5-04 parame-
ter setting values.
Sets the speed limit during
Speed limit torque control as a percentage
of the maximum output fre-
quency.
This function is enabled when -120 to
d5-04 0% No No No No A 29DH 6-121
d5-03 is set to 2. Directions +120
Speed Lmt
are as follows.
Value
+: run command direction
-: run command opposite
direction
5-29
Field Weakening: d6
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Field weak- Sets the inverter output volt-
ening level age when the field weakening
command is input at a digital
d6-01 input. 0 to 100 80% No A A No No 2A0H 6-110
Field-Weak Sets the voltage level as a per-
Lvl centage taking the voltage set
by the V/f pattern as 100%.
Field weak- Sets the lower limit of the fre-
ening fre- quency range where field con-
quency limit trol is valid.
The field weakening com- 0.0 to
d6-02 mand is accepted only at fre- 150.0 0.0 Hz No A A No No 2A1H 6-110
Field-Weak quencies above this setting *
Freq and only when the speed is in
agreement with the current
speed reference.
Field forc-
ing function Enables or disables field forc-
selection ing function.
d6-03 0 or 1 0 No No No No A 2A2H 6-111
0: Disabled
Field Force 1: Enabled
Sel
5
ing function excitation current applied by
Limit the field forcing function.
A setting of 100% is equal to 100 to
d6-06 400% No No No A A 2A5H 6-111
the motor no-load current. 400
FieldForce Field forcing is active during
Limit all types of operation except
DC Injection.
* The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will
be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz
5-30
Motor Parameters: E
V/f Pattern: E1
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
Display Range Setting
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Input volt-
Sets the Inverter input voltage. 155 to
age setting 200 V 4-5
E1-01 This setting is used as a reference 255 No Q Q Q Q 300H
Input *1 *1 6-113
value for protection functions.
Voltage
V/f pattern 0 to E: Select from the 15 preset
selection patterns.
E1-03 F: Custom user-set pattern 0 to F F No Q Q No No 302H 6-113
V/f (Applicable for setting of E1-04
Selection to E1-10.)
Max. out-
put fre-
40.0 to
quency 50.0
E1-04 (FMAX) 150.0 No Q Q Q Q 303H 6-113
*2 Hz
Max Fre-
quency
Max. out-
put volt-
age 0.0 to 200.0
E1-05 (VMAX)
Max Volt-
255.0
*1
V
*1
No Q Q Q Q 304H 6-113
5
age
Base fre-
quency 0.0 to
Output Voltage (V) 50.0
E1-06 (FA) 150.0 No Q Q Q Q 305H 6-113
Hz
Base Fre- *2
quency
Mid. out-
put fre-
quency 0.0 to 2.5 Hz
E1-07 (FB) 150.0 *3 No A A A No 306H 6-113
*2
Mid Fre-
quency A Frequency (Hz)
To set V/f characteristics in a straight
Mid. out-
line, set the same values for E1-07
put fre-
and E1-09. In this case, the setting
quency 0.0 to
for E1-08 will be disregarded. 15.0 V 4-14
E1-08 voltage Always ensure that the four frequen- 255 No A A A No 307H
(VB) *1 *3 6-113
cies are set in the following manner: *1
Mid Volt- E1-04 (FMAX) ≥ E1-06 (FA) > E1-
age A 07 (FB) ≥ E1-09 (FMIN)
Min. out-
put fre-
quency 0.0 to
1.2 Hz
E1-09 (FMIN) 150.0 No Q Q Q A 308H 6-113
*3
*2
Min Fre-
quency
Min. out-
put fre-
quency 0.0 to
9.0 V 4-14
E1-10 voltage 255.0 No A A A No 309H
(VMIN) *1 *3 6-113
*1
Min Volt-
age
5-31
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
Display Range Setting
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Mid. out-
put fre- 0.0 to 0.0 Hz
E1-11 quency 2 150.0 *4 No A A A A 30AH 6-113
Mid Fre- *2
quency B Set only to fine-adjust V/f for the
output range. Normally, this setting
Mid. out- is not required.
put fre- E1-11 must be set higher than E1-04.
quency 0.0 to
0.0 V
E1-12 voltage 2 255.0 No A A A A 30BH 6-113
*4
*1
Mid Volt-
age B
Base volt-
age 0.0 to
Sets the output voltage of the base 0.0 V
E1-13 (VBASE) 255.0 No A A Q Q 30CH 6-113
frequency (E1-06).
*1 *4 * 5
Base Volt-
age
* 1. The values are for a 200 V class Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 2. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting
range will be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
* 3. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (V/f control factory settings are given.)
* 4. E1-11 and E1-12 are disregarded when set to 0.0.
* 5. E1-13 is set to the same value as E1-05 after autotuning.
Motor Setup: E2
5 Param-
eter
Name
Setting Factory
Change
during
Control Methods
MEMO-
Description V/f Open Closed BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Sets the motor rated current.
Motor rated
current This set value will become the 0.32 to
reference value for motor pro- 1.90 A 6-51
E2-01 6.40 *2 No Q Q Q Q 30EH
Motor Rated tection and torque limits. *1 6-111
FLA This parameter is an input data
for autotuning.
Sets the motor rated slip.
Motor rated
slip This set value will become the
reference value for the slip 0.00 to 2.90 Hz
E2-02 No A A A A 30FH 6-111
Motor Rated compensation. 20.00 *2
Slip This parameter is automati-
cally set during autotuning.
Motor no- Sets the motor no-load cur- 0.00 to
load current rent. 1.20 A
E2-03 1.89 No A A A A 310H 6-111
No-Load This parameter is automati- *3 *2
Current cally set during autotuning.
Motor line-
to-line resis- Sets the motor phase-to-phase 0.000
resistance. 9.842 Ω
E2-05 tance to No A A A A 312H 6-111
This parameter is automati- *2
Term Resis- cally set during autotuning. 65.000
tance
Motor leak Sets the voltage drop due to
inductance motor leakage inductance as a
percentage of the motor rated 0.0 to 18.2%
E2-06 No No No A A 313H 6-111
Leak Induc- voltage. 40.0 *2
tance This parameter is automati-
cally set during autotuning.
5-32
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor iron Sets the motor iron saturation
saturation coefficient at 50% of magnetic
coefficient 1 flux. 0.00 to
E2-07 0.50 No No No A A 314H 6-111
This parameter is automati- 0.50
Saturation cally set during rotating auto-
Comp1 tuning.
Motor iron Sets the motor iron saturation
saturation coefficient at 75% of magnetic
coefficient 2 flux. 0.50 to
E2-08 0.75 No No No A A 315H 6-111
This parameter is automati- 0.75
Saturation cally set during rotating auto-
Comp2 tuning.
Motor Sets the motor mechanical
mechanical losses as a percentage of
losses motor rated output.
Usually changing this setting
is not necessary.
0.0 to
E2-09 Adjust the value under the fol- 0.0% No No No No A 316H 6-111
10.0
Mechanical lowing the torque loss is large
loss due e.g. to heavy friction in
the machine.
The set mechanical loss will
be compensated.
Motor iron
loss for
torque com-
E2-10 pensation Sets motor iron losses.
0 to
65535
14 W
*2
No A A No No 317H 6-111 5
Tcomp Iron
Loss
Motor rated
output Sets the rated output power of
0.40
power the motor. 0.00 to
E2-11 kW No Q Q Q Q 318H 6-111
This parameter is an input data 650.00
Mtr Rated *2
for autotuning.
Power
* 1. The setting range is 10% to 200% of the Inverter rated output current. The value for a 200 V class inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
* 2. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V class inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
* 3. The setting range is 0.00A to (E2-01 - 0.01A).
5-33
Motor 2 V/f Pattern: E3
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Range Setting Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor 2
control 0:V/f control
method 1:V/f control with PG
E3-01 selection 0 to 3 0 No A A A A 319H 6-120
2: Open Loop Vector control
Control 3: Closed Loop Vector Control
Method
Motor 2
max. output
40.0 to
frequency 50.0
E3-02 (FMAX) 150.0 No A A A A 31AH 6-120
*1 Hz
Max
Frequency
Motor 2
max. output
0.0 to 200.0
voltage
E3-03 (VMAX) 255.0 V No A A A A 31BH 6-120
*2 *2
Max
Voltage
Motor 2
max. volt- Output voltage (V)
age fre- 0.0 to
50.0
E3-04 quency (FA) 150.0 No A A A A 31CH 6-120
Hz
5
*1
Base
Frequency
Motor 2
mid. output
frequency 1 0.0 to 2.5 Hz
E3-05 (FB) 150.0 *3 No A A A No 31DH 6-120
Frequency (Hz)
*1
Mid
Frequency
Motor 2 To set V/f characteristics in a straight
mid. output line, set the same values for E3-05
frequency and E3-07.
0.0 to
In this case, the setting for E3-06 will 15.0 V
E3-06 voltage 1 255.0 No A A A No 31EH 6-120
(VB) be disregarded. *2 *3
*2
Always ensure that the four frequen-
Mid cies are set in the following manner:
Voltage E3-02 (FMAX) ≥ E3-04 (FA) > E3-
Motor 2 05 (FB) > E3-07 (FMIN)
min. output
frequency 0.0 to
1.2 Hz
E3-07 (FMIN) 150.0 No A A A A 31FH 6-120
*3
*1
Min
Frequency
Motor 2
min. output
frequency 0.0 to
9.0 V
E3-08 voltage 255.0 No A A A No 320H 6-120
(VMIN) *2 *3
*2
Min
Voltage
* 1. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range
will be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz
* 2. These are values for a 200 Vclass Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 3. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (V/f control factory settings are given.)
5-34
Motor 2 Setup: E4
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor 2 Sets the motor rated current.
rated current This set value will become a 0.32
reference value for motor pro- 1.90 A 6-51
E4-01 to 6.40 *2 No A A A A 321H
Motor Rated tection and torque limits. *1 6-120
FLA This parameter is an input data
for autotuning.
Motor 2 Sets the motor rated slip.
This set value will become a
rated slip
reference value for slip com- 0.00 to 2.90 Hz
E4-02 No A A A A 322H 6-120
Motor Rated pensation. 20.00 *2
Slip This parameter is automati-
cally set during autotuning.
Motor 2 no- Sets the motor no-load cur- 0.00 to
load current rent. 1.20 A
E4-03 1.89 No A A A A 323H 6-120
No-Load This parameter is automati- *3 *2
Current cally set during autotuning.
Motor 2
number of Sets the number of motor
poles (num- poles.
E4-04 ber of poles) 2 to 48 4 poles No No A No A 324H 6-120
This value is an input data for
Number of autotuning.
Poles
Motor 2
line-to-line
E4-05 resistance
Sets the motor phase-to-phase
resistance in Ω units.
0.000
to
9.842 Ω
No A A A A 325H 6-120
5
This parameter is automati- *2
Mid 65.000
cally set during autotuning.
Frequency
Motor 2 leak Sets the voltage drop due to
inductance motor leakage inductance as a
percentage of the motor rated 0.0 to 18.2%
E4-06 No No No A A 326H 6-120
Leak Induc- voltage. 40.0 *2
tance This parameter is automati-
cally set during autotuning.
Motor 2
rated capac- Sets the rated output of the
motor in units of 0.01 kW. 0.40 to 0.40
E4-07 ity No A A A A 327H 6-120
This parameter is an input data 650.00 *2
Mtr Rated for autotuning.
Power
* 1. The setting range is 10% to 200% of the Inverter’s rated output current. The value for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
* 2. The factory setting depends oon the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
* 3. The setting range is 0.00A to (E2-01 - 0.01A).
5-35
Option Parameters: F
PG Option Setup: F1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
PG constant
Sets the number of PG pulses 0 to
F1-01 PG Pulses/ 1024 No No Q Q Q 380H 6-146
per revolution 60000
Rev
Operation Sets the PG disconnection
selection at stopping method.
PG open cir- 0: Ramp to stop
cuit (PGO) (Deceleration to stop using
the deceleration time 1,
C1-02.)
1: Coast to stop
F1-02 0 to 3 1 No No A No A 381H 6-146
2: Fast stop (using the
PG Fdbk deceleration time in C1-
Loss Sel 09.)
3: Continue operation (To
protect the motor or
machinery, avoid to use
this setting.)
Operation Sets the stopping method
5
selection at when an overspeed (OS) fault
overspeed occurs.
(OS) 0: Ramp to stop
(Deceleration to stop using
the deceleration time 1,
C1-02.)
F1-03 1: Coast to stop 0 to 3 1 No No A No A 382H 6-146
2: Fast stop (using the
PG Over- deceleration time in C1-
speed Sel 09.)
3: Continue operation (To
protect the motor or
machinery, avoid to use
this setting.)
Operation Sets the stopping method
selection at when a speed deviation (DEV)
deviation fault occurs.
0: Ramp to stop
(Deceleration to stop using
the deceleration time 1,
C1-02.)
F1-04 0 to 3 3 No No A No A 383H 6-146
PG 1: Coast to stop
Deviation 2: Fast stop (using the
Sel deceleration time in C1-
09.)
3: Continue operation (DEV
is displayed and operation
continued.)
PG rotation 0: Phase A leads with
forward run command.
(Phase B leads with
reverse run command,
C.C.W.)
F1-05 PG Rotation 0 or 1 0 No No A A A 384H 6-146
1: Phase B leads with
Sel forward run command.
(Phase A leads with
reverse run command,
C.W.)
5-36
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
PG division Sets the division ratio for the
rate (PG PG speed control card pulse
pulse moni- output.
tor) Division ratio = (1+ n) /m
(n=0 or 1 m=1 to 32)
The first digit of the value of
F1-06 F1-06 stands for n, the second 1 to 132 1 No No A A A 385H 6-146
and the third stands for m.
PG Output This parameter is effective
Ratio only when a PG-B2 is used.
The possible division ratio set-
tings are: 1/32 ≤ F1-06
≤ 1.
Integral Enables or disables integral
value during control during acceleration/
accel/decel deceleration.
enable/dis- 0: Disabled (The integral
able function isn't used while
F1-07 0 or 1 0 No No A No No 386H 6-146
acceleration or
deceleration; it is used at
PG Ramp constant speeds only.)
PI/I Sel 1: Enabled (The integral
function is always used.)
Overspeed
detection
Sets the overspeed detection
5
F1-08 level 0 to 120 115% No No A No A 387H 6-146
method.
PG Overspd Motor speeds that continue to
Level exceed the value set in F1-08
Overspeed (set as a percentage of the
detection maximum output frequency)
delay time for the time set in F1-09 are 0.0 to
F1-09 0.0 s No No A No A 388H 6-146
detected as overspeed faults. 2.0
PG Overspd
Time
Excessive
speed devia- Sets the speed deviation detec-
tion detec- tion method.
F1-10 tion level 0 to 50 10% No No A No A 389H 6-146
Any speed deviation above the
PG Deviate F1-10 set level (set as a per-
Level centage of the maximum out-
put frequency) that continues
Excessive for the time set in F1-11 is
speed devia- detected as a speed deviation.
tion detec- The speed deviation is the dif-
tion delay 0.0 to
F1-11 ference between actual motor 0.5 s No No A No A 38AH 6-146
time 10.0
speed and the speed reference
PG Deviate command.
Time
Number of
PG gear Sets the number of teeth on
F1-12 teeth 1 the gears if there are gears 0 No No A No No 38BH 6-146
PG # Gear between the PG and the motor.
Teeth 1 PG Input Pulses x 60 x F1-13 0 to
F1-01 F1-12 1000
Number of
PG gear A gear ratio of 1 will be used
F1-13 teeth 2 if one of these parameters is 0 No No A No No 38CH 6-146
PG # Gear set to 0.
Teeth 1
5-37
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
PG open-cir-
cuit detec- Used to set the PG disconnec-
tion delay tion detection time. PGO will 0.0 to
F1-14 time 2.0 s No No A No A 38DH 6-146
be detected if the detection 10.0
PGO Detect time exceeds the set time.
Time
5 AI-14 Input
1: 3-channel addition (Addi-
tion values are the fre-
quency reference)
Sel When b1-01 is set to 1 and
F2-01 is set to 0, the multi-
function digital input function
“Option/Inverter selection” can
not be used.
5-38
Digital Reference Card: F3
Name Control Methods
Param- Change MEMO
eter Setting Factory during Open
Description V/f Closed BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- Loop
Display V/f with Loop Regis-
ber tion Vector ter
PG Vector
1
Sets the Digital Reference
Card input method.
0: BCD 1% unit
Digital input 1: BCD 0.1% unit
option 2: BCD 0.01% unit
3: BCD 1 Hz unit
4: BCD 0.1 Hz unit
5: BCD 0.01 Hz unit
F3-01 6: BCD special setting (5- 0 to 7 0 No A A A A 390H 6-149
digit input)
7: Binary input
6 is effective only, when the
DI Input DI-16H2 is used.
When o1-03 is set to 2 or
higher, the input will be BCD,
and the units will change to the
o1-03 setting.
5
Number V/f with Loop Loop
tion PG Vector Vector ter
Channel 1 This function is enabled when
F4-01 Monitor the analog monitor card is 1 to 38 2 No A A A A 391H -
Selection used.
Channel 1 0.0 to
F4-02 Monitor selection: Sets the 100.0% Yes A A A A 392H -
Gain 100.0
number of the monitor item to
Channel 2 be output. (Numerical portion
F4-03 Monitor of U1- ) 1 to 38 3 No A A A A 393H -
Selection 4, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 25, 28,
Channel 2 35, 39 and 40 cannot be set. 0.0 to
F4-04 50.0% Yes A A A A 394H -
Gain 100.0
Gain: Sets the percentage of
the monitor item, which is –110.0
CH1 Output
F4-05 to 0.0% Yes A A A A 395H -
Bias equal to 10V output.
110.0
Bias: Sets the percentage of
–110.0
CH2 Output the monitor item, which is
F4-06 to 0.0% Yes A A A A 396H -
Bias equal to 0V output.
110.0
0: 0 to 10V
1: -10 to +10
Analog Out-
F4-08 put Signal Using an AO-08 option card 0, 1 0 No A A A A 398H -
Level CH2 the possible outputs signal is 0
to +10V only. The setting of
F4-07 and F4-08 has no
effect.
5-39
Digital Output Option Card Setup: F5
Param- Change Control Methods MEMO
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed BUS
Name Description Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Regis-
ber tion PG Vector Vector ter
Selects the desired multi-function
Channel 1 output for channel 1.
F5-01 Output This function is enabled when a 0 to 3D 0 No A A A A 399H -
Selection digital output card (DO-02 or
DO-08) is used.
Selects the desired multi-function
Channel 2 output for channel 2.
F5-02 Output This function is enabled when a 0 to 3D 1 No A A A A 39AH -
Selection digital output card (DO-02 or
DO-08) is used.
Selects the desired multi-function
Channel 3 output for channel 3.
F5-03 Output This function is enabled when a 0 to 3D 2 No A A A A 39BH -
Selection digital output card (DO-02 or
DO-08) is used.
Selects the desired multi-function
Channel 4 output for channel 4.
F5-04 Output This function is enabled when a 0 to 3D 4 No A A A A 39CH -
Selection digital output card (DO-02 or
DO-08) is used.
Selects the desired multi-function
Channel 5 output for channel 5.
F5-05 Output This function is enabled when a 0 to 3D 6 No A A A A 39DH -
5-40
Serial Communications Settings: F6
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Operation Sets the stopping method for
selection communications faults.
after com- 0: Deceleration to stop using
munications the deceleration time in
F6-01 fault C1-02 0 to 3 1 No A A A A 3A2H -
1: Coast to stop
Comm Bus 2: Fast stop using the
Flt Sel deceleration time in C1-09
3: Continue operation
Input level
of external
fault from
Communica- 0: Always detect
F6-02 tions Option 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 3A3H -
1: Detect during operation
Card
EF0 Fault
Detection
Stopping
method for 0: Deceleration to stop using
external the deceleration time in
fault from C1-02
F6-03 Communica- 1: Coast to stop 0 to 3 1 No A A A A 3A4H -
tions Option 2: Fast stop using the
5
Card deceleration time in C1-09
EF0 Fault 3: Continue operation
Action
Trace sam-
pling from
Communica-
tions Option 0 to
F6-04 - 0 No A A A A 3A5H -
Card 60000
Trace Sam-
ple Tim
Current
monitor unit Sets the unit of current moni-
selection tor
F6-05 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 3A6H -
0: Ampere
Current Unit 1: 100%/8192
Sel
Torque ref-
erence/
torque limit 0: Torque reference/torque
selection limit by communications
from com- option disabled.
F6-06 0 or 1 0 No No No No A 3A7H -
munications 1: Torque reference/torque
option card limit by communications
option enabled.
Torque Ref/
Lmt Sel
Operation Sets the stopping method for
selection SI-T WDT errors (E5)
after SI-T 0: Deceleration to stop using
WDT error the deceleration time in
F6-08 C1-02 0 to 3 1 No A A A A 3B6H -
1: Coast to stop
SI-T 2: Fast stop using the decel-
WDTErr Sel ration time in C1-09
3: Continue operation
5-41
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Number of
SI-T BUS Sets the number of detected
error detec- communication errors before
F6-09 tion 2 to 10 2 No A A A A 3B7H -
the BUS fault is actually
SI-T BUS detected.
DET Ctr
5-42
Terminal Function Parameters: H
* 1. The values in parentheses indicate initial values when initialized in 3-wire sequence.
5-43
Control Methods
Setting V/f Open Closed
Function Page
Value V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
V/f control with/without PG (ON: Speed feedback control disabled,) (normal V/f
D No Yes No No 6-40
control)
E Speed control (ASR) integral disable (ON: Integral control disabled) No Yes No Yes 6-40
F Not used (Set when a terminal is not used) - - - -
10 UP command (Always set with the Down command) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-71
11 DOWN command (Always set with the Up command) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-71
12 FJOG command (ON: Forward run at jog frequency d1-17) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-75
13 RJOG command (ON: Reverse run at jog frequency d1-17) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-75
14 Fault reset (Reset when turned ON) Yes Yes Yes Yes 7-2
15 Fast stop. (NO: Deceleration to stop in deceleration time set in C1-09 when ON.) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-19
16 Motor switch command (Motor 2 selection) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-119
17 Fast stop (NC: Deceleration to stop in deceleration time set in C1-09 when OFF) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-19
Timer function input (Functions are set in b4-01 and b4-02 and the timer function
18 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-98
outputs are set in H2- .)
19 PID control disable (ON: PID control disabled) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-99
1A Accel/Decel time 2 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-21
Parameters write enable (ON: All parameters can be written-in. OFF: All parame-
1B Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-144
ters are write protected.)
Trim control increase (ON: d4-02 frequency is added to analog frequency refer-
1C Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-74
ence.)
5 1D
Trim control decrease (ON: d4-02 frequency is subtracted from analog frequency
reference.)
Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-74
5-44
Control Methods
Setting V/f Open Closed
Function Page
Value V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
Follower Disable (ON: Follower mode is disabled and the drive will follow the nor-
90 mal frequency reference (based on b1-01 setting) and use the normal accel/decel Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-134
times.
91 MOP Adjust Increase (ON: The MOP ratio adjustment is increased) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-134
92 MOP Adjust Decrease (ON: The MOP ratio adjustment is decreased) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-134
93 MOP Adjust Reset (ON: The MOP ratio adjustment is reset to 0) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-134
5-45
Control Methods
Setting V/f Open Closed
Function Page
Value V/f with loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
D Braking resistor fault (ON: Resistor overheat or braking transistor fault) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-63
Fault (ON: Digital Operator communications fault or fault other than CPF00 and
E Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-78
CPF01 has occurred.)
F Not used. (Set when the terminal is not used.) Yes Yes Yes Yes -
10 Alarm (ON: Alarm displayed) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-78
11 Fault reset command active Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-78
12 Timer function output Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-98
13 fref = fout agree 2 (detection width L4-04 is used) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-33
fout = fset agree 2 (ON: Output frequency = L4-03, with detection width L4-04 is
14 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-33
used, and during frequency agree)
Frequency detection 3 (ON: Output frequency ≤ -L4-03, detection width L4-04 is
15 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-33
used)
Frequency detection 4 (ON: Output frequency ≥ -L4-03, detection width L4-04 is
16 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-33
used)
17 Overtorque/undertorque detection 1 NC (NC Contact, OFF: Torque detection) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-49
18 Overtorque/undertorque detection 2 NO (NO Contact, ON: Torque detection) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-49
19 Overtorque/undertorque detection 2 NC (NC Contact, OFF: Torque detection) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-49
1A During reverse run (ON: During reverse run) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-78
1B During baseblock 2 (OFF: During baseblock) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-78
1C Motor selection (ON: Motor 2 selected) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-79
5 1D
1E
During regenerative operation
Restart enabled (ON: Restart enabled)
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
6-79
6-61
During motor overload (OL1, including OH3) pre-alarm (ON: 90% or more of the
1F Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-52
detection level)
20 Inverter overheat (OH) pre-alarm (ON: Temperature exceeds L8-02 setting) Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-64
30 During torque limit (current limit) (ON: During torque limit) No No Yes Yes 6-121
31 During speed limit No No No Yes 6-121
Activated if the speed control circuit (ASR) is operating for torque control. The
32 No No No Yes 6-121
ASR output becomes the torque reference. The motor is rotating at the speed limit.
33 Zero-servo end (ON: Zero-Servo completed) No No No Yes 6-129
Frequency (FOUT) detection 5 (like Frequency Detection 2, but OFF during base-
36 block; ON: Output Frequency ≥ +L4-01 or Output Frequency < -L4-01, L4-02 is Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-33
used)
During run 2 (ON: Frequency output, OFF: Baseblock, DC injection braking, initial
37 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-77
excitation, operation stop)
38 Drive enabled Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-79
3D Inverter’s Cooling Fan Fault detected Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-62
5-46
Analog Inputs: H3
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Multi-func-
tion analog
input termi- Sets the analog input A1 sig-
nal A1 sig- nal level.
H3-01 nal level 0: 0 to +10V (11 bit) 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 410H 6-27
selection 1: –10V to +10V (11 bit plus
sign)
Term A1
Signal
Gain (termi-
Sets the frequency as a per-
nal A1) centage of the maximum out- 0.0 to
H3-02 100.0% Yes A A A A 411H 6-27
Terminal A1 put frequency, when 10 V is 1000.0
Gain input.
Bias (termi-
nal A1) Sets the frequency as a per- -100.0
H3-03 centage of the maximum fre- to 0.0% Yes A A A A 412H 6-27
Terminal A1 quency, when 0 V is input. +100.0
Bias
Signal level
selction (AI- Sets the signal level of AI-
H3-04 14B, chan- 14B, channel 3.
*1 nel 3) 0: 0 to +10V (11 bit) 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 413H 6-27
1: –10V to +10V (11 bit plus
Term A3 sign)
Signal
Multi-func-
tion analog
5
input (AI- Selects the multi-function ana-
H3-05 14B, chan- log input function for AI-14B,
nel 3) func- 0 to 21 1F No A A A A 414H 6-27
*1 channel 3. Refer to the table
tion below.
selection
Term A3 Sel
Gain (AI- Sets the input level when AI-
14B, chan- 14B, channel input is 10 V
H3-06 nel 3) 0.0 to
according to the 100% value 100.0% Yes A A A A 415H 6-27
*1 1000.0
Terminal A3 of the function set in parame-
Gain ter H3-05.
Bias (AI- Sets the input level when AI-
14B, chan- 14B, channel 3 is 0 V accord- -100.0
H3-07 nel 3)
ing to the 100% value of the to 0.0% Yes A A A A 416H 6-27
*1
Terminal A3 function set in parameter H3- 100.0
Bias 05.
5-47
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Gain (termi-
Sets the input level when ter-
nal A2)minal A2 input is 10 V (20
0.0 to
H3-10 mA) according to the 100% 100.0% Yes A A A A 419H 6-27
1000.0
Terminal A2 value of the function set in
Gain parameter H3-09.
Bias (termi-
Sets the input level when ter-
nal A2)minal A2 is 0 V (4 mA) -100.0
H3-11 according to the 100% value to 0.0% Yes A A A A 41AH 6-27
Terminal A2 of the function set in parame- +100.0
Bias ter H3-09.
Analog input
filter time Sets primary delay filter time
constant constant for the two analog 0.00 to 0.03
H3-12 No A A A A 41BH 6-27
input terminals (A1 and A2). 2.00 s
Filter Avg Effective for noise control etc.
Time
Terminal 0: Use terminal A1 analog
A1/A2 input as main frequency
switching reference.
1: Use terminal A2 analog
input as main frequency
H3-13 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 41CH 6-8
reference.
TA1/TA2 Terminal A1 becomes
Select multi functional. Its func-
5
tion can be selected in
parameter H3-09.
* 1. This parameter is only visible when the AI-14B (Analogue Input) option card is connected and F2-01=0.
H3-09 Settings
Control Methods
Setting Open
Function Contents (100%) V/f Closed Page
Value Loop
V/f with Loop
Vec-
PG Vector
tor
0 Frequency bias Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-29
Frequency reference (voltage) command
1 Frequency gain Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-28
value
Auxiliary frequency reference (is
2 Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-7
used as frequency reference 2)
4 Voltage bias Motor rated voltage (E1-05) Yes Yes No No -
Set acceleration and deceleration times (C1-
5 Accel/decel time gain Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-22
01 to C1-08)
6 DC injection braking current Inverter rated output current Yes Yes Yes No 6-18
Overtorque/undertorque detection Motor rated torque for vector control
7 Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-51
level Inverter rated output current for V/f control
8 Stall prevention level during run Inverter rated output current Yes Yes No No 6-48
9 Frequency reference lower limit level Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-32
A Jump frequency Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-30
B PID feedback Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-99
C PID target value Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-99
D Frequency bias 2 Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-29
E Motor temperature input – Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-53
10 Positive torque limit Motor's rated torque No No Yes Yes 6-46
11 Negative torque limit Motor's rated torque No No Yes Yes 6-46
12 Regenerative torque limit Motor's rated torque No No Yes Yes 6-46
5-48
Control Methods
Setting Open
Function Contents (100%) V/f Closed Page
Value Loop
V/f with Loop
Vec-
PG Vector
tor
Torque reference/torque limit at
13 Motor’s rated torque No No No Yes 6-121
speed control
14 Torque compensation Motor’s rated torque No No No Yes 6-121
15 Positive/negative torque limit Motor's rated torque No No Yes Yes 6-46
1E Analog Ratio Adjustment 10V = 100.00% Yes Yes Yes Yes 6-134
1F Analog input not used. – Yes Yes Yes Yes –
5
Sets the percentage of the
0 to
monitor item that is equal to 4-5
H4-02 1000.0 100.0% Yes Q Q Q Q 41EH
10V/20mA output at terminal 6-80
Terminal %
FM. Note that the maximum
FM Gain
output voltage/current is 10V/
20mA.
Bias (termi- Sets the multi-function analog
nal FM) output 1 (terminal FM) bias.
Sets the percentage of the -110.0
monitor item that is equal to to
H4-03 0.0% Yes A A A A 41FH 6-80
Terminal 0V/4mA output at terminal +110.0
FM Bias FM. %
The maximum output from the
terminal is 10 V/20mA.
Monitor Sets the number of the moni-
selection tor item to be output (U1-
(terminal ) at terminal AM.
H4-04 AM) The monitors U1-04, -10 to 1 to 88 3 No A A A A 420H 6-80
-14, -28, -34, -39, -40 cannot
Terminal be set to be output at terminal
AM Sel AM).
5-49
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Analog out- Sets the signal output level for
put 1 signal multi-function output 1 (ter-
level selec- minal FM)
tion 0: 0 to +10 V output
H4-07 1: –10V to +10V output 0 to 2 0 No A A A A 423H 6-80
2: 4 – 20 mA
AO Level Switch current and voltage
Select1 output using CN15 on the
control panel
Analog out- Sets the signal output level for
put 2 signal multi-function output 2 (ter-
level selec- minal AM)
tion 0: 0 to +10 V output
H4-08 1: –10V to +10V output 0 to 2 0 No A A A A 424H 6-80
2: 4 – 20 mA
AO Level Switch current and voltage
Select2 output using CN15 on the
control panel
MEMOBUS Communications: H5
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
5 H5-01
Station
address Sets the Inverter's node 0 to 20
1F No A A A A 425H 6-83
Serial address. *
Comm Adr
Communica- Sets the baud rate for MEMO-
tions speed BUS communications.
selection 0: 1200 bps
H5-02 1: 2400 bps 0 to 4 3 No A A A A 426H 6-83
Serial Baud 2: 4800 bps
Rate 3: 9600 bps
4: 19200 bps
Communica- Sets the parity for MEMO-
tions parity BUS communications.
H5-03 selection 0: No parity 0 to 2 0 No A A A A 427H 6-83
Serial Com 1: Even parity
Sel 2: Odd parity
Send wait
time Sets the time from the Inverter
H5-06 receiving data to when the 5 to 65 5 ms No A A A A 42AH 6-83
Transmit Inverter starts to send.
WaitTIM
5-50
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
RTS control Enables or disables RTS con-
ON/OFF trol.
0: Disabled (RTS is always
H5-07 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 42BH 6-83
RTS Con- ON)
trol Sel 1: Enabled (RTS turns ON
only when sending)
Unit Selec-
tion for
MEMO- Selects the unit used for
BUS regis- MEMOBUS register 0025H
H5-10 ter 0025H (output voltage monitor) 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 436H -
0: 0.1 V units
MEMO- 1: 1 V units
BUS 0025H
Unit
* Set H5-01 to 0 to disable Inverter responses to MEMOBUS communications.
5-51
Protection Function Parameters: L
Motor Overload: L1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Sets whether the motor thermal
Motor pro- overload protection function is
enabled or disabled.
tection
0: Disabled
selection
1: General-purpose motor
protection (fan cooled
motor)
2: Inverter motor protection
(externally cooled motor)
3: Vector motor protection
4-5
L1-01 When the Inverter power 0 to 3 1 No Q Q Q Q 480H
6-51
supply is turned off, the
thermal value is reset, so
MOL Fault
even if this parameter is set
Select to 1, protection may not be
effective.
When several motors are con-
nected to one Inverter, set to
L1-01 to 0 and ensure that each
motor is installed with a pro-
5 Motor pro-
tection device.
Sets the electric thermal detec-
tection time tion time in seconds units.
constant Usually changing this setting is
not necessary.
The factory setting is 150%
0.1 to
L1-02 overload for one minute. 1.0 min No A A A A 481H 6-51
5.0
MOL Time When the motor's overload
Const capability is known, also set
the overload resistance protec-
tion time for when the motor is
hot started.
Alarm oper- Selects the operation when the
ation selec- input motor temperature (ther-
tion during mistor) input exceeds the alarm
motor over- detection level (1.17 V) (H3-09
heating must be set to E).
L1-03 0: Decelerate to stop 0 to 3 3 No A A A A 482H 6-53
1: Coast to stop
Mtr OH 2: Fast stop using the
Alarm Sel deceleration time in C1-09.
3: Continue operation (oH3
on the Operator flashes).
Motor over- Selects the operation when the
heating motor temperature (ther-
operation mistor) input exceeds the over-
selection heating detection level (2.34
L1-04 V) (H3-09 must be set to E). 0 to 2 1 No A A A A 483H 6-53
0: Decelerate to stop
Mtr OH 1: Coast to stop
Fault Sel 2: Fast stop using the
deceleration time in C1-09.
5-52
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor tem-
perature
input filter Sets H3-09 to E and sets the
time con- delay time constant for the 0.00 to
L1-05 0.20 s No A A A A 484H 6-53
stant motor temperature (ther- 10.00
mistor) input in seconds.
Mtr Temp
Filter
5
power returns during
control operations. Does
not detect DC bus
undervoltage.)
Momentary
power loss Ridethrough time, when
ride through Momentary Power Loss Selec- 0 to 0.1 s
L2-02 time *1 No A A A A 486H 6-55
tion (L2-01) is set to 1, in units 25.5
PwrL Ride- of seconds.
thru t
Sets the Inverter's minimum
Min. base-
baseblock time, when the
block time
Inverter is restarted after power
loss ride through.
Set the time to approximately
0.7 times the motor time con- 0.1 to 0.2 s 6-55
L2-03 No A A A A 487H
stant. 5.0 *1 6-56
PwrL Base- When an overcurrent or over-
block t voltage occurs when starting a
speed search or DC injection
braking, increase the set val-
ues.
Voltage Sets the time required to return
recovery the Inverter output voltage
0.0 to 0.3 s 6-55
L2-04 time from 0V to normal voltage at No A A A A 488H
5.0 *1 6-56
PwrL V/F the completion of a speed
Ramp t search.
Undervolt-
Sets the DC bus undervoltage
age detec-
(UV) detection level (DC bus 150 to
tion level 190 V 6-55
L2-05 voltage). 210 No A A A A 489H
*2 *2 6-131
PUV Det Usually changing this setting is
Level not necessary.
5-53
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Kinetic Sets the time required to decel-
Energy Buff- erate from the speed where the
ering decel- deceleration at momentary 0.0 to
L2-06 eration time 0.0 s No A A A No 48AH 6-131
power loss command (Kinetic 200.0
KEB Decel Energy Buffering) is input to
Time zero speed.
Momentary
recovery Sets the time to accelerate to
0.0 to 0.0 s
L2-07 time the set speed after recovery *3 No A A A No 48BH 6-131
25.5
UV Return from a momentary power loss.
Time
Frequency Sets the reduction gain of the
reduction output frequency at the begin-
gain at ning of deceleration at momen-
Kinetic tary power loss (Kinetic
L2-08 Energy Buff- 0 to 300 100% No A A A No 48CH 6-131
Energy Buffering).
ering start Reduction = slip frequency
KEB before Kinetic Energy Buffer-
Frequency ing operation × L2-08 × 2
* 1. The asdfasdffactory setting depends on the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
* 2. This is the value for a 200 V class Inverter. The value for a 400 V class Inverter is the double.
* 3. If the setting is 0, the axis will accelerate to the last frequency reference using the active acceleration time (C1-01 to C1-08).
5 Stall Prevention: L3
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Stall preven- 0: Disabled (Acceleration as
tion selec- set. With a heavy load, the
tion during motor may stall.)
accel 1: Enabled (Acceleration
stopped when L3-02 level
is exceeded. Acceleration
starts again when the
current has fallen below the
L3-01 0 to 2 1 No A A A No 48FH 6-23
stall prevention level).
StallP Accel 2: Intelligent acceleration
Sel mode (Using the L3-02
level as a basis,
acceleration is
automatically adjusted. The
set acceleration time is
disregarded.)
Stall preven- Sets the stall prevention during
tion level acceleration operation current
during accel level as a percentage of
Inverter rated current.
150%
L3-02 Effective when L3-01 is set to 0 to 200 No A A A No 490H 6-23
*
StallP Accel 1 or 2.
Lvl Usually changing this setting is
not necessary. Reduce the set-
ting when the motor stalls.
Stall preven- Sets the lower limit for the stall
tion limit prevention during acceleration,
during accel as a percentage of the Inverter
L3-03 0 to 100 50% No A A A No 491H 6-23
rated current.
StallP CHP Usually changing this setting is
Lvl not necessary.
5-54
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Selects the stall prevention
Stall preven-
tion selec- during deceleration.
0: Disabled (Deceleration as
tion during
set. If deceleration time is
decel
too short, a DC-Bus
overvoltage may result.)
1: Enabled (Deceleration is
stopped when the DC-Bus
voltage exceeds the stall
prevention level.
Deceleration restarts when
the voltage falls below the
stall prevention level
again.) 4-5
L3-04 0 to 3 1 No Q Q Q Q 492H
2: Intelligent deceleration 6-25
mode (Deceleration rate is
StallP Decel
automatically adjusted so
Sel that in Inverter can
decelerate in the shortest
possible time. The set
deceleration time is
disregarded.)
3: Enabled (with Braking
Resistor Unit)
When a braking option (Brak-
ing Resistor, Braking Resistor
Unit, Braking Unit) is used,
always set to 0 or 3. 5
Stall preven- Selects the stall prevention
tion selec- during running.
tion during 0: Disabled (Runs as set. With
running a heavy load, the motor
may stall.)
L3-05 0 to 2 1 No A A No No 493H 6-48
1: Deceleration using
StallP Run deceleration time 1
Sel (C1-02.)
2: Deceleration using deceler-
ationtime 2 (C1-04.)
Stall preven- Set the stall prevention during
tion level run operation current level as a
during run percentage of the Inverter rated
current.
30 to 150%
L3-06 Effective when L3-05 is 1 or 2. No A A No No 494H 6-48
200 *
StallP Run Usually changing this setting is
Level not necessary.
Reduce the setting when the
motor stalls.
* The given initial value is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the initial value will
be 120%.
5-55
Reference Detection: L4
Param Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Speed agree- Sets the detection level for the
ment detection output frequency detection
level function. Effective when a
0.0 to
multi-function digital output is
L4-01 150.0 0.0 Hz No A A A A 499H 6-33
set to:
Spd Agree *
• 3 (fout / fset agree 1)
Level • 4 (Frequency detection 1)
• 5 (Frequency detection 2)
Speed agree- Sets the hysteresis for the out-
ment detection put frequency detection func-
width tion. Effective when a multi-
function digital input is set to: 0.0 to
L4-02 • 2 (fref / fout agree 1) 2.0 Hz No A A A A 49AH 6-33
20.0
Spd Agree • 3 (fout / fset agree 1)
Width
• 4 (Frequency detection 1)
• 5 (Frequency detection 2)
Speed agree- Sets the detection level for the
ment detection output frequency detection
level (+/-) function. Effective when a -150.0
multi-function digital output is to
L4-03 0.0 Hz No A A A A 49BH 6-33
set to: +150.0
Spd Agree • 14 (fout / fset agree 2) *
Lvl+- • 15 (Frequency detetcion 3)
5 • 16 (Frequency detection 4)
Speed agree- Sets the hysteresis for the out-
ment detection put frequency detection func-
width (+/-) tion. Effective when a multi-
function digital input is set to: 0.0 to
L4-04 • 13 (fref / fout agree 2) 2.0 Hz No A A A A 49CH 6-33
20.0
Spd Agree • 14 (fout / fset agree 2)
Wdth+-
• 15 (Frequency detection 3)
• 16 (Frequency detection 4)
Operation 0: Stop (Operation follows
when fre- the frequency reference.)
quency refer- 1: Operation continues at the
ence is frequency, set in parameter
L4-05 missing L4-06. 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 49DH 6-60
Frequency reference loss
means that the frequency
Ref Loss Sel reference value drops over
90% in 400 ms.
Frequency ref-
erence value
at frequency Sets the frequency reference
0.0 to
L4-06 reference loss value when the frequency ref- 80% No A A A A 4C2H 6-60
100.0%
erence is missing
Fref at Floss
Width of fre-
quency refer- When the frequency reference
drops by this value within
L4-12 ence loss 10 to 80 10% No A A A A 4E7H 6-60
400ms frequency reference
FREF Loss loss is detected.
Width
* The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range will
be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
5-56
Fault Restart: L5
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Number of Sets the number of auto restart
auto restart attempts.
L5-01 attempts Automatically restarts after a 0 to 10 0 No A A A A 49EH 6-61
Num of fault and conducts a speed
Restarts search from the run frequency.
Auto restart Sets whether a fault digital
operation output is activated during fault
selection restart.
L5-02 0: No output (Fault output is 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 49FH 6-61
not activated.)
Restart Sel 1: Output (Fault output is
activated.)
5-57
Torque Detection: L6
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
0: Overtorque/undertorque
Torque detection disabled.
detection
1: Overtorque detection only
selection 1
with speed agreement;
operation continues
(warning is output).
2: Overtorque detected
continuously during
operation; operation
continues
(warning is output).
3: Overtorque detection only
with speed agreement;
output stopped upon
detection.
4: Overtorque detected
continuously during
operation; output stopped
L6-01 0 to 8 0 No A A A A 4A1H 6-49
upon detection.
5: Undertorque detection
Torq Det 1 Sel only with speed agree-
ment; operation continues
(warning is output).
6: Undertorque detected
continuously during
5 operation; operation
continues
(warning is output).
7: Undertorque detection
only with speed agree-
ment; output stopped upon
detection.
8: Undertorque detected
continuously during
operation; output stopped
upon detection.
Torque detec-
Vector control: Motor rated
tion level 1torque is set as 100%. 0 to
L6-02 150% No A A A A 4A2H 6-49
V/f control: Inverter rated cur- 300
Torq Det 1 Lvl rent is set as 100%.
Torque detec-
tion time 1 Sets the overtorque/under- 0.0 to
L6-03 0.1 s No A A A A 4A3H 6-49
Torq Det 1 torque detection time. 10.0
Time
Torque detec-
tion selection
L6-04 2 0 to 8 0 No A A A A 4A4H 6-49
Torque detec-
tion level 2 See L6-01 to L6-03 for a 0 to
L6-05 description. 150% No A A A A 4A5H 6-49
300
Torq Det 2 Lvl
Torque detec-
tion time 2 0.0 to
L6-06 0.1 s No A A A A 4A6H 6-49
Torq Det 2 10.0
Time
5-58
Torque Limits: L7
Param Change Control Methods
Name Set- Fac- MEMO-
eter during V/f Open Closed
Description ting tory BUS Page
Num- Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
Display Range Setting
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Forward
drive torque
0 to
L7-01 limit 200%* No No No A A 4A7H 6-46
300
Torq Limit
Fwd
Reverse Sets the torque limit value as a per-
drive torque centage of the motor rated torque.
0 to
L7-02 limit Four individual regions can be set. 200%* No No No A A 4A8H 6-46
300
Torq Limit
Rev Output torque
Positive torque
Forward
regenera- No. o
motor
tive torque Reverse Regen. rotations 0 to
L7-03 limit 200%* No No No A A 4A9H 6-46
Regen. Forward 300
Torq Lmt
Fwd Rgn Negative torque
Reverse
regenera-
tive torque 0 to
L7-04 limit 200%* No No No A A 4AAH 6-46
300
Torq Lmt
Rev Rgn
Torque
limit time
5
Sets the torque limit integration time 5 to
L7-06 constant 200 ms No No No A No 4ACH 6-47
constant 10000
Torque
Limit Time
Torque Sets the torque limit operation during
Limit Oper- acceleration and deceleration.
ation dur- 0: P-control (I control is added at
ing accel/ constant speed operation)
decel 1: I-control
Normally changing this setting is not
L7-07 necessary. 0 or 1 0 No No No A No 4C9H 6-47
If the torque limitation accuracy dur-
Torque ing accel/decel. has preference, I
Limit Sel control should be selected. This may
result in an increased accel./decel.
time and speed deviations from the
reference value.
5-59
Hardware Protection: L8
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Protect selec-
tion for inter- 0: Disabled (no overheating
nal DB protection)
L8-01 resistor 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 4ADH 6-63
1: Enabled (overheating
DB Resistor protection)
Prot
Overheat pre- Sets the detection temperature
alarm level for the Inverter overheat
detection pre-alarm in °C. 50 to
L8-02 95 °C* No A A A A 4AEH 6-64
OH Pre- The pre-alarm detects when 130
Alarm Lvl the cooling fin temperature
reaches the set value.
Operation Sets the operation for when
selection the Inverter overheat pre-
after overheat alarm occurs.
pre-alarm 0: Decelerate to stop using
the deceleration time C1-
02.
1: Coast to stop
L8-03 0 to 3 3 No A A A A 4AFH 6-64
2: Fast stop in fast-stop time
OH Pre- C1-09.
Alarm Sel 3: Continue operation
(Monitor display only.)
5
A fault will be given in setting
0 to 2 and a alarm will be
given in setting 3.
Input open- 0: Disabled
phase protec- 1: Enabled (Detects power
tion selection supply open-phase, power
L8-05 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 4B1H 6-64
supply voltage imbalance
Ph Loss In or DC bus electrostatic
Sel capacitor deterioration.)
Output open- 0: Disabled
phase protec- 1: Enabled, 1 Phase Observa-
tion selection tion
2: Enabled, 2 and 3 Phase
Observation
An output open-phase is
L8-07 detected at less than 5% of 0 or 2 0 No A A A A 4B3H 6-65
Ph Loss Out Inverter rated current.
Sel When the applied motor
capacity is small compared to
the Inverter capacity, the
detection may not work prop-
erly and should be disabled.
Ground pro- 0:Disabled
tection selec- 1:Enabled
L8-09 tion It is not recommended to use 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 4B5H 6-65
Ground Fault another setting than factory
Sel setting.
5-60
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Cooling fan
control delay Set the time in seconds to
time delay turning OFF the cooling
L8-11 0 to 300 60 s No A A A A 4B7H 6-65
fan after the inverter STOP
Fan Delay command is given.
Time
Ambient
temperature
L8-12 Sets the ambient temperature. 45 to 60 45 °C No A A A A 4B8H 6-66
Ambient
Temp
OL2 charac- 0: OL2 characteristics at low
teristics speeds disabled.
selection at 1: OL2 characteristics at low
L8-15 low speeds speeds enabled. 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 4BBH 6-67
It is not recommended to use
OL2 Sel @ another setting than the fac-
L-Spd tory setting.
Soft CLA
selection 0: Disable
L8-18 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 4BFH -
1: Enable
Soft CLA Sel
OH Detect
sel
(FAN alarm is displayed)
1: Enabled (OH1 fault 5
occurs)
* The factory setting depends upon the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
Special Adjustments: n
5-61
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Hunting-pre- Sets the hunting-prevention
vention gain gain.
Normally, there is no need to
change this setting.
If necessary, make the adjust-
ments as follows:
• If vibration occurs with 0.00 to 4-14
n1-02 1.00 No A A No No 581H
Hunt Prev light load, increase the set- 2.50 6-44
Gain ting.
• If the motor stalls, reduce
the setting.
If the setting is too large, the
voltage will be too suppressed
and the motor may stall.
5-62
Automatic Frequency Regulator: n2
Param- Change Control Methods
MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Name Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Speed feed- Sets the internal speed feed-
back detec- back detection control gain.
tion control Normally, there is no need to
(AFR) gain change this setting.
If necessary, adjust this
parameter as follows:
0.00 to 4-14
n2-01 • If hunting occurs, increase 1.00 No No No A No 584H
10.00 6-45
the set value.
AFR Gain • If response is low, decrease
the set value.
Adjust the setting by 0.05 at a
time, while checking the
response.
Speed feed-
back detec- Set the time constant 1 to
tion control decide the rate of change in 0 to
n2-02 (AFR) time 50 ms No No No A No 585H 6-45
the speed feedback detection 2000
constant control.
AFR Time
Speed feed-
back detec-
tion control Set the time constant 2 to
0 to
n2-03 (AFR) time decide the rate of change in 750 ms No No No A No 586H 6-45
2000
the speed.
5
constant 2
AFR Time 2
High-slip Braking: n3
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
High-slip
braking Sets the frequency width for
deceleration deceleration during high-slip
n3-01 frequency braking in percent, taking the 1 to 20 5% No A A No No 588H 6-132
width maximum frequency (E1-04)
HSB Down as 100%.
Freq
High-slip Sets the current limit for
braking cur-deceleration during high-slip
rent limit braking in percent, taking the
100 to
n3-02 motor rated current as 100%. 150% No A A No No 589H 6-132
200
The resulting limit must be
HSB Current 150% of the Inverter rated
current or less.
High-slip Sets the dwell time of the out-
braking stop put frequency for FMIN (1.5
dwell time 0.0 to
n3-03 Hz) during V/f control. 1.0 s No A A No No 58AH 6-132
10.0
HSB Dwell Effective only during deceler-
Time ation with high-slip braking.
High-slip
braking OL Set the OL time when the out-
time put frequency does not change 30 to
n3-04 40 s No A A No No 58BH 6-132
for any reason during deceler- 1200
HSB OL ation with high-slip braking.
Time
5-63
Digital Operator Parameters: o
Monitor Selections: o1
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Monitor Set the number of the 4rd.
selection monitor item to be displayed
o1-01 4 to 88 6 Yes A A A A 500H 6-138
User Moni- in the Drive Mode. (U1- )
tor Sel (On LED operator only.)
5
output frequency is 100%)
• 2 to 39: rpm units (Set the
motor poles.)
• 40 to 39999:User desired
display Set the desired val-
ues for setting and display 0 to
o1-03 0 No A A A A 502H 6-139
for the max. output fre- 39999
quency.
Display
Scaling
Sets the value that is
to be displayed at
100% excluding the
decimal point.
5-64
Digital Operator Functions: o2
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
LOCAL/ Enables/Disables the Digital
REMOTE Operator Local/Remote key
key enable/ 0: Disabled
o2-01 disable 1: Enabled (Switches 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 505H 6-139
between the Digital
Local/ Operator and the parame-
Remote Key ter settings b1-01, b1-02.)
STOP key Enables/Disables the Stop key
during con- in the run mode.
trol circuit 0: Disabled (When the run
terminal command is issued from
o2-02 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 506H 6-139
operation an external terminal, the
Stop key is disabled.)
Oper Stop 1: Enabled (Effective even
Key during run.)
Clears or stores user initial
User param- values.
eter initial 0: Stores/not set
value 1: Begins storing (Records
the set parameters as user
initial values.)
o2-03 0 to 2 0 No A A A A 507H 6-139
2: All clear (Clears all
recorded user initial
User values)
Defaults When the set parameters are
recorded as user initial val- 5
ues, 1110 will be set in A1-03.
kVA selec- Do not set unless after replac-
tion ing the control board. (Refer
o2-04 0 to FF 0 No A A A A 508H 6-139
Inverter to page 5-79 for the setting
Model # values).
5-65
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Cumulative
operation 0: Accumulated inverter
time selec- power on time.
o2-08 tion 0 or 1 1 No A A A A 50CH 6-140
1: Accumulated inverter run
Elapsed time.
Time Run
Initialize
Mode
o2-09 2: Europe 2 2 No A A A A 50DH -
InitModeSet
5
Copy Function: o3
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Copy func- 0: Normal operation
tion selec- 1: READ (Inverter to
tion Operator)
o3-01 0 to 3 0 No A A A A 515H 6-140
2: COPY (Operator to
Copy Func- Inverter)
tion Sel 3: Verify (compare)
Read per-
mission
selection 0: READ prohibited
o3-02 0 or 1 0 No A A A A 516H 6-140
1: READ permitted
Copy
Allowable
5-66
Speed Follower: S
Master
direction)
5
encoder PPR Sets the master drive encoder 20 to
S1-02 1024 No Q Q Q Q 681H 5-67
Master PG PPR. 60000
PPR
Ratio
Numerator
(Upper 4 Sets the upper 4 digits of the 0 to
S1-03 Digits) 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q 682H 5-67
primary gear ratio numerator. 9999
Ratio Num
High
Ratio
Denomina-
tor (Upper 4 Sets the upper 4 digits of the
0 to
S1-04 Digits) primary gear ratio denomina- 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q 683H 5-67
9999
tor
Ratio Den
High
Ratio
Numerator
(Lower 4 Sets the lower 4 digits of the
0 to
S1-05 Digits) primary gear ratio denomina- 0 Yes A A A A 684H 5-67
9999
tor
Ratio Num
Low
Ratio
Denomina-
tor (Lower 4 Sets the lower 4 digits of the 0 to
S1-06 Digits) primary gear ratio denomina- 0 Yes A A A A 685H 5-67
9999
tor
Ratio Den
Low
5-67
Follower Configuration Configuration 2: S2
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
5 PG Mon Ch
Select
monitor outputs
1: Channel 2 (Master’s PG)
PG Channel 2 is sent to the
monitor outputs
Ratio Sets the frequency width used
Change to determine a speed agree
Speed Agree condition when the drive is
Width accelerating or decelerating
due to one of the following:
0.0 to
S2-05 • Gear ratio change 0.5 Hz Yes A A A A 694H 5-67
20.0
• Change in state of the Fol-
RatioChgSp- lower Disable multi-func-
dAgrF tion input
• Change in state of the run
command.
Motor Autotuning: T
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor 1/2 Sets the parameter group, in
selection which the autotuned motor
parameters are stored.
1: E1 to E2 (motor 1)
T1-00 1 or 2 1 No Yes Yes Yes Yes 700H 4-8
2: E3 to E4 (motor 2)
Select Motor Displayed only if a digital
input is set to “Motor 1/2
selection” (H1- =16).
Autotuning Sets the autotuning mode.
mode selec- 0: Rotating autotuning
tion 1: Non-rotating autotuning
4-8
T1-01 2: Non-rotating autotuning 0 to 4* 1 0 No Yes Yes Yes Yes 701H
4-11
Tuning for line-to-line resistance
Mode Sel only
4: Non-rotating autotuning 2
5-68
Param- Change Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
Description BUS Page
Num- Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber tion PG Vector Vector
Motor out-
0.40
put power Sets the output power of the 0.00 to
T1-02 kW No Yes Yes Yes Yes 702H 4-11
Mtr Rated motor in kilowatts. 650.00 *2
Power
Motor rated
0 to
voltage Sets the rated voltage of the 200.0 V
T1-03 255.0 No No No Yes Yes 703H 4-11
Rated motor. *3 *3
Voltage
Motor rated
0.32 to
current Sets the rated current of the 1.90 A
T1-04 6.40 No Yes Yes Yes Yes 704H 4-11
Rated motor. *4 *2
Current
Motor base
0 to
frequency Sets the base frequency of the
T1-05 150.0 50.0 Hz No No No Yes Yes 705H 4-11
Rated Fre- motor. *5
quency
Number of
motor poles Sets the number of motor 2 to 48
T1-06 4 poles No No No Yes Yes 706H 4-11
Number of poles. poles
Poles
Motor base
Sets the base speed of the 0 to 1750
T1-07 speed No No No Yes Yes 707H 4-11
5
motor in r/min. 24000 r/min
Rated Speed
Number of
PG pulses Sets the number of PG pulses 0 to
T1-08 1024 No No No No Yes 708H 4-11
PG Pulses/ per revolution. 60000
Rev
Sets the current value
Motor no- recorded in the motor’s test
load current results for a motor without a 0.00 to
1.89 1.20 A
T1-09 load. No No No Yes Yes 709H 4-11
*6 *2
No-Load Displayed only when Non-
Current Rotating Auto-Tuning 2 is
selected (T1-01=4)
* 1. For V/f control V/f control with PG the setting range is limited to setting 2 only.
* 2. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity. (The value for a 200 V Class Inverter for 0.4 kW is given.)
* 3. These are values for a 200 V class Inverter. Values for 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 4. The setting range is from 10% to 200% of the Inverter rated output current. (The value for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4kW is given)
* 5. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01= 1 or 2) the setting
range will be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
* 6. The setting range depends on the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4kW is given.
5-69
Monitor Parameters: U
Control
method Displays the current control
U1-04 (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 43H
Control method.
Method
Motor speed 10 V: Max. frequency
Monitors the detected motor 0.01
5
U1-05 (0 to ± 10 V possible) No Yes Yes Yes 44H
Motor Speed speed.*1 Hz
Output
voltage Monitors the output voltage 10 V: 200 VAC (400 VAC)
U1-06 0.1 V Yes Yes Yes Yes 45H
Output reference value. (0 to +10 V output)
Voltage
DC bus
voltage Monitors the main DC bus 10 V: 400 VDC (800 VDC)
U1-07 1V Yes Yes Yes Yes 46H
DC Bus voltage. (0 to +10 V output)
Voltage
Output 10 V: Inverter capacity
power Monitors the output power (max. applicable motor 0.1
U1-08 Yes Yes Yes Yes 47H
Output (internally detected value). capacity) kW
kWatts (0 to ± 10 V possible)
Torque
reference Monitors the internal torque
10 V: Motor rated torque
U1-09 reference value for open vec- 0.1% No No Yes Yes 48H
Torque (0 to ± 10 V possible)
tor control.
Reference
* 1. The unit is set in o1-03 (Frequency units of reference setting and monitor)
5-70
Param- Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Output Signal Level During Min. V/f Open Closed
Description BUS
Num- Multi-Function Analog Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber PG Vector Vector
Input termi- Shows input ON/OFF status.
nal status
1: FWD command
(S1) is ON
1: REV command
(S2) is ON
1: Multi input 1
(S3) is ON
1: Multi input 2
U1-10 (S4) is ON (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 49H
Input Term
1: Multi input 3
Sts (S5) is ON
1: Multi input 4
(S6) is ON
1: Multi input 5
(S7) is ON
1: Multi-function
digital output 2
(M3-M4) is ON
U1-11 (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 4AH
5
Output Term 1: Multi-function
digital output 3
Sts (M5-M6) is ON
Not used
(Always 0).
1: Fault output
(MA/MB-MC) is
ON
1: Zero speed
1: Reverse
1: Reset signal
input
U1-12 1: Speed agree (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 4BH
Int Ctl Sts 1 1: Inverter ready
1: Alarm
1: Fault
FLASH ID
Terminal A1 Monitors the input level of
input level analog input A1. A value of 10 V: 100%
U1-15 0.1% Yes Yes Yes Yes 4EH
Term A1 100% corresponds to 10V (0 to ± 10 V possible)
Level input.
5-71
Param- Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Output Signal Level During Min. V/f Open Closed
Description BUS
Num- Multi-Function Analog Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber PG Vector Vector
Terminal A2 Monitors the input level of
input level analog input A2. A value of 10 V/20mA: 100%
U1-16 0.1% Yes Yes Yes Yes 4FH
Term A2 100% corresponds to 10V/ (0 to ±10 V possible)
Level 20mA input.
5 SFS Output
ASR input
The unit is set in o1-03.
Monitors the input to the
speed control loop. 10 V: Max. frequency 0.01
U1-21 No Yes No Yes 54H
ASR Input The maximum frequency cor- (0 to ± 10 V possible) %
responds to 100%.
ASR output Monitors the output from the
speed control loop. 10 V:Max. frequency 0.01
U1-22 No Yes No Yes 55H
ASR output The maximum frequency cor- (0 to ± 10 V possible) %
responds to 100%.
PID feed-
back value Monitors the feedback value 10 V: 100% feedback value 0.01
U1-24 Yes Yes Yes Yes 57H
PID when PID control is used. (0 to ± 10 V possible) %
Feedback
DI-16H2 Monitors the reference value
Input Status from a DI-16H2 option card.
U1-25 The value will be displayed (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 58H
DI-16 in binary or BCD depending
Reference on user constant F3-01.
Output volt-
age refer- Monitors the Inverter internal
10 V: 200 VAC (400 VAC)
U1-26 ence (Vq) voltage reference for motor 0.1 V No No Yes Yes 59H
(0 to ± 10 V possible)
Voltage secondary current control.
Ref(Vq)
Output volt-
age refer- Monitors the Inverter internal
10 V: 200 VAC (400 VAC)
U1-27 ence (Vd) voltage reference for motor 0.1 V No No Yes Yes 5AH
(0 to ± 10 V possible)
Voltage excitation current control.
Ref(Vd)
Software
(Manufacturer’s CPU soft-
U1-28 No. (CPU) (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 5BH
ware No.)
CPU ID
5-72
Param- Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Output Signal Level During Min. V/f Open Closed
Description BUS
Num- Multi-Function Analog Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber PG Vector Vector
kWH Lower
four digits Shows the consumed energy 0.1
U1-29 (Cannot be output.) Yes Yes Yes Yes 5CH
kWh Lower in kWh. U1-29 shoes the kWh
4 dig lower four digits, U1-30
shows the upper five digits.
kWH Higher
five digits . 1
U1-30 (Cannot be output.) Yes Yes Yes Yes 5DH
kWh Upper U1-30 U1-29 MW
5 dig
ACR output
of q axis Monitors the current control
10 V: 100% 0.1
U1-32 output value for the motor No No Yes Yes 5FH
ACR(q) (0 to ± 10 V possible) %
secondary current.
Output
ACR output Monitors the current control
10 V: 100% 0.1
U1-33 of d axis output value for the motor No No Yes Yes 60H
(0 to ± 10 V possible) %
ACR(d) axis excitation current.
OPE fault
parameter Shows the first parameter
U1-34 number when an OPE fault is (Cannot be output.) - Yes Yes Yes Yes 61H
OPE detected.
Detected
Zero servo Shows the number of PG
movement pulses of the movement range
U1-35 pulses when zero servo was acti- (Cannot be output.) - No No No Yes 62H
Zero Servo
Pulse
vated. The shown value is the
actual pulse number times 4. 5
PID input
10 V: 100% PID input 0.01
U1-36 volume PID input volume Yes Yes Yes Yes 63H
(0 to ± 10 V possible) %
PID Input
PID output
10 V: 100% PID output 0.01
U1-37 volume PID control output Yes Yes Yes Yes 64H
(0 to ± 10 V possible) %
PID Output
0.01
U1-38 PID setpoint PID set point 10 V: 100% PID set point Yes Yes Yes Yes 65H
%
MEMOBUS Shows MEMOBUS faults.
communica-
tions fault
1: CRC fault
code
1: Data length fault
Not used
1: Parity fault
Transmit Err
1: Framing fault
1: Timeout
Cooling fan
operating Monitors the total operating
time time of the cooling fan. The 1
U1-40 (Cannot be output.) Yes Yes Yes Yes 67H
FAN time can be set in hr
Elapsed 02-10.
Time
5-73
Param- Control Methods
Name MEMO-
eter Output Signal Level During Min. V/f Open Closed
Description BUS
Num- Multi-Function Analog Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display Register
ber PG Vector Vector
Master
encoder fre- Displays the frequency refer-
quency ref- ence from the master drive 10 V: Max. output frequency 0.1
U1.85 erence Yes Yes Yes Yes 71BH
before gear ratios and gains (E1-04) Hz
Master PG are applied.
Fref
Follower
frequency
reference Displays the frequency refer-
ence from the master drive 10V: Max. output frequency 0.1
U1-86 after gear Yes Yes Yes Yes 72CH
ratio after the gear ratio (S1-03 to (E1-04) Hz
S1-06) has been applied.
FrefAfter
Gear
Gear ratio Displays the total gear ratio
adjustment adjustment (sum of digital, 0.01
U1-87 10V: 100.00% Yes Yes Yes Yes 71DH
Gear Ratio analog, MOP and communi- %
Adj cation adjustments)
Follower
reference Displays the frequency refer-
after gear ence from the master drive
after the digital, analog, MOP 10V: Maximum frequency 0.1
U1-88 ratio adjust- Yes Yes Yes Yes 71EH
ment and communication gear (E1-04) Hz
ration adjustments have been
Fref After applied.
5
Adj
* 1. This monitor parameter is only visible when the AI-14B (Analogue input) option card is conneccted and F2-01=0.
5-74
Fault Trace: U2
Param- Control Methods
Name Output Signal Level During MEMO-
eter Min. V/f Open Closed
Description Multi-Function Analog Out- BUS
Num- Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display put Register
ber PG Vector Vector
Current fault
U2-01 Current The content of the current fault. - Yes Yes Yes Yes 80H
Fault
Last fault
U2-02 The content of the last fault. - Yes Yes Yes Yes 81H
Last Fault
Reference
frequency at
The reference frequency when 0.01
U2-03 fault Yes Yes Yes Yes 82H
the last fault occurred. Hz*
Frequency
Ref
Output fre-
quency at The output frequency when the 0.01
U2-04 fault Yes Yes Yes Yes 83H
last fault occurred. Hz*
Output Freq
Output cur-
rent at fault The output current when the last
U2-05 0.01A Yes Yes Yes Yes 84H
Output fault occurred.
Current
Motor speed
The motor speed when the last 0.01
U2-06 at fault No Yes Yes Yes 85H
fault occurred. Hz*
Motor Speed
Output volt-
5
age refer-
The output reference voltage
U2-07 ence at fault 0.1 V Yes Yes Yes Yes 86H
when the last fault occurred.
Output (Cannot be output.)
Voltage
DC bus volt-
age at fault The main current DC voltage
U2-08 1V Yes Yes Yes Yes 87H
DC Bus when the last fault occurred.
Voltage
Output
power at
The output power when the last 0.1
U2-09 fault Yes Yes Yes Yes 88H
fault occurred. kW
Output
kWatts
Torque ref-
erence at The reference torque when the
last fault occurred. The motor
U2-10 fault 0.1% No No No Yes 89H
rated torque corresponds to
Torque 100%.
Reference
Input termi-
nal status at The input terminal status when
the last fault occurred.
U2-11 fault - Yes Yes Yes Yes 8AH
The format is the same as for U1-
Input Term 10.
Sts
Output ter-
minal status The output terminal status when
U2-12 at fault the last fault occurred. The for- - Yes Yes Yes Yes 8BH
Output Term mat is the same as for U1-11.
Sts
5-75
Param- Control Methods
Name Output Signal Level During MEMO-
eter Min. V/f Open Closed
Description Multi-Function Analog Out- BUS
Num- Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Display put Register
ber PG Vector Vector
Operation
status at The operating status when the
U2-13 fault last fault occurred. The format is - Yes Yes Yes Yes 8CH
Inverter Sta- the same as for U1-12.
tus
(Cannot be output.)
Cumulative
operation
The operating time when the last 1
U2-14 time at fault Yes Yes Yes Yes 8DH
fault occurred. hr
Elapsed
Time
* The unit is set in o1-03 (frequency units of reference setting and monitor
Fault History: U3
Param- Name MEMO-
Output Signal Level During Min.
eter Description BUS
Display Multi-Function Analog Output Unit
Number Register
Last fault
U3-01 The fault content of 1st last fault. - 90H
Last Fault
Second last fault
U3-02 The fault content of 2nd last fault. - 91H
Fault Message 2
Third last fault
U3-03 The fault content of 3rd last fault. - 92H
5 Fault Message 3
Fourth last fault
U3-04 The fault content of 4th last fault. - 93H
Fault Message 4
Cumulative opera-
tion time at fault The total operating time when the 1st previous 1
U3-05 94H
fault occurred. hr
Elapsed Time 1
Accumulated time of
second fault The total operating time when the 2nd previous 1
U3-06 95H
fault occurred. hr
Elapsed Time 2
Accumulated time of (Cannot be output.)
third fault The total operating time when the 3rd previous 1
U3-07 96H
fault occurred. hr
Elapsed Time 3
Accumulated time of
fourth/oldest fault The total operating time when the 4th previous 1
U3-08 97H
fault occurred. hr
Elapsed Time 4
Fifth last to tenth last 804
fault 805H
U3-09
806H
– The fault content of the 5th to 10th last fault –
807H
U3-14 Fault Message 5 to 10 808H
809H
Accumulated time of 806H
fifth to tenth fault 80FH
U3-15
Total generating time when 5th ... 10th previous 810H
– 1hr
fault occurred 811H
U3-20 Elapsed Time 5 to 10 812H
813H
The following faults are not recorded in the Fault Trace and Fault History:
CPF00, 01, 02, 03, UV1, and UV2.
IMPORTANT
5-76
Factory Settings that Change with the Control Method (A1-02)
Factory Setting
Param
eter Closed
Name Setting Range Unit V/F with Open Loop
Num- V/f Control Loop Vec-
PG Vector
ber A1-02=0 tor
A1-02=1 A1-02=2
A1-02=3
b3-01 Speed search selection 0 to 3 - 2 3 2 -
b3-02 Speed search operating current 0 to 200 1% 120 - 100 -
b8-02 Energy saving gain 0.0 to 10.0 - - - 0.7 1.0
0.50 0.01
b8-03 Energy saving filter time constant 0.0 to 10.0 - - - *1 *1
C3-01 Slip compensation gain 0.0 to 2.5 - 0.0 - 1.0 1.0
Slip compensation primary delay time con-
C3-02 0 to 10000 1 ms 2000 - 200 -
stant
Torque compensation primary delay time
C4-02 0 to 10000 1 ms 200 200 20 -
constant
C5-01 ASR proportional gain 1 0.00 to 300.00 - - 0.20 - 20.00
C5-02 ASR integral time 1 0.000 to 10.000 1 ms - 0.200 - 0.500
C5-03 ASR proportional gain 2 0.00 to 300.00 - - 0.02 - 20.00
C5-04 ASR integral time 2 0.000 to 10.000 1 ms - 0.050 - 0.500
E1-07 0.0 to 150.0
Mid. output frequency (VB) *2 0.1 V 2.5 2.5 3.0 -
E3-05
0.0 to 150.0
0.1 V *3*4
1.2
*3 *4
1.5
*4
-
5
Min. output frequency (FMIN) 0.1 Hz 0.5 0.0
E3-07 *2 *3 *3
E1-10 9.0 9.0 2.4
Min. output frequency voltage (VMIN) 0.0 to 255.0 0.1 V -
E3-08 *3 *4 *3 *4 *4
F1-09 Overspeed detection time 0.0 to 2.0 1 - 1.0 - 0.0
* 1. The factory settings are 2.00 (Open Loop Vector) / 0.05 (Closed Loop Vector) for inverters of 55 kW and larger.
* 2. The given setting range is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the setting range
will be 0.0 to 400.0 Hz.
* 3. The setting depends also on the Inverter capacity and the setting of E1-03. The given factory setting is for a 200V class Inverter of 0.4 kW and E1-03=F.
* 4. The settins shown is for a 200 V class Inverter. The value will be double for 400 V class Inverters.
5-77
200 V and 400 V Class Inverters of 0.4 to 1.5 kW
Param-
eter Unit Factory Setting
Number
E1-03 - 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
E1-04 Hz 50.0 60.0 60.0 72.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 90.0 120.0 180.0 60.0
E1-05
*1 V 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0 200.0
E1-06 Hz 50.0 60.0 50.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0
E1-07 Hz 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 25.0 25.0 30.0 30.0 2.5 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0
E1-08
V 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 35.0 50.0 35.0 50.0 19.0 24.0 19.0 24.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0
*1
E1-09 Hz 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5
E1-10
V 9.0 9.0 9.0 9.0 8.0 9.0 8.0 9.0 11.0 13.0 11.0 15.0 9.0 9.0 9.0 9.0
*1
* 1. The settings shown are for 200 V class Inverters. The values are double for 400 V class Inverters.
E1-06 Hz 50.0 60.0 50.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 50.0
5 E1-07
E1-08
*1
Hz
V
2.5
14.0
3.0
14.0
3.0
14.0
3.0
14.0
25.0
35.0
25.0
50.0
30.0
35.0
30.0
50.0
2.5
18.0
2.5
23.0
3.0
18.0
3.0
23.0
3.0
14.0
3.0
14.0
3.0
14.0
3.0
14.0
2.5
14.0
E1-09 Hz 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.2
E1-10
V 7.0 7.0 7.0 7.0 6.0 7.0 6.0 7.0 9.0 11.0 9.0 13.0 7.0 7.0 7.0 7.0 7.0
*1
* 1. The settings shown are for 200 V class Inverters. The values are double for 400 V class Inverters.
E1-06 Hz 50.0 60.0 50.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 50.0 50.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0 50.0
E1-07 Hz 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 25.0 25.0 30.0 30.0 2.5 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 2.5
E1-08
V 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0 35.0 50.0 35.0 50.0 15.0 20.0 15.0 20.0 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0
*1
E1-09 Hz 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.2
E1-10
V 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 5.0 6.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 9.0 7.0 11.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
*1
* 1. The settings shown are for 200 V class Inverters. The values are double for 400 V class Inverters.
5-78
Factory Settings that Change with the Inverter Capacity (o2-04)
sec
0.40
0.1
0.75
0.1
1.50
0.2
2.20
0.3
3.70
0.5
5.50
1.0
7.50
1.0
11.00
1.0
15.00
2.0
5
through time
L2-03 Min. baseblock (BB) time sec 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9
L2-04 Voltage recovery time sec 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level °C 95 95 95 100 95 95 95 95 90
Parame-
ter Num- Name Unit Factory Setting
ber
- Inverter Capacity kW 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90 110
o2-04 kVA selection - 9 A B C D E F 10 11
Energy-saving filter time con-
b8-03 sec 0.50 (Open Loop vector) 2.00 (Open Loop vector)
stant
b8-04 Energy-saving coefficient - 57.87 51.79 46.27 38.16 35.78 31.35 23.10 20.65 18.12
Carrier fre- Normal Duty 1 - 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
C6-02 quency
selection Normal Duty 2 - 4 4 4 3 4 6 6 3 4
E2-01
Motor rated current A 65.8 77.2 105.0 131.0 160.0 190.0 260.0 260.0 260.0
(E4-01)
E2-02
Motor rated slip Hz 1.67 1.70 1.80 1.33 1.60 1.43 1.39 1.39 1.39
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor no-load current A 15.7 18.5 21.9 38.2 44.0 45.6 72.0 72.0 72.0
(E4-03)
E2-05
Motor line-to-line resistance W 0.101 0.079 0.064 0.039 0.030 0.022 0.023 0.023 0.023
(E4-05)
E2-06
Motor leak inductance % 20.1 19.5 20.8 18.8 20.2 20.5 20.0 20.0 20.0
(E4-06)
Motor iron loss for torque com-
E2-10 W 505 538 699 823 852 960 1200 1200 1200
pensation
E2-11
Motor rated output power kW 18.50 22.00 30.00 37.00 45.00 55.00 75.00 90.00 110.00
(E4-07)
Momentary power loss ride
L2-02 sec 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
through time
L2-03 Min. baseblock (BB) time sec 1.0 1.0 1.1 1.1 1.2 1.2 1.3 1.5 1.7
L2-04 Voltage recovery time sec 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level °C 100 90 90 95 100 105 110 100 95
5-79
400 V Class Inverters
Param-
eter Name Unit Factory Setting
Number
- Inverter Capacity kW 0.4 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 4.0 5.5 7.5 11
o2-04 kVA selection - 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
Energy-saving filter time con-
b8-03 sec 0.50 (Open Loop vector)
stant
b8-04 Energy-saving coefficient - 576.40 447.40 338.80 313.60 245.80 236.44 189.50 145.38 140.88
Carrier fre- Normal Duty 1 - 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
C6-02 quency
selection Normal Duty 2 - 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 3
E2-01
Motor rated current A 1.00 1.60 3.10 4.20 7.00 7.00 9.80 13.30 19.9
(E4-01)
E2-02
Motor rated slip Hz 2.90 2.60 2.50 3.00 2.70 2.70 1.50 1.30 1.70
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor no-load current A 0.60 0.80 1.40 1.50 2.30 2.30 2.60 4.00 5.6
(E4-03)
E2-05
Motor line-to-line resistance W 38.198 22.459 10.100 6.495 3.333 3.333 1.595 1.152 0.922
(E4-05)
E2-06
Motor leak inductance % 18.2 14.3 18.3 18.7 19.3 19.3 18.2 15.5 19.6
(E4-06)
Motor iron loss for torque com-
E2-10 W 14 26 53 77 130 130 193 263 385
pensation
E2-11
Motor rated output power kW 0.40 0.75 1.50 2.20 3.70 4.00 5.00 7.50 11.00
(E4-07)
Momentary power loss ride
L2-02 sec 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.5 0.5 0.8 0.8 1.0
through time
L2-03 Min. baseblock (BB) time sec 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.6 0.7 0.8
5 L2-04
L8-02
Voltage recovery time
Overheat pre-alarm level
sec
°C
0.3
95
0.3
95
0.3
95
0.3
90
0.3
95
0.3
95
0.3
95
0.3
90
0.3
95
Param-
eter Name Unit Factory Setting
Number
- Inverter Capacity kW 15 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90
o2-04 kVA selection - 29 2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31
Energy-saving filter time con- 2.00 (Open Loop
b8-03 sec 0.50 (Open Loop vector)
stant vector)
b8-04 Energy-saving coefficient - 126.26 115.74 103.58 92.54 76.32 71.56 67.20 46.20 38.91
Carrier fre- Normal Duty 1 - 6 6 6 4 4 4 4 3 3
C6-02 quency
selection Normal Duty 2 - 4 4 4 3 3 3 2 2 3
E2-01
Motor rated current A 26.5 32.9 38.6 52.3 65.6 79.7 95.0 130.0 156.0
(E4-01)
E2-02
Motor rated slip Hz 1.60 1.67 1.70 1.80 1.33 1.60 1.46 1.39 1.40
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor no-load current A 7.6 7.8 9.2 10.9 19.1 22.0 24.0 36.0 40.0
(E4-03)
E2-05
Motor line-to-line resistance W 0.550 0.403 0.316 0.269 0.155 0.122 0.088 0.092 0.056
(E4-05)
E2-06
Motor leak inductance % 17.2 20.1 23.5 20.7 18.8 19.9 20.0 20.0 20.0
(E4-06)
Motor iron loss for torque com-
E2-10 W 440 508 586 750 925 1125 1260 1600 1760
pensation
E2-11
Motor rated output power kW 15.00 18.50 22.00 30.00 37.00 45.00 55.00 75.00 90.00
(E4-07)
Momentary power loss ride
L2-02 sec 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
through time
L2-03 Min. baseblock (BB) time sec 0.9 1.0 1.0 1.1 1.1 1.2 1.2 1.3 1.5
L2-04 Voltage recovery time sec 0.3 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 1.0 1.0 1.0
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level °C 95 98 78 85 85 90 90 98 108
5-80
Param-
eter Name Unit Factory Setting
Number
- Inverter Capacity kW 110 132 160 185 220 300
o2-04 kVA selection - 32 33 34 35 36 37
Energy-saving filter time con-
b8-03 sec 2.00 (Open Loop vector)
stant
b8-04 Energy-saving coefficient - 32.79 33.18 30.13 30.57 27.13 21.76
Carrier fre- Normal Duty 1 - 3 2 2 2 1 1
C6-02 quency
selection Normal Duty 2 - 2 2 2 1 1 1
E2-01
Motor rated current A 190.0 223.0 270.0 310.0 370.0 500.0
(E4-01)
E2-02
Motor rated slip Hz 1.40 1.38 1.35 1.30 1.30 1.25
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor no-load current A 49.0 58.0 70.0 81.0 96.0 130.0
(E4-03)
E2-05
Motor line-to-line resistance W 0.046 0.035 0.029 0.025 0.020 0.014
(E4-05)
E2-06
Motor leak inductance % 20.0 20.0 20.0 20.0 20.0 20.0
(E4-06)
Motor iron loss for torque com-
E2-10 W 2150 2350 2850 3200 3700 4700
pensation
E2-11
Motor rated output power kW 110.00 132.00 160.00 185.00 220.00 300.00
(E4-07)
Momentary power loss ride
L2-02 - 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
L2-03
through time
Min. baseblock (BB) time sec 1.7 1.7 1.8 1.9 2.0 2.1
5
L2-04 Voltage recovery time sec 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level °C 100 110 108 95 100 108
5-81
Parameter Setting Ranges that Change With the Setting of C6-01
Setting Range
Parameter Num-
Name C6-01=1 or 2
ber C6-01=0 (Heavy Duty)
(Normal Duty 1 or 2)
0, F, 1 to 6 (depends on the 0, F, 0 to 6 (depends on the
C6-02 Carrier frequency selection
Inverter capacity) inverter rated power)
b5-15 PID sleep function operation level
b6-01 Dwell frequency at start
b6-03 Dwell frequency at stop
C1-11 Accel./Decel. time switching frequency
C5-07 ASR gain switching frequency
d1- Frequency references
d3-01 Jump frequency 1
d3-02 Jump frequency 2
d3-03 Jump frequency 3
d6-02 Field weakening limit
Upper Limit = 150.0 Hz Upper Limit = 400.0 Hz
E1-04 Maximum output frequency
E1-06 Base frequency
E1-07 Middle output frequency
E1-09 Minimum output frequency
E1-11 Middle output frequency 2
E3-02 Motor 2 maximum output frequency
5 E3-04
E3-05
Motor 2 base frequency
Motor 2 middle output frequency
E3-07 Motor 2 minimum output frequency
L4-01 Frequency detection level
L4-03 Frequency detection bandwidth -150.0 to +150.0 Hz -400.0 to 400.0 Hz
5-82
6
Parameter Settings by
Function
Application and Overload Selections .....................................6-2
Frequency Reference ............................................................6-7
Run Command Input Methods .............................................6-12
Stopping Methods ................................................................6-14
Acceleration and Deceleration Characteristics ....................6-20
Adjusting Frequency References.........................................6-27
Speed Limit (Frequency Reference Limits)..........................6-32
Frequency Detection............................................................6-33
Improving the Operation Performance.................................6-36
Machine Protection ..............................................................6-46
Automatic Restart ................................................................6-55
Inverter Protection................................................................6-63
Input Terminal Functions .....................................................6-68
Output Terminal Functions...................................................6-77
Monitor Parameters .............................................................6-80
Individual Functions .............................................................6-83
Digital Operator Functions .................................................6-138
Option Cards......................................................................6-146
Application and Overload Selections
Related Parameters
6 Torque Torque
6-2
Setting Precautions
* 1. The rated current depends on on the Heavy/Normal Duty selection. (See page -2, Specifications by Model for details)
* 2. The factory setting and the maximum carrier frequency depend on the inverter capacity. (See page -2, Specifications by Model for details)
* 3. If the carrier frequency in Heavy Duty mode is set to a higher value than 2.5 kHz, a current derating must be considered.
• If speed and torque vary at low speeds: Lower the carrier frequency.
• If Inverter noise is affecting peripheral devices: Lower the carrier frequency.
• If leakage current from the Inverter is large: Lower the carrier frequency.
• If metallic noise from the motor is large: Increase the carrier frequency.
6-3
• When using V/f control or V/f control with PG, the carrier frequency can be set to vary depending on the
output frequency, as shown in the following diagram by setting C6-03 (Carrier Frequency Upper Limit),
C6-04 (Carrier Frequency Lower Limit), and C6-05 (Carrier Frequency Proportional Gain).
Carrier Frequency
C6-03
C6-04
Output frequency
E1-04
Max. Output Frequency
• With Open Loop and Closed Loop Vector control, the carrier frequency is fixed by the Carrier Frequency
Upper Limit in C6-03 if user-set, or by the carrier frequency set in C6-02.
• To fix the carrier frequency, set C6-03 and C6-04 to the same value, or set C6-05 to 0.
• If the settings are as shown below, OPE11 (Data setting fault) will occur.
If Carrier Frequency Proportional Gain (C6-05) > 6 and C6-03 < C6-04.
If C6-01 = 0 and Carrier Frequency Selection C6-02 is set from 2 to E.
If C6-01 = 1 and Carrier Frequency Selection C6-02 is set from 7 to E.
6-4
Carrier Frequency and Inverter Overload Capability
The inverter overload capability depends among other things on the carrier frequency setting. If the carrier fre-
quency setting is higher than the factory setting, the overload current capability must be reduced.
110
100
90
Output Current (%)
80
70 6
60
50
2 4 6 8 10 12 14
Carrier Frequency (kHz)
6-5
Normal Duty 1 (C6-01=1)
The default carrier frequency for the Normal Duty 1 mode depends on the inverter capacity. The overload
capability is 120% of the Normal Duty 1 rated current for 1 minute.
If the carrier frequency is set to a higher value than the factory setting, the overload capability is reduced like
shown in Fig 6.3.
96%
90%
400V Class 132kW 200V Class 30kW
Output Current for 1 min.
Carrier Freq.
0
5kHz 8kHz 10kHz 15kHz
6 In the Normal Duty 2 mode the maximum carrier frequency is decreased compared to the Normal Duty 1
mode but the short term overload capability is increased. Refer to Fig 6.4 for the overload capability of both
modes.
100
Inverter Overload Detection Time [min]
10
0.1
100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200
6-6
Frequency Reference
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-01 Frequency reference source selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
H3-09 Analog input 2 function selection 0 No A A A A
H3-13 Terminal A1/A2 main reference input switching 0 No A A A A
H6-01 Pulse train input function selection 0 No A A A A
H6-02 Pulse train input scaling 1440 Hz No A A A A
AC (Analog common)
6-7
2-Step Switching: Master/Auxiliary
If performing 2-step switching between master and auxiliary speed frequencies, input the master speed fre-
quency reference to control circuit terminal A1, and input the auxiliary speed frequency reference to A2.
When terminal S3 (multi-step speed command 1) is OFF, terminal A1 input (master speed frequency refer-
ence) will be the Inverter frequency reference, and when terminal S3 is ON, terminal A2 input (auxiliary
speed frequency reference) will be the Inverter frequency reference.
Inverter
S3 Multi-step speed
Master/ command 1
Auxiliary
SN Digital input neutral
2 kΩ
+V (Power supply: 15 V,
20 mA)
2 kΩ 0 to 10 V input
A1(Master frequency
0 to 10 V reference)
input
A2(Auxiliary frequency
reference)
2 kΩ AC (Analog common)
DIP switch S1
Setting Precautions
When inputting a voltage signal to terminal A2, turn OFF pin 2 on DIP switch S1 to switch to voltage input
(factory setting is ON).
Inputting the Frequency Reference Using a Current Signal / Making Analog Input A1
6 Multifunctional
The frequency reference can be input from control circuit terminal A2 using a 4-20mA current signal. To use
this function parameter H3-13 must be set to 1 (terminal A1/A2 switching).
In this case A2 becomes the master frequency input and A1 becomes multi-functional. The function for the
analog input A1 can be set in parameter H3-09.
Inverter
+V (Power supply: 15 V,
A1(Auxiliary frequency
4 to 20 mA
A2(Master frequency
AC (Analog common)
DIP switch S1
Setting Precautions
• When inputting a current signal to terminal A2, turn ON pin 2 on DIP switch S1 (factory setting: ON).
6-8
Setting Frequency Reference Using Pulse Train Signals
When b1-01 is set to 4, the pulse train input signal at terminal RP input is used as the frequency reference.
Set H6-01 (Pulse Train Input Function Selection) to 0 (frequency reference), and then set the reference pulse
frequency that is equal to 100% of the reference value to H6-02 (Pulse Train Input Scaling).
Inverter
Pulse Input Specifications
Low level voltage 0.0 to 0.8 V
High level voltage 3.5 to 13.2 V
Pulse duty factor 30 to 70%
32 kHz max.
Pulse frequency 0 to 32 kHz
3.5 to 13.2 V
(Pulse train input terminal)
Pulse input
(Analog common)
6-9
Using Multi-Step Speed Operation
The inverter supports a multi step speed operation with a maximum of 17 speed steps, using 16 multi-step fre-
quency references, and one jog frequency reference.
The following example of a multi-function input terminal function shows a 9-step operation using multi-step
references 1 to 3 and jog frequency selection functions.
Related Parameters
To switch frequency references, set multi-step references 1 to 3 and the jog reference selection in the multi-
function digital inputs.
6
mand 1 mand 2 mand 3 tion
1 OFF OFF OFF OFF Frequency reference 1 d1-01, master speed frequency
2 ON OFF OFF OFF Frequency reference 2 d1-02, auxiliary frequency
3 OFF ON OFF OFF Frequency reference 3 d1-03
4 ON ON OFF OFF Frequency reference 4 d1-04
5 OFF OFF ON OFF Frequency reference 5 d1-05
6 ON OFF ON OFF Frequency reference 6 d1-06
7 OFF ON ON OFF Frequency reference 7 d1-07
8 ON ON ON OFF Frequency reference 8 d1-08
17 - - - *1 Jog frequency d1-17
ON
* 1. Terminal S7's jog frequency selection is given priority over multi-step speed commands.
6-10
Setting Precautions
When setting analog inputs to step 1 and step 2, observe the following precautions.
• When setting terminal A1's analog input to step 1 set b1-01 to 1, when setting d1-01 (Frequency Reference
1) to step 1 set b1-01 to 0.
• When setting terminal A2's analog input to step 2 set H3-09 to 2 (auxiliary frequency reference). When
setting d1-02 (Frequency Reference 2) to step 2 set H3-09 to an other setting than 2.
Inverter
Forward/stop
Reverse/stop
Fault reset
Multi-step command 3
Multi-step command 1
Multi-step command 2
Jog frequency
SN Digital input neutral
Forward/stop
Multi-step speed
command 1
Multi-step speed
command 2
Multi-step speed
command 3
Jog frequency
selection
Note:
• The multifunction input setting “Multistep Speed Reference 4” (32) has to be used for selecting the fre-
quency references from d1-09 to d1-16.
• The multifunction input setting “Jog Frequency 2” (69) can be used for jog frequency selection when a 3-
wire control is used for the control circuit. If it is selected while the inverter is initialized to 2-wire control
an OPE03 alarm will be displayed.
6-11
Run Command Input Methods
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-02 RUN command source selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
6 Forward/Stop
Inverter
Reverse/Stop
6-12
Performing Operations Using 3-Wire Control
If one of the parameter H1-01 to H1-05 (digital input terminals S3 to S7) is set to 0, the terminals S1 and S2
are used for a 3-wire control, and the multi-function input terminal that has been set to 0 works as a forward/
reverse selection command terminal.
When the Inverter is initialized for 3-wire control with A1-03, multi-function input 3 becomes the input termi-
nal for the forward/reverse run command.
Stop switch (NC Operation switch
contact) (NO contact)
Run command (operates when ON)
50 ms min.
Run command Can be either ON or OFF
OFF
Stop command (stopped)
OFF (forward) ON (reverse)
Forward/reverse command
Motor speed
Use a control circuit that turns ON terminal S1 for 50 ms or longer for the run command. This
INFO will make the run command self-holding in the Inverter.
6-13
Stopping Methods
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-03 Stopping method selection 0 No Q Q Q Q
b1-05 Zero speed operation selection 0 No No No No A
b2-01 Zero speed level 0.5 Hz No A A A A
b2-02 DC injection braking current 50% No A A A No
b2-04 DC injection braking time at stop 0.50 s No A A A A
6 If the output frequency when decelerating to stop falls below b2-01, the DC injection brake will be applied
using the DC current set in b2-02 for the time set in b2-04.
For deceleration time settings, refer to page 6-20, Setting Acceleration and Deceleration Times.
Run command
Output frequency
Decelerates to stop
deceleration time
DC injection brake
DC injection brake
time when
stopping (b2-04)
6-14
When Closed Loop Vector control is selected, the stopping behavior depends on the setting of b1-05.
RUN OFF ON
fref
Analog
frequency E1-09
reference
0
The Run command turns
OFF and zero speed
control starts when the
fout motor speed feedback
drops below b2-01.
b1-05=0 Zero speed
Run at frequency Initial excitation
control
reference
6
zero speed control starts when
b1-05=3 motor speed feedback drops below
Zero Speed Initial excitation b2-01.
Operation Zero speed
control
After the stop command is input, Run commands are ignored until the Minimum Baseblock Time
INFO (L2-03) has elapsed.
6-15
DC Braking to Stop (b1-03=2)
After the stop command has been input and the minimum baseblock time (L2-03) has elapsed, DC injection
will be applied to the motor. The applied DC injection current can be set in parameter b2-02. The DC injection
braking time depends on the set value of b2-04 and on the output frequency at the moment when the stop com-
mand is input and. If the output frequency was higher than 10% of the maximum output frequency (E1-04) the
DC injection time is lengthened like shown in the figure below.
DC injection brake time
Run command
ON OFF b2-04 x 10
Output frequency
DC injection brake
b2-04
Minimum baseblock DC injection brake time Output frequency at
time (L2-03) stop command input
Lengthen the Minimum Baseblock Time (L2-03) when an overcurrent (OC) occurs during stopping.
INFO
Deceleration time
(e.g., C1-02)
Output frequency
Minimum baseblock
Operation wait time T time (L2-03) Output frequency at
stop command input
6-16
Using the DC Injection Brake
The DC injection brake can be used to stop a coasting motor before restarting it or to hold it at the deceleration
end when the inertia is large. Set parameter b2-03 to apply DC injection to the motor, before it starts to accel-
erate. Set parameter b2-04 to apply a DC injection brake to the motor at stopping.
Setting b2-03/04 to 0 to disables the DC injection brake at start/stop.
Set the DC injection brake current using b2-02.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b2-01 Zero speed level (DC injection braking starting frequency) 0.5 Hz No A A A A
b2-02 DC injection braking current 50% No A A A No
b2-03 DC injection braking time at start 0.00 s No A A A A
b2-04 DC injection braking time at stop 0.50 s No A A A A
b2-04
b2-03 DC inj. time
DC inj. time at start b2-01 at stop
E1-09 DC inj. start
Frequency Min. frequency frequency
Reference
RUN
6-17
Inputting the DC Injection Brake Command from Control Circuit Terminals
If you set a digital input terminal (H1- ) to 60 (DC injection brake command), the DC brake can be applied
by enabling or disabling this input. The time chart for the DC injection brake is shown below.
FRUN
Output frequency
6-18
Using an Fast Stop
Set a digital input terminal (H1- ) to 15 or 17 (Fast stop) to decelerate to stop using the fast stop decelera-
tion time set in C1-09. If inputting the fast stop with an NO contact, set the multi-function digital input termi-
nal (H1- ) to 15, and if inputting the fast stop with an NC contact, set the multi-function digital input
terminal (H1- ) to 17.
After the fast stop command has been input, operation cannot be restarted until the Inverter has stopped. To
cancel the fast stop, turn OFF the run command and emergency stop command.
Related parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C1-09 Fast stop time 10.0 s No A A A A
6-19
Acceleration and Deceleration Characteristics
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C1-01 Acceleration time 1 Yes Q Q Q Q
C1-02 Deceleration time 1 Yes Q Q Q Q
C1-03 Acceleration time 2 Yes A A A A
C1-04 Deceleration time 2 Yes A A A A
10.0 s
C1-05 Acceleration time 3 No A A A A
C1-06 Deceleration time 3 No A A A A
C1-07 Acceleration time 4 No A A A A
C1-08 Deceleration time 4 No A A A A
C1-10 Acceleration/deceleration time setting unit 1 No A A A A
C1-11 Acceleration/deceleration time switching frequency 0.0 Hz No A A A A
C2-01 S-curve characteristic time at acceleration start 0.20 s No A A A A
C2-02 S-curve characteristic time at acceleration end 0.20 s No A A A A
C2-03 S-curve characteristic time at deceleration start 0.20 s No A A A A
6
C2-04 S-curve characteristic time at deceleration end 0.00 s No A A A A
6-20
Switching Acceleration and Deceleration Time Using Multi-Function Input Terminal
Commands
Four different acceleration times and deceleration times can be set. When the multi-function input terminals
(H1- ) are set to 7 (acceleration/deceleration time selection 1) and 1A (acceleration/deceleration time
selection 2), you can switch the acceleration/deceleration time even during operation by combining the ON/
OFF status of the terminals.
The following table shows the acceleration/deceleration time switching combinations.
Acceleration/Deceleration Time Acceleration/Deceleration Time
Acceleration Time Deceleration Time
Selection 1 Terminal Selection 2 Terminal
OFF OFF C1-01 C1-02
ON OFF C1-03 C1-04
OFF ON C1-05 C1-06
ON ON C1-07 C1-08
Output
Frequency
Accel./Decel. time
Switching Freq.
C1-11
6
C1-07 C1-01 C1-02 C1-08
When output frequency ≥ C1-11, acceleration and deceleration are performed using
Acceleration/deceleration Time 1 (C1-01, C1-02).
When output frequency < C1-11, acceleration and deceleration are performed using
Acceleration/deceleration Time 4 (C1-07, C1-08).
6-21
Adjusting Acceleration and Deceleration Time Using an Analog Input
If you set H3-09 (Analog Input Terminal A2 Function Selection) to 5 (acceleration/deceleration time gain),
you can adjust the acceleration/deceleration time using terminal A2's input voltage.
The resulting acceleration time is as follows:
Acceleration time = C1-01 set value x acceleration/deceleration time gain
Acceleration/deceleration time gain
C2-03
2
+ C2-04- + C1-02/04/06/08
Decel. Time = -----------------------------------
2
Setting Example
The S-curve characteristic when switching operation (forward/reverse) is shown in the following diagram.
Forward
Reverse
Output frequency
6-22
Accelerating and Decelerating Heavy Loads (Dwell Function)
The dwell function holds the output frequency temporarily when starting or stopping heavy loads. When using
the dwell function, deceleration to stop must be set as stopping method (b1-03 = 0).
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b6-01 Dwell frequency at start 0.0 Hz No A A A A
b6-02 Dwell time at start 0.0 s No A A A A
b6-03 Dwell frequency at stop 0.0 Hz No A A A A
b6-04 Dwell time at stop 0.0 s No A A A A
Output frequency
6
b6-01 b6-03 Time
b6-02 b6-04
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L3-01 Stall prevention selection during acceleration 1 No A A A No
L3-02 Stall prevention level during acceleration *1 No A A A No
150%
L3-03 Stall prevention limit during acceleration 50% No A A A No
* 1. Shows the initial value when C6-01 is set to 0 (default). If C6-01 is set to 1 or 2, the initial value is 120%
6-23
Time Chart
The following figure shows the frequency characteristics when L3-01 is set to 1.
Output current
Time
Output frequency
*1.
*2.
Setting Precautions
• If the motor capacity is small compared to the Inverter capacity or if the inverter is operated using the fac-
tory settings and the motor stalls, lower the set value of L3-02.
• If using the motor in the constant power range, L3-02 will be automatically lowered to prevent stalling.
6 L3-03 is the limit value to prevent the stall prevention level in the constant power range from being
reduced more than necessary (see Fig 6.28).
• Set the parameters as a percentage taking the inverter rated current to be 100%.
Stall prevention level during
acceleration
Output frequency
E1-06
Base Frequency (FA)
6-24
Preventing Overvoltage During Deceleration
The stall prevention during deceleration function lengthens the deceleration time automatically with respect to
the DC-bus voltage to avoid overvoltage tripping.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
Stall prevention selection during deceleration function selec-
L3-04 1 No Q Q Q Q
tion
6-25
Setting Example
An example of stall prevention during deceleration when L3-04 is set to 1 is shown below.
Time
Deceleration time
(set value)
Setting Precautions
• The stall prevention level during deceleration differs depending on the inverter rated voltage and input
voltage. Refer to the following table for details.
Inverter Rated/Input Voltage Stall Prevention Level during Deceleration (V)
200 V class 380
E1-01 ≥ 400 V 760
400 V class
E1-01 < 400 V 660
• When using the braking option (braking resistor, braking resistor units, and braking units), be sure to set
parameter L3-04 to 0 or 3.
• When a braking option is used and the deceleration time shall be optimized (shorter than setting of C1-02/
6-26
Adjusting Frequency References
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
H3-01 Multi-function analog input terminal A1 signal level selection 0 No A A A A
H3-02 Frequency reference terminal A1 input gain 100.0% Yes A A A A
H3-03 Frequency reference terminal A1 input bias 0.0% Yes A A A A
* 1. These parameters are only accessable when an analog input option card (AI-14B) is mounted and F2-01=0 (input selection: 3 channel indi-
vidual). The standard analog inputs are then replaced by the the 3 channels of the analog input accordingly (Channel 1: A1, Channel 2: A2,
Channel 3: A3).
Set
Control Methods
Open Closed
6
Function 100% of Contents V/f with
Value V/f Loop Loop
PG
Vector Vector
0 Frequency Bias Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes
D Frequency Bias 2 Maximum output frequency Yes Yes Yes Yes
6-27
Refer to Fig 6.30 for adjusting the signal using the gain and bias functions.
Frequency Gain: 170%
reference Bias: 30%
100%
Gain: 100%
Bias: 0%
Gain: 0%
Bias: 100%
0%
0V 10V Input voltage (current)
(4mA) (20mA)
6 The frequency gain for terminal A1 is the product of H3-02 and gain which is input at terminal A2 (or channel
3 of AI-14B). For example, when H3-02 is set to 100% and the terminal A2 (or channel 3 of AI-14B) input is
5 V, the frequency reference gain will be 50%.
Frequency reference
100 % H3-02
50 % H3-02 x 0.5
6-28
Adjusting Frequency Bias Using an Analog Input
For example, if H3-02 is 100%, H3-03 is 0%, and the terminal A2 input is 1 V, the frequency reference when
0 V is input to A1 will be 10% of the maximum output frequency (E1-04).
Frequency reference
H3-02
10 %
Bias
0V 10 V
Terminal A1 input voltage
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d3-01 Jump frequency 1 0.0 Hz No A A A A
6-29
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d3-02 Jump frequency 2 0.0 Hz No A A A A
d3-03 Jump frequency 3 0.0 Hz No A A A A
d3-04 Jump frequency width 1.0 Hz No A A A A
The relationship between the output frequency and the jump frequency reference is shown in Fig 6.35.
Output frequency
Jump frequency
width d3-04
Jump frequency
width d3-04
Jump frequency
width d3-04
Setting Precautions
• Set the jump frequencies according to the following formula: d3-01 ≥ d3-02 ≥ d3-03 > Analog input.
• When parameters d3-01 to d3-03 are set to 0 Hz, the jump frequency function is disabled.
6-30
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
H6-01 Pulse train input function selection 0 No A A A A
H6-02 Pulse train input scaling 1440 Hz Yes A A A A
H6-03 Pulse train input gain 100.0% Yes A A A A
H6-04 Pulse train input bias 0.0% Yes A A A A
H6-05 Pulse train input filter time 0.10 s Yes A A A A
The block diagram in Fig 6.37 explains the functioning of the pulse train input.
Gain and bias
Filter
Master speed frequency
Cycle
measurement PID feedback
The principle for setting the input gain and bias is the same as for the analog inputs (refer to page 6-27). The
only difference is that the input signal is not a voltage or a current but a pulse train.
6-31
Speed Limit (Frequency Reference Limits)
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d2-01 Frequency reference upper limit 100.0% No A A A A
Related Parameters
Control Methods
6
Change
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d2-02 Frequency reference lower limit 0.0% No A A A A
d2-03 Master speed reference lower limit 0.0% No A A A A
Fig 6.38 Analog Input A2 Characteristics for Frequency Reference Lower Limit
If parameter d2-02 and terminal A2 output frequency lower level have been set at the same time, the larger set
value will become the frequency lower limit.
6-32
Frequency Detection
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L4-01 Speed agreement detection level 0.0 Hz No A A A A
L4-02 Speed agreement detection width 2.0 Hz No A A A A
L4-03 Speed agreement detection level (±) 0.0 Hz No A A A A
L4-04 Speed agreement detection width (±) 2.0 Hz No A A A A
Setting Precautions
• With L4-01 an absolute speed agreement level is set, i.e. a speed agreement is detected in both directions
(FWD and REV).
• With L4-03 a signed speed agreement level is set, i.e. a speed agreement is detected only in the set direc-
tion (positive level → FWD direction, negative level → REV direction).
6-33
Time Charts
The following table shows the time charts for each of the speed agreement functions.
Related L4-01: Speed Agree Level L4-03: Speed Agree Level +/–
parameter L4-02: Speed Agree Width L4-04: Speed Agree Width
Frequency Frequency
reference reference
L4-02 L4-04
fref/fout Agree 1 OFF ON fref/fout Agree 2 OFF ON
(Multi-function output setting = 13)
(Multi-function output setting = 2)
L4-02
OFF ON OFF ON
fout/fset Agree 1 fout/fset Agree 2
L4-01 L4-03
Output fre- Output fre-
quency or quency or
motor speed motor speed
L4-01
L4-02
L4-01 L4-03
Output fre- Output fre-
quency or quency or
motor speed motor speed
L4-01
L4-02
Freq. Detection 2
OFF ON OFF ON
Freq. Detection 4
(Multi-function output setting = 5) (Multi-function output setting = 16)
6-34
Related L4-01: Speed Agree Level L4-03: Speed Agree Level +/–
parameter L4-02: Speed Agree Width L4-04: Speed Agree Width
Frequency (FOUT) Detection 5
(L4-01 < | Output frequency |)
L4-02
L4-01
Output fre-
quency or
motor speed
Frequency L4-01
Detection
L4-02
ON
Freq. Detection 5
OFF
(Multi-function output setting = 36)
Baseblock N.O.
6-35
Improving the Operation Performance
Related Pameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C3-01 Slip compensation gain 0.0* 1 Yes A No A No
200 ms
C3-02 Slip compensation delay time No A No A No
*1
C3-03 Slip compensation limit 200% No A No A No
C3-04 Slip compensation during regeneration 0 No A No A No
C3-05 Output voltage limit operation selection 0 No No No A A
* 1. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (The V/f control factory settings are given.).
6 Set C3-01 to 1.0 to compensate the slip depending on the actual torque output status using the rated slip
(E2-02/E4-02) as reference.
Adjust the slip compensation gain using the following procedure.
1. With Open Loop Vector control Set E2-02 (Motor Rated Slip) and E2-03 (Motor No-load Current) cor-
rectly. The motor rated slip can be calculated using the values on the motor nameplate and the following
formula:
6-36
Adjusting Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time Constant (C3-02)
The slip compensation delay time constant is set in ms.
The setting value of C3-02 depends on the control method. The factory settings are:
• V/f control without PG: 2000 ms
• Open loop vector control: 200 ms
Normally, there is no need to change these settings. When the slip compensation response is low, lower the set
value. When the speed is unstable, increase the set value.
Output frequency
6-37
Torque Compensation for Sufficient Torque at Start and Low-speed
Operation
The torque compensation function detects a rising motor load, and increases the output torque.
In V/f control the inverter calculates the motor primary loss voltage using the terminal resistance value (E2-
05) and adjusts the output voltage (V) to compensate insufficient torque at startup and during low-speed oper-
ation.
The compensation voltage is calculated by the calculated Motor primary voltage loss × parameter C4-01.
In Open Loop Vector control the motor excitation current and the torque producing current are calculated and
controlled separately. The torque compensation affects the torque producing current only.
The torque producing current is calculated by the calculated torque reference × C4-01.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C4-01 Torque compensation gain 1.00 Yes A A A No
200 ms
C4-02 Torque compensation delay time constant *1 No A A A No
* 1. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed (V/f control factory settin is given).
V/f control:
• If the cable is very long, increase the set value.
• If the motor capacity is smaller than the Inverter capacity (max. applicable motor capacity), increase the
set value.
• If the motor is vibrating, reduce the set value.
Setting precautions:
• Adjust this parameter so that the output current during low-speed rotation does not exceed the Inverter
rated output current range.
• Adjust the value in steps of 0.05 only.
6-38
Adjusting the Torque Compensation Primary Delay Time Constant (C4-02)
The setting value of C4-02 depends on the control method. The factory settings are:
• V/f control without PG: 200 ms
• V/f control with PG: 200 ms
• Open loop vector control: 20 ms
Normally, there is no need to change this setting. If adjustments are necessary do the following:
• If the motor is vibrating, increase the set value.
• If the torque response is slow, decrease the set value.
OFF
C5-01/03
Frequency + + Delay
P Torque
Reference - Timer Reference
+
C5-06
I Torque
Motor Limits
Speed C5-02/04 C5-08
I-Limit
6-39
In V/f control with PG the ASR adjusts the output frequency in order to eliminate the deviation between the
speed reference and the measured speed (PG feedback). Fig 6.42 shows the ASR structure for V/f control with
PG.
Frequency Output
Reference Frequency
+ +
C5-01/03
+
Motor
Speed P
- + +
I C5-05
ASR Limit
C5-02/04
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C5-01 ASR proportional (P) gain 1 20.00 * 1 Yes No A No A
6
* 1. When the control method is changed, these values are reset to the factory settings for the selected control mode (V/f with PG control
mode factory settings are given).
6-40
ASR Gain and Integral Time Adjustments for Closed Loop Vector Control
General Procedure
1. Operate the motor at zero speed.
2. Increase C5-01 (ASR proportional gain 1) to a level where no oscillation in the motor speed occurs.
3. Decrease C5-04 (ASR integral time 2) to a level where no oscillation in the motor speed occurs.
4. Increase the speed and observe the motor speed. If oscillations occur at any speed the gain must be
decreased and/or the integral time must be increased.
5. If the speed is stable at all speeds the adjustment is completed.
Fine Adjustments
When an even finer ASR adjustment is required, adjust the gain and integral time while observing the speed
waveform using the analog output terminals FM and AM. The necessary parameter settings are shown in the
following table.
Parameter Setting Explanation
H4-01 Monitor selection (terminal FM) 20
Settings that allow multi-function analog output 1 to be used to
H4-02 Gain (terminal FM) 100%
monitor the frequency reference after soft starter.
H4-03 Bias (terminal FM) 0.0%
H4-04 Monitor selection (terminal AM) 5
Settings that allow multi-function analog output 2 to be used to
H4-05 Gain (terminal AM) 100%
monitor the motor speed.
H4-06 Bias (terminal AM) 0.0%
H4-07 Analog output 1 signal level selection 1
This setting allows a 0 to ± 10 V signal range to be monitored.
H4-08 Analog output 2 signal level selection 1
The multi-function analog outputs have the following functions with these parameter settings.
• Analog output 1 (terminal FM): Outputs frequency reference after the soft starter (Accel./decel. ramp and
S-curve) (0 to ±10 V).
• Analog output 2 (terminal AM): Outputs actual motor speed (0 to ±10 V).
6
Adjusting ASR Proportional Gain 1 (C5-01)
This gain adjusts the responsiveness of the speed control (ASR). The responsiveness is increased when this
setting is increased. Oscillation will occur if this setting is increased too much. See Fig 6.43 for details.
Time
If undershooting occurs:
Decrease C5-03 and/or increase C5-04
6-41
Different Gain Settings for Low-speed and High-speed
Switch between low-speed and high-speed gain when oscillation occurs because of resonance with the
mechanical system at low speed or high speed. The gain and integral time can be switched according to the
motor speed, as shown in Fig 6.44.
P,I P=C5-01
I=C5-02
P=C5-03
I=C5-04
Motor
0 C5-07 Speed
If C5-07 is set to 0, the gain in C5-01 and the integral time in C5-02 are used for the whole speed range.
6
Adjust these parameters at normal operating speed. Increase C5-01 (ASR gain 1) and decrease C5-02 (ASR
integral time 1) as long as no oscillation occurs.
C5-03 value
C5-02 C5-02
6-42
ASR Gain and Integral Time Adjustments for V/f control with PG
When using V/f control with PG, set the ASR gain and the integral time at E1-09 (minimum output frequency)
and E1-04 (maximum output frequency). See Fig 6.46 for details.
P,I
P=C5-01
I=C5-02
P=C5-03
I=C5-04
0 Motor Speed
E1-09 E1-04
Min. Output Max. Output
Frequency Frequency
Fig 6.46 Speed Control Gain Integral Time Adjustment for V/f Control with PG
Fine Adjustments 6
When an even finer ASR adjustment is required, adjust the gain while observing the motor speed. The adjust-
ment procedure is the same as for vector control.
6-43
Hunting-Prevention Function
The hunting-prevention function suppresses hunting when the motor is operating with a light load. This func-
tion can be used in the V/f control modes only.
If high response has the priority to vibration suppression this function should be disabled (n1-01 = 0).
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
n1-01 Hunting-prevention function selection 1 No A A No No
n1-02 Hunting-prevention gain 1.00 No A A No No
6-44
Stabilizing Speed (Automatic Frequency Regulator)
The speed feedback detection control (AFR) function controls the stability of the speed when a load is sud-
denly applied or removed. It calculates the amount of speed fluctuation using the torque current (Iq) feedback
value and compensates the output frequency with the amount of fluctuation.
fref fout
Iq
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
n2-01 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) gain 1.00 No No No A No
n2-02 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) time constant 50 ms No No No A No
n2-03 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) time constant 2 750 ms No No No A No
6-45
Machine Protection
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L7-01 Forward drive torque limit 200% * 1 No No No A A
L7-02 Reverse drive torque limit 200% *1 No No No A A
L7-03 Forward regenerative torque limit 200% *1 No No No A A
L7-04 Reverse regenerative torque limit 200% *1 No No No A A
L7-06 Torque limit time constant 200 ms No No No A No
L7-07 Torque limit operation during accel./decel. 0 No No No A No
L7-01
L7-04
Forward
Reverse Drive
Regenerative
Output Speed
Forward
Reverse
Regenerative
Drive
L7-03
L7-02
6-46
Set the Torque Limit Value Using an Analog Input
The analog input A2 can be used to input several torque limits. The table below shows the possible analog
input settings (H3-09) for the torque limit function.
Control Methods
Set V/f Open Closed
Function 100% of Contents
Value V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
10 Positive torque limit Motor rated torque No No Yes Yes
11 Negative torque limit Motor rated torque No No Yes Yes
12 Regenerative torque limit Motor rated torque No No Yes Yes
15 Positive/negative torque limit Motor rated torque No No Yes Yes
The analog input terminal A2 signal level is factory-set as follows: 4 to 20 mA (i.e. if 20 mA are input the
torque is limited to 100% of the motor rated torque). Fig 6.49 shows the relationship between the torque lim-
its.
Output torque
Fig 6.50 Torque Limit Using Parameters and an Analog Input Together
6-47
Setting Precautions
• When the output torque reaches the torque limit, control and compensation of the motor speed is disabled
to prevent the output torque from exceeding the torque limit. The torque limit has the priority.
• When using the torque limit for hoist applications, do not carelessly lower the torque limit value, as this
may result in motor stalling.
• When using an analog input for torque limit setting, an analog input value of 10 V/20 mA is equal to a
torque limit of 100% of the motor rated torque. To raise the torque limit value at an analog input of 10 V/
20 mA for instance to 150% of the rated torque, set the input terminal gain to 150.0 (%). Adjust the gain
for multi-function analog input terminal A2 using H3-10.
• The torque limit accuracy is ±5% at an output frequency of 10 Hz or above. When output frequency is
lower than 10 Hz, the accuracy is lowered.
Related Parameters
6 Parameter
No.
Name
Factory
Setting
Change
during
Opera- V/f
Control Methods
V/f with
Open Closed
Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L3-05 Stall prevention selection during run function selection 1 No A A No No
L3-06 Stall prevention level during run 150% *1 No A A No No
* 1. Shows the initial value when C6-01 is set to 0 (default). If C6-01 is set to 1 or 2, the initial value is 120%
Fig 6.51 Stall Prevention Level during Operation Using an Analog Input
If the motor capacity is smaller than the Inverter capacity or the motor stalls when operating at the factory set-
tings, lower the stall prevention level during operation.
6-48
Motor Torque Detection
If an excessive load is applied to the machinery (overtorque) or the load drops suddenly (undertorque), an
alarm signal can be output to one of the digital output terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, or M5-M6.
To use the torque detection function, set one of the multi-function digital outputs (H2-01 to H2-03) to B, 17,
18, 19 (overtorque/undertorque detection NO/NC).
Overtorque/undertorque is detected by:
• observing the output current in V/f control with or without PG (the inverter rated output current is equal to
100%).
• observing the torque reference value in Open Loop and Closed Loop Vector control (the motor rated torque
is equal to 100%).
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L6-01 Torque detection selection 1 0 No A A A A
L6-02 Torque detection level 1 150% No A A A A
L6-03 Torque detection time 1 0.1 s No A A A A
L6-04 Torque detection selection 2 0 No A A A A
L6-05 Torque detection level 2 150% No A A A A
L6-06 Torque detection time 2 0.1 s No A A A A
Set
Value
Function
V/f
Control Methods
V/f
with
Open Closed
Loop Loop
6
PG Vector Vector
Overtorque/undertorque detection 1 NO
B Yes Yes Yes Yes
(NO contact: Overtorque / undertorque detected when relay is ON)
Overtorque/undertorque detection 1 NC
17 Yes Yes Yes Yes
(NO contact: Overtorque / undertorque detected when relay is OFF)
Overtorque/undertorque detection 2 NO
18 Yes Yes Yes Yes
(NO contact: Overtorque / undertorque detected when relay is ON)
Overtorque/undertorque detection 2 NC
19 Yes Yes Yes Yes
(NO contact: Overtorque / undertorque detected when relay is OFF)
6-49
L6-01 and L6-04 Set Values and Operator Display
The relationship between alarms displayed on the digital operator when overtorque or undertorque is detected,
and the set values in L6-01 and L6-04, is shown in the following table.
Operator Display
Set Overtorque/ Overtorque/
Function
Value Undertorque Undertorque
Detection 1 Detection 2
0 Overtorque/undertorque detection disabled. – –
1 Overtorque detection only with speed agree; operation continues (warning is output). OL3 flashes OL4 flashes
2 Overtorque detected continuously during operation; operation continues (warning is output). OL3 flashes OL4 flashes
3 Overtorque detection only with speed agree; output is stopped upon detection. OL3 lights up OL4 lights up
4 Overtorque detected continuously during operation; output is stopped upon detection. OL3 lights up OL4 lights up
5 Undertorque detection only with speed agree; operation continues (warning is output). UL3 flashes UL4 flashes
6 Undertorque detected continuously during operation; operation continues (warning is output). UL3 flashes UL4 flashes
7 Undertorque detection only with speed matching; output is stopped upon detection. UL3 lights up UL4 lights up
8 Undertorque detected continuously during operation; output is stopped upon detection. UL3 lights up UL4 lights up
Timing Charts
Fig 6.52 and Fig 6.53 show the timing charts for overtorque and undertorque detection.
Motor current (output torque)
L6-02 or L6-05
Overtorque detection 1 NO
or overtorque detection 2 NO
L6-02 or L6-05
L6-03 or
L6-03 or L6-06
Undertorque detection 1 NO L6-06
or undertorque detection 2 NO
6-50
Changing Overtorque and Undertorque Detection Levels Using an Analog Input
If parameter H3-09 (Analog Input Terminal A2 Function Selection) is set to 7 (overtorque/undertorque detec-
tion level), the overtorque/undertorque detection level can be changed using the analog input A2 (refer to Fig
6.54).
Only the overtorque/undertorque detection level 1 can be changed using the analog input. Overtorque/under-
torque detection level 2 cannot be changed by an analog input signal.
Detection level
(4 mA)
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
No Q
PG
Q
Vector Vector
Q Q
6
1.90 A
E4-01 Motor 2 rated current No A A A A
*1
L1-01 Motor protection selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
L1-02 Motor protection time constant 1.0 min No A A A A
* 1. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (the value shown is for a 200 V Class inverter with 0.4kW)
6-51
Setting Motor Overload Protection Characteristics (L1-01)
Set the overload protection function in L1-01 according to the used motor.
The induction motor's cooling abilities vary with the motor type. Consequently, you must select the electronic
thermal protection characteristics.
Set L1-01 to:
0: to disable the thermal motor protection function.
1: to enable the thermal motor protection for a fan cooled general purpose motor (self-cooled).
2: to enable the thermal motor protection for an inverter motor (externally cooled).
3: to enable the thermal motor protection for a special vector motor (externally cooled).
Cold start
Hot start
Setting Precautions
• If multiple motors are connected to one inverter, set parameter L1-01 to 0 (disabled). To protect each of the
motors, use a control circuit that switches off the inverter output when one of the motors overheats.
• With applications where the power supply is often turned ON and OFF, there is a risk that the motor cannot
be protected even if this parameter has been set to 1 (enabled), because the thermal value will be reset after
inverter power supply switch off.
• For safe overload tripping, set the value in parameter L1-02 to a low setting.
• When using a general-purpose motor (standard motor), the cooling ability will be lowered by f1/4 (fre-
quency). Consequently, a low output frequency may cause motor overload protection (OL1) to occur, even
when the output current is below the rated current. If the motor is operated at the rated current at a low fre-
quency, use a special motor which is externally cooled.
6-52
Motor Overheating Protection Using PTC Thermistor Inputs
This function provides a motor overheating protection using a thermistor (PTC characteristic – Positive Tem-
perature Coefficient) which is built into the windings of each motor phase. The thermistor must be connected
to an analog input.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L1-03 Alarm operation selection during motor overheating 3 No A A A A
L1-04 Motor overheating operation selection 1 No A A A A
L1-05 Motor temperature input filter time constant 0.20 s No A A A A
6
Tr: Temperature threshold value
Temperature
* The shown resistance value is for one motor phase. Normally the 3 resistors are connected in series.
6-53
Terminal Connection
The terminal connection for the motor overheat function is shown in Fig 6.57. The following points have to be
considered:
• Pin 2 of the DIP-switch S1 on the control terminal board has to be turned to OFF for voltage input at termi-
nal A2. The factory setting is ON (current input).
• Parameter H3-09 has to be set to “E”
• Parameter H3-08 (analog input terminal A2 signal level) has to be set to 0 (0-10V input).
MA
+V (15V, 20mA) MB
MC
Branch resistance
18kOhm*
M1
A2 , 0-10V M2
M3
PTC thermistor M4
AC M5
M6
*1The resistance value of 18 kΩ is only valid when a 3-phase PTC with the characteristic shown on the pre-
vious page is used.
6
Limiting Motor Rotation Direction and Output Phase Rotation
If the motor reverse rotation is prohibited, a reverse run command will not be accepted, even if it is input. Use
this setting for applications in which reverse motor rotation can cause problems (e.g., fans, pumps, etc.)
In V/f and Open Loop Vector control mode it is also possible to change the output phase order by changing a
parameter. This is much easier and faster than changing the wiring if the motor rotational direction is wrong. If
this function is used a prohibition of reverse direction is not possible.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Param-
Setting Factory during V/f Open Closed
eter Name Description
Range Setting Opera- V/f with Loop Loop
Number
tion PG Vector Vector
0: Reverse enabled
Prohibition of reverse A A A A
b1-04 1: Reverse disabled 0 or 2* 1 0 No
operation
2: Output Phase Rotation A No A No
* 1. The setting range is 0 and 1 for Closed Loop Vector control and V/f control with PG.
6-54
Automatic Restart
This section explains functions for continuing or automatically restarting inverter operation after a momentary
power loss.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L2-01 Momentary power loss detection 0 No A A A A
0.1 s
L2-02 Momentary power loss ride through time *1 No A A A A
* 1. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (the value shown is for a 200 V class Inverter with 0.4 kW)
* 2. These values are for a 200 V Class Inverter. For a 400 V Class Inverter the values are double.
6
Setting Precautions
• Fault output signals are not output during momentary power loss recovery.
• To continue Inverter operation after the power has been restored, make the settings so that RUN com-
mands from the control main circuit terminal are stored even while power is suspended.
• If the momentary power loss operation selection is set to 0 (Disabled), an alarm UV1 (main circuit under-
voltage) will be detected when the momentary power loss exceeds 15 ms during operation.
6-55
Speed Search
The speed search function detect the actual speed of a motor that is coasting without control and restart it
smoothly from that speed. It is also activated after momentary power loss detection when L2-01 is set to
enabled.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b3-01 Speed search selection (current detection or speed calculation) 2*1 No A A A No
b3-02 Speed search operating current (current detection) 120% *1 No A No A No
b3-03 Speed search deceleration time (current detection) 2.0 sec No A No A No
b3-05 Speed search wait time (current detection or speed calculation) 0.2 sec No A A A A
b3-14 Speed search rotation selection direction 1 No A A A No
0.3 sec
L2-04 Voltage recovery time No A A A A
*3
* 1. The factory setting will cahnge when the control mode is changed (V/f control factory settings are given).
* 2. The given factory setting is valid if Heavy Duty is selected (C6-01=0, default setting). If Normal Duty 1 or 2 is selected (C6-01=1 or 2) the factory setting
will be 120%.
* 3. The factory setting depeds on the Inverter capacity. The value for a 200 V class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given.
6-56
Setting Precautions
• When both external search commands 1 and 2 are set for the multi-function digital inputs, an OPE03
(invalid multi-function digital input selection) alarm will occur. Set either external search command 1 or
external search command 2.
• If speed search during startup is selected when using V/f control with PG or Closed Loop Vector control
the unit will start from the frequency detected by PG.
• If performing speed search using external search commands, design the control circuit so that the run com-
mand and external search command are both ON. These two commands must be kept on, at least for the
time set in parameter L2-03.
• If the Inverter output is equipped with a contactor, set the contactor operation delay time in the Speed
Search Wait Time (b3-05). The factory setting is 0.2 s. When not using a contactor, you can reduce the
search time to 0.0 s. After waiting for the speed search wait time, the Inverter starts the speed search.
• Parameter b3-02 (current detection level for search completion) is effective only when current detection
speed search is selected. When the current falls below the detection level, the speed search is supposed to
be as completed, and the motor accelerates or decelerates to the set frequency.
• If an overcurrent (OC) is detected when using speed search after power recovery, lengthen the Minimum
Baseblock Time (L2-03).
6-57
Speed Calculation
Search at Startup
The time chart for when speed search at startup and speed search to multi-function input terminals is shown
below.
OFF ON
Deceleration time set in b3-03 Set frequency refer-
Run command
ence
Starts using
calculated speed
Output frequency
b3-02
Output current
0.7 to 1.0 s *Lower limit set using Speed Search Wait Time (b3-05)
6
Output frequency
Output current
10 ms
Fig 6.59 Speed Search after Power Loss with Loss Time < L2-03
Output frequency
Output current
10 ms
Note: If the frequency immediately before the baseblock is low or the power supply break time is long, operation may be the
same as the search in case 1.
Fig 6.60 Speed Search after Power Loss with Loss Time > L2-03
6-58
Current Detection
Output frequency
b3-02
Output current
Output frequency
b3-02
speed search operating current
Output current 6
*1Baseblock time may be reduced by the output frequency immediately
before baseblock.
Minimum baseblock time (L2-03)*1 *2After AC power supply recovery, the inverter waits for the minimum
Speed Search Wait Time (b2-03).
*2
Fig 6.62 Speed Search after Power Loss Time < L2-03
Output frequency
b3-02
Speed search operating time
Output current
Speed search wait time (b3-05)
Fig 6.63 Speed Search after Power Loss with Loss Time > L2-03
6-59
Speed Search Retry Function
With the calculation type speed search the speed is detected with the motor residual current before a voltage is
applied to the motor. In case of very low current values (as with special motors) the detected speed can differ
from the actual speed of the motor. This results in a very high current when the voltage is applied as the
inverter output frequency differs from the actual motor frequency.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L4-05 Operation when frequency reference is missing 0 No A A A A
L4-06 Output frequency adjustment after freq. reference loss 80% No A A A A
L4-12 Frequency reference detection width 10% No A A A A
6-60
Restarting Operation After Transient Fault (Auto Restart Function)
If an Inverter fault occurs during operation, the Inverter will perform self-diagnosis. If no fault is detected, the
Inverter will restart automatically. This is called the auto restart function.
Set the number of allowed auto restarts in parameter L5-01.
The auto restart function can be applied to the following faults.
• OC (Overcurrent) • RH (Braking resistor overheated)
• GF (Ground fault) • RR (Braking transistor fault)
• PUF (DC bus fuse blown) • OL1 (Motor overload)
• OV (Main circuit overvoltage) • OL2 (Inverter overload)
*1 • OH1 (Motor overheat)
• UV1 (Main Circuit Undervoltage, Main Circuit MC Operation Failure)
• PF (Main circuit voltage fault) • OL3 (Overtorque 1)
• LF (Output phase failure) • OL4 (Overtorque 2)
* 1. When L2-01 is set to 1 or 2 (continue operation during momentary power loss).
If a fault that is not listed above occurs, the protection function will operate and the auto restart function will
not work.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter
No.
Name
Factory
Setting
during
Opera-
tion
V/f
V/f with
PG
Open Closed
Loop Loop
Vector Vector
6
L5-01 Number of auto restart attempts 0 No A A A A
L5-02 Auto restart operation selection 0 No A A A A
Application Precautions
The number of auto restarts counter is reset under the following conditions:
• After auto restart, normal operation has continued for 10 minutes.
• After the protection operation has been performed and an fault reset has been input.
• After the power supply voltage has been cycled.
6-61
Operation Selection After Cooling Fan Fault
Use the parameter setting to select the operation of the motor after a cooling fan fault occurs. This function can
be used for times when a motor should not be stopped quickly (with an emergency stop.)
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-32 OH1 detection of Inverter’s cooling fan 1 No A A A A
The following table describes the operation of the motor and the display of the Digital Operator in accordance
with the settings of the L8-32 if a cooling fan fault occurred.
Setting Multi-function Digital
Fault Digital Operator Motor Operation
value Output
Cooling Fin Overheat OH1 Coast to stop Fault
0
Inverter’s Cooling Fin FAN (flashing) Continue operation* 1 Alarm
6 If L8-32 is set to 0, be sure to set H2-01 to H2-03 multi-function digital outputs to 10 (Alarm)
or to 3D (Inverter’s cooling fan fault.) If a cooling fan fault occurs, stop the Inverter immedi-
ately and replace the cooling fan. If the Inverter continues to run while a cooling fan fault
IMPORTANT occurs, the Inverter’s cooling ability will be affected and the Inverter’s internal temperature
will increase and shorten the Inverter’s life time. During a cooling fan fault, the cooling fan
stops for about 3 seconds every minute (interval operation.)
6-62
Inverter Protection
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-01 Protection selection for internal DB resistor (Type ERF) 0 No A A A A
The most likely causes of RH (Mounted braking resistor overheating) faults are that the deceleration
time is too short or that the motor regeneration energy is too large. In these cases, lengthen the
INFO
deceleration time or replace the Braking Resistor with one with a higher braking capacity.
6
This function is not applicable for protecting external braking resistors. When external braking resis-
tors are used together with the internal braking chopper, L8-01 should be set to 0 to disable the inter-
IMPORTANT nal braking resistor protection.
6-63
Inverter Overheat Protection
This function provides overheat protection for inverter-mounted braking resistors (Model: ERF-150WJ ).
When overheating of a mounted braking resistor is detected, an fault RH (mounted braking resistor overheat-
ing) is displayed on the Digital Operator, and the motor coasts to stop.
The fault can be output using one of the multi-function digital outputs as well. Therefore one of the parameters
H2-01 to H2-03 has to be set to D.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level 95°C No A A A A
L8-03 Inverter overheat (OH) pre-alarm operation selection 3 No A A A A
6 over 10 scans (approximately 10 seconds). If the integrated ΔV value of any consecutive ten scan range is
greater than the voltage determined by multiplying L8-06 times the drives rated OV Trip point (410Vdc/
820Vdc), a PF fault will occur and the Drive will coast to stop
DC Bus L8-06
Voltage
10 seconds
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-05 Input open-phase protection selection 1 No A A A A
6-64
Output Open Phase Protection
This function detects an open output phase by comparing the output current value of each phase with an inter-
nal set output open phase detection level (5% of inverter rated current). The detection will not work when the
output frequency is below 2% of the base frequency (E1-13).
Three settings are available:
• L8-07=0, output open phase detection disabled
• L8-07=1, the loss of one phase is detected only
• L8-07=2, the loss of 2 or 3 phases is detected as well
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-07 Output open-phase protection selection 0 No A A A A
The function should be disabled if the motor capacity is very low compared to the inverter capacity. Otherwise
wrong output open phase faults might be detected.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-10 Cooling fan control selection 0 No A A A A
L8-11 Cooling fan control delay time 60 s No A A A A
6-65
Selecting the Cooling Fan Control
Using parameter L8-10 two modes can be selected:
0: The fan is ON only when the inverter output is ON, i.e. a voltage is output. This is the factory setting.
1: The fan is ON whenever the inverter power supply is switched ON.
If L8-10 is set to 0, the turn OFF delay time for the fan can be set in parameter L8-11. After a stop command
the inverter waits for this time before switching OFF the cooling fan. The factory setting is 60 sec.
100
Output Current in % of the
80
Rated Current
60 IP00
IP20
40
20
6 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Temperature (°C)
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-12 Ambient temperature 45 °C No A A A A
Since the inverter has no IP00/ NEMA 1 (IP20) detection, with NEMA 1 (IP20) units the ambient tem-
perature value in L8-12 has to be set 5° higher than the actual ambient temperature.
IMPORTANT
6-66
OL2 Characteristics at Low Speed
At output frequencies below 6 Hz the overload capability of the inverter is lower than at higher speeds, i.e. an
OL2 fault (inverter overload) may occur even if the current is below the normal OL2 current level (see Fig.
6.61).
OL2 Detection Level*
150% (120%)*
for 1 min.
75% (60%)*
for 1 min.
Output
Speed
-6 Hz 0 Hz 6 Hz
* Note that the OL2 level depends on the setting of C6-01. The values are given for
Heavy Duty. The values in parentheses are for Normal Duty 1 or 2.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
L8-15 OL2 characteristics selection at low speeds
6-67
Input Terminal Functions
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-01 Reference selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
b1-02 RUN command source selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
Local/Remote switching can also be performed using the LOCAL/REMOTE key on the Digital Oper-
ator. When the Local/Remote function has been set for one external terminal, the LOCAL/REMOTE
6 INFO
key function on the Digital Operator will be disabled.
Timing Chart
6-68
The timing chart when using a baseblock command is shown in Fig 6.67.
Forward operation/Stop
Input Cleared
Baseblock command
Frequency reference
Coast to a stop
When a contactor between inverter and motor is used, always perform a base block command before
opening the contactor.
IMPORTANT
If a digital input is programmed for this function (H1- =C) the analog input A2 can be enabled or disabled
by switching the digital input ON/OFF (ON – Analog Input A2 enabled).
Drive Enable/Disable
Control Methods
Set V/f Open Closed
Function
Value V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
6A Enable/Disable drive (ON: drive enabled) Yes Yes Yes Yes
If a digital input is programmed for this function (H1- =6A) the drive can be enabled or disabled by
switching the digital input ON/OFF (ON – Drive enabled).
6-69
If the input is switched OFF while a RUN command is active the inverter will stop using the stopping method
set in b1-03.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d4-01 Frequency reference hold function selection 0 No A A A A
6-70
Timing Chart
The timing chart when using Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp Hold commands is shown in Fig 6.68.
Ramp Hold
Frequency reference
Output frequency
Hold Hold
The change of the output frequency depends on the acceleration and deceleration times. Be sure to set b1-02
(Run command selection) to 1 (Control circuit terminal).
Precautions
Setting Precautions
If multi-function input terminals S3 to S7 are set as follows, an OPE3 alarm will occur:
• Only either the UP command or DOWN command has been set.
• UP/DOWN commands and Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp Hold have been allocated at the same time.
6-71
Application Precautions
• Frequency references which use the UP/DOWN commands are limited by the frequency reference upper
and lower limits set in parameters d2-01 to d2-03. In this case the value from the input A1 becomes the fre-
quency reference lower limit. If using a combination of the frequency reference from terminal A1 and the
frequency reference lower limit set in either parameter d2-02 or d2-03, the larger limit value will become
the frequency reference lower limit.
• If the UP/DOWN commands are used as frequency reference and the run command is input the inverter
accelerates to the frequency reference lower limit which is set in d2-02.
• When using UP/DOWN commands, multi-step operations are disabled.
• When d4-01 (Frequency Reference Hold Function Selection) is set to 1, the frequency reference value
using the UP/DOWN functions is stored even after the power supply is turned OFF. When the power sup-
ply is turned ON and the run command is input, the motor accelerates to the frequency reference that has
been stored. To reset (i.e., to 0 Hz) the stored frequency reference, turn ON the UP or DOWN command
while the run command is OFF.
Inverter
Forward operation/
Stop
6
S1
Reverse operation/
S2 Stop
S3 Up command
Down command
S4
Digital input neu-
tral
SN
Frequency reference lower
0 to 10 V analog sig-
A1 limit
nal
AC
6-72
Output frequency
Upper limit (d2-01)
Accelerates to
lower limit
Same
frequency
Forward operation/stop
UP command Reference
frequency reset
DOWN command
Speed agree*
Power supply
* The speed agree signal turns ON when the motor is not accelerating/decelerating while
the run command is ON.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d4-02 Trim control speed limits 10% No A A A A
6-73
Trim Control Increase/Decrease Command and Frequency Reference
The frequency references using Trim Control Increase/Decrease command ON/OFF operations are shown
below.
Set Frequency Set Frequency
Frequency Reference Reference Reference HOLD
+ d4-02 - d4-02
Trim Control Increase Command
ON OFF ON OFF
Terminal
Trim Control Decrease Com-
OFF ON ON OFF
mand Terminal
Application Precautions
• Trim Control Increase/Decrease command is enabled when speed reference > 0 and the speed reference
source is an analog input (A1 or A2).
• When the (analog frequency reference value - d4-02) < 0, the frequency reference is set to 0.
• If only one of the Trim Control Increase command or Trim Control Decrease command has been set for a
digital input terminal, an OPE03 alarm will be displayed.
6 Sample/hold
command
Analog input
Frequency reference
Related Parameters
Precautions
When setting and executing sample and hold for analog frequency references, observe the following precau-
tions.
6-74
Setting Precautions
When using sample/hold of analog frequency reference, you cannot use the following commands at the same
time. Otherwise operation fault OPE03 (invalid multi-function input selection) will occur.
• Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp Hold command
• UP/DOWN command
• Trim Control Increase/Decrease command
Application Precautions
• When performing sample/hold of analog frequency reference, be sure to close the digital input for 100 ms
or more. If the sample/hold time is less than 100 ms, the frequency reference will not be held.
• The frequency reference value that is held will be deleted when the power supply is turned OFF.
Related Parameters
6
Set Value Function
V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
Operation source selection: Option Card/ Inverter (ON: Inverter settings in b1-01 and b1-
2 Yes Yes Yes Yes
02, OFF: Option Card)
Setting Precautions
To use the operation source switching function make the following settings:
• Set b1-01 (frequency reference source) to a value different from 3 (option card).
• Set b1-02 (RUN command source) to a value different from 3 (option card).
• Set one of the parameters H1-01 to H1-05 to 2.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d1-17 Jog frequency reference 6.00 Hz Yes Q Q Q Q
6-75
Multi-Function Digital Inputs (H1-01 to H1-05)
Control Methods
Set Value Function V/f Open Closed
V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
12 FJOG command (ON: Forward run at jog frequency d1-17) Yes Yes Yes Yes
13 RJOG command (ON: Reverse run at jog frequency d1-17) Yes Yes Yes Yes
Application Precautions
• Jog frequencies using FJOG and RJOG commands have the priority over other frequency references.
• When both FJOG command and RJOG commands are ON for 500 ms or longer at the same time, the
Inverter stops according to the setting in b1-03 (stopping method selection).
* 1. Sets the input level at which faults are detected. (NO contact: External fault when ON; NC contact: External fault when OFF).
* 2. Set the detection method to detect faults using either constant detection or detection during operation.
Constant detection: Detects while power is supplied to the Inverter.
Detection during operation: Detects only during Inverter operation.
6-76
Output Terminal Functions
The digital multifunction outputs can be set for several functions using the H2-01 to H2-03 parameters (termi-
nal M1 to M6 function selection). These functions are described in the following section.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
H2-01 Terminal M1-M2 function selection 0 No A A A A
H2-02 Terminal M3-M4 function selection 1 No A A A A
H2-03 Terminal M5-M6 function selection 2 No A A A A
6-77
Inverter Operation Ready (Setting: 6)
If a multifunction output is programmed for this function the output will be switched ON when the initialisa-
tion of the inverter at startup has finished without any faults.
6-78
Motor 2 Selection (Setting: 1C)
If a multifunction output is programmed for this function the output is switched ON when motor 2 is selected.
6-79
Monitor Parameters
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
H4-01 Monitor selection (terminal FM) 2 No A A A A
H4-02 Gain (terminal FM) 100% Yes Q Q Q Q
H4-03 Bias (terminal FM) 0.0% Yes A A A A
H4-04 Monitor selection (terminal AM) 3 No A A A A
H4-05 Gain (terminal AM) 50% Yes Q Q Q Q
H4-06 Bias (terminal AM) 0.0% Yes A A A A
H4-07 Analog output 1 signal level selection (FM) 0 No A A A A
H4-08 Analog output 2 signal level selection (AM) 0 No A A A A
6 Adjust the output current/voltage for multi-function analog output terminals FM-AC and AM-AC using the
gain and bias in H4-02, H4-03, H4-05, and H4-06.
The gain sets the analog output voltage/current value which is equal to 100% of the monitor item.
The bias sets the analog output voltage/current value which is equal to 0% of the monitor item.
Note that the maximum output voltage/current is 10V/20mA. A voltage/current higher than these values can
not be output.
6-80
Adjustment Examples
The influence of the settings of gain and bias on the analog output channel is shown on three examples in Fig
6.74.
Output voltage/
current
Gain: 170%
Bias: 30%
10V
Gain: 100%
Bias: 0%
3V/8.8mA
Gain: 0%
Bias: 100%
0V Monitor item
100% (e.g. Output Frequency)
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
H6-06 Pulse train monitor selection 2 Yes A A A A
H6-07 Pulse train monitor scaling 1440 Hz Yes A A A A
6-81
Application Precautions
When using the pulse monitor output, connect a peripheral device according to the following load conditions.
If the load conditions are different, there is a risk of characteristic insufficiency or damage to the inverter.
Sinking current
6-82
Individual Functions
Communications Specifications 6
The MEMOBUS communications specifications are shown in the following table.
Item Specifications
Interface RS-422, RS-485
Communications Cycle Asynchronous (Start-stop synchronization)
Baud rate: Select from 1,200, 2,400, 4,800, 9,600 and 19,200 bps.
Data length: 8 bits fixed
Communications Parameters
Parity: Select from even, odd, or none.
Stop bits: 1 bit fixed
Communications Protocol MEMOBUS
Number of Connectable Units 31 units max.
6-83
Communications Connection Terminal
The MEMOBUS communications use the following terminals: S+, S-, R+, and R-. Enable the terminating
resistance by turning ON pin 1 of switch S1 for the last Inverter (seen from the PLC) only.
S1 Terminating
RS-422A resistance
or RS-485
O 1
F
F 2
S1
1. Separate the communications cables from the main circuit cables and other wiring and power cables.
2. Use shielded cables for the communications cables, and use proper shield clamps
3. When using RS-485 communications, connect S+ to R+, and S- to R-, on the Inverter exterior. See pic-
IMPORTANT ture below.
6-84
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-01 Reference source selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
b1-02 RUN command Source Selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
MEMOBUS communications can perform the following operations regardless of the settings in b1-01 and
b1-02.
• Monitoring operation status of the inverter
• Setting and reading parameters
• Resetting faults
• Inputting multi-function commands. (An OR operation is performed between the multi-function com-
mands input from the PLC and commands input from digital input terminals S3 to S7.)
Message Format
In MEMOBUS communications, the master sends commands to the slave, and the slave responds. The mes-
sage format is configured for both sending and receiving as shown below, and the length of data packets 6
depends on the command (function) content.
Slave address
Function code
Data
Error check
H5-06
24 bits long setting 24 bits long 5 ms min.
Slave Address
Set the Inverter address from 0 to 31. If you set 0, commands from the master will be received by all slaves.
(Refer to “Broadcast Data” on the following pages.)
6-85
Function Code
The function code specifies commands. The three function codes shown in the table below are available.
Command Message Response Message
Function Code
Function
(Hexadecimal) Min. (Bytes) Max. (Bytes) Min. (Bytes) Max. (Bytes)
Data
Configure consecutive data by combining the memory register address (test code for a loop back address) and
the data the register contains. The data length changes depending on the command details.
Error Check
Faults during communications are detected using CRC-16 (cyclic redundancy check, checksum method).
The result of the checksum calculation is stored in a data-word (16 bit), which starting value is FFFH. The
value of this word is manipulated using Exclusive OR- and SHIFT operations together with the data package
that should be sent (slave address, function code, data) and the fixed value A001H. At the end of the calcula-
tion the data-word contains the checksum value.
The checksum is calculated in the following way:
1. The starting value of the 16 Bit data-word, that is used for the calculation, has to be set to FFFFH.
2. An Exclusive OR operation has to be performed with the starting value and the slave address.
3. The result has to be shifted to the right until the overflow bit becomes 1.
4. When this bit becomes 1, an Exclusive OR operation with the result of step 3 and the fix value A001H has
6 to be performed.
5. After 8 shift operations (every time when the overflow bit becomes 1, an Exclusive OR like in step 4 has to
be done), perform an Exclusive OR operation with the result of the former operations and the next data
package (8 bit function code). Again the result of this operation has to be shifted 8 times and if needed it
has to be interconnected with the fix value A001H using an Exclusive OR operation.
6. The same steps have to be performed with the data, first with the higher byte and then with the lower byte
until all data are proceeded.
7. The result of these operations is the checksum. It consists of a high and a low byte.
6-86
The following example clarifies the calculation method. It shows the calculation of a CRC-16 code with the
slave address 02H (0000 0010) and the function code 03H (0000 0011). The resulting CRC-16 code is D1H
for the lower and 40H for the higher byte. The example calculation in this example is not done completely
(normally data would follow the function code).
Calculations Overflow Description
1111 1111 1111 1111 Initial value
0000 0010 Address
1111 1111 1111 1101 ExOr Result
0111 1111 1111 1110 1 Shift 1
1010 0000 0000 0001
1101 1111 1111 1111 ExOr Result
0110 1111 1111 1111 1 Shift 2
1010 0000 0000 0001
1100 1111 1111 1110 ExOr Result
0110 0111 1111 1111 0 Shift 3
0011 0011 1111 1111 1 Shift 4
1010 0000 0000 0001
1001 0011 1111 1110 ExOr Result
0100 1001 1111 1111 0 Shift 5
0010 0100 1111 1111 1 Shift 6
1010 0000 0000 0001
1000 0100 1111 1110 ExOr Result
0100 0010 0111 1111 0 Shift 7
0010 0001 0011 1111 1 Shift 8
1010 0000 0000 0001
1000 0001 0011 1110 ExOr Result
0000 0011 Function Code
1000 0001 0011 1101
0100 0000 1001 1110 1
ExOr Result
Shift 1 6
1010 0000 0000 0001
1110 0000 1001 1111 ExOr Result
0111 0000 0100 1111 1 Shift 2
1010 0000 0000 0001
1101 0000 0100 1110 ExOr Result
0110 1000 0010 0111 0 Shift 3
0011 0100 0001 0011 1 Shift 4
1010 0000 0000 0001
1001 0100 0001 0010 ExOr Result
0100 1010 0000 1001 0 Shift 5
0010 0101 0000 0100 1 Shift 6
1010 0000 0000 0001
1000 0101 0000 0101 ExOr Result
0100 0010 1000 0010 1 Shift 7
1010 0000 0000 0001
1110 0010 1000 0011 ExOr Result
0111 0001 0100 0001 1 Shift 8
1010 0000 0000 0001
1101 0001 0100 0000 ExOr Result
D1H 40H CRC-16 Result
Higher Lower
Byte Byte
6-87
MEMOBUS Message Example
An example of MEMOBUS command/response messages is given below.
6
Loop back Test
The loop back test returns command messages directly as response messages without changing the contents to
check the communications between the master and slave. You can set user-defined test code and data values.
The following table shows a message example when performing a loop back test with the slave no. 1.
Response Message Response Message
Command Message
(During Normal Operation) (During Fault)
Slave address 01H Slave address 01H Slave address 01H
Function code 08H Function code 08H Function code 89H
Higher 00H Higher 00H Fault Code 01H
Test Code Test Code
Lower 00H Lower 00H Higher 86H
CRC-16
Higher A5H Higher A5H Lower 50H
Data Data
Lower 37H Lower 37H
Higher DAH Higher DAH
CRC-16 CRC-16
Lower 8DH Lower 8DH
6-88
Writing to Multiple Inverter Memory Registers
The writing of inverter memory registers works similar to the reading process, i.e. the address of the first reg-
ister that is to be written and the quantity of to be written registers must be set in the command message.
The to be written data must be consecutive, starting from the specified address in the command message. The
data order must be higher 8 bits, then lower 8 bits. The data must be in memory register address order.
The following table shows an example of a message where a forward operation has been set with a frequency
reference of 60.0 Hz for the inverter with the slave address 01H.
Response Message Response Message
Command Message
(During Normal Operation) (During Fault)
Slave Address 01H Slave Address 01H Slave Address 01H
Function Code 10H Function Code 10H Function Code 90H
Higher 00H Higher 00H Fault code 02H
Start Address Start Address
Lower 01H Lower 01H Higher CDH
CRC-16
Higher 00H Higher 00H Lower C1H
Quantity Quantity
Lower 02H Lower 02H
No. of data 04H Higher 10H
CRC-16
Higher 00H Lower 08H
Lead data
Lower 01H
Higher 02H
Next data
Lower 58H * No. of data = 2 x (quantity)
Higher 63H
CRC-16
Lower 39H
For the number of data value in the command message the double value of the data quantity must be
taken.
IMPORTANT
6-89
Data Tables
The data tables are shown below. The types of data are as follows: Reference data, monitor data, and broadcast
data.
Reference Data
The reference data table is shown below. These data can be read and written. They cannot be used for monitor-
ing functions.
Register Address Contents
0000H Reserved
Run operation and input commands
Bit 0 Forward run
Bit 1 Reverse run
Bit 2 External fault
Bit 3 Reset command
Bit 4 ComNet
0001H Bit 5 ComCtrl
Bit 6 Multi-function input command 3
Bit 7 Multi-function input command 4
Bit 8 Multi-function input command 5
Bit 9 Multi-function input command 6
Bit A Multi-function input command 7
Bits B to F Not used
0002H Frequency reference (Set units using parameter o1-03)
0003H to 0005H Not used
0006H PID target value
0007H Analog output 1 setting (-11 V/-726 to 11 V/726) → 10V = 660
0008H Analog output 2 setting (-11 V/-726 to 11 V/726) → 10V = 660
6-90
Monitor Data
The following table shows the monitor data. Monitor data can only be read.
Register Address. Contents
Inverter status signal
Bit 0 During run
Bit 1 Zero speed
Bit 2 During reverse operation
Bit 3 Reset signal active
0010H
Bit 4 During speed agree
Bit 5 Inverter ready
Bit 6 Alarm
Bit 7 Fault
Bits 8 to F Not used
Operator status
Bit 0 During OPE alarm
Bit 1 During fault
0011H
Bit 2 Operator in programming mode
Bit 3, 4 00: JVOP-160 attached, 01: JVOP-161 attached, 11: PC connected
Bit 5 to F Not used
0012H OPE Fault Number
0013H Not used
Fault Content 1
Bit 0 PUF, DC bus fuse blown
Bit 1 UV1
Bit 2 UV2
Bit 3 UV3
Bit 4 Not used
Bit 5
Bit 6
GF, Ground fault
OC, Over current 6
0014H Bit 7 OV, DC bus over voltage
Bit 8 OH, Inverter heatsink overheat pre-alarm
Bit 9 OH1, Inverter heatsink overheat
Bit A OL1, Motor overload
Bit B OL2, Inverter overload
Bit C OL3, Overtorque detection 1
Bit D OL4, Overtorque detection 2
Bit E RR, Internal braking transistor fault
Bit F RH, Inverter mounted braking resistor overheat
Fault Content 2
Bit 0 EF3, External fault set on terminal S3
Bit 1 EF4, External fault set on terminal S4
Bit 2 EF5, External fault set on terminal S5
Bit 3 EF6, External fault set on terminal S6
Bit 4 EF7, External fault set on terminal S7
Bit 5 Not used
0015H Bit 6 Not used
Bit 7 OS, Overspeed detected
Bit 8 DEV, Speed deviation detected
Bit 9 PGO, PG disconnected
Bit A PF, Input phase loss
Bit B LF, Output open phase
Bit C OH3, Motor overheat pre-alarm (PTC analog input)
Bit D OPR, Digital operator disconnected
6-91
Register Address. Contents
Bit E ERR,
0015H
Bit F OH4, Motor overheat (PTC analog input)
Fault Content 3
Bit 0 CE, Memobus communications fault
Bit 1 BUS, Bus option communications fault
Bit 2/3 Not used
Bit 4 CF, Control fault
Bit 5 Not used
0016H
Bit 6 EF0, External fault from optional input card
Bit 7 FBL, PID feedback loss
Bit 8 UL3, Undertorque detection 1
Bit 9 UL4, Undertorque detection 2
Bit A OL7, High Slip Braking overload
Bit B to F Not used
CPF Fault Content 1
Bit 0/1 Not used
Bit 2 CPF02
Bit 3 CPF03
0017H
Bit 4 Not used
Bit 5 CPF05
Bit 6 CPF06
Bit 7 to F Not used
CPF Fault Content 2
Bit 0 CPF20
Bit 1 CPF21
0018H
Bit 2 CPF22
Bit 3 CPF23
6 Bit 4 to F
Alarm Content 1
Not used
6-92
Register Address. Contents
Bit 8 to A Not used
Bit B FBL, PID feedback loss
Bit C CALL, Communications on standby
001AH
Bit D UL3, Undertorque detection 1
Bit E UL4, Undertorque detection 2
Bit F Not used
Alarm Content 3
Bit 0 Not used
001BH
Bit 1 OH3, Motor overheat pre-alarm
Bit 2 to F Not used
Inverter status
Bit 0 Forward operation
Bit 1 Reverse operation
Bit 2 Inverter startup complete 1: Completed 2: Not completed
Bit 3 Fault
0020H
Bit 4 Data setting fault
Bit 5 Multi-function digital output 1 (terminal M1 - M2) 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 6 Multi-function digital output 2 (terminal M3 - M4) 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 7 Multi-function digital output 3 (terminal M5 - M6) 1: ON 0: OFF
Bits 8 to F Not used
Fault details
Bit 0 Overcurrent (OC), Ground fault (GF)
Bit 1 Main circuit overvoltage (OV)
Bit 2 Inverter overload (OL2)
Bit 3 Inverter overheat (OH1, OH2)
Bit 4 Braking transistor/resistance overheat (rr, rH)
Bit 5 Fuse blown (PUF)
Bit 6
Bit 7
PID feedback lost (FbL)
External fault (EF, EFO)
6
0021H
Bit 8 Control board fault (CPF)
Bit 9 Motor overload (OL1) or overtorque 1 (OL3) detected
Bit A PG broken wire detected (PGO), Overspeed (OS), Speed deviation (DEV)
Bit B Main circuit undervoltage (UV) detected
Main circuit undervoltage (UV1), control power supply fault (UV2), inrush prevention circuit fault (UV3),
Bit C
power loss
Bit D Missing output phase (LF)
Bit E MEMOBUS communications fault (CE)
Bit F Operator disconnected (OPR)
Data link status
Bit 0 Writing data
Bit 1 Not used
0022H Bit 2 Not used
Bit 3 Upper and lower limit faults
Bit 4 Data integrity fault
Bits 5 to F Not used
Frequency refer-
0023H Monitors U1-01
ence
0024H Output frequency Monitors U1-02
0025H Output voltage (U1-06)
0026H Output current U1-03
0027H Output power U1-08
0028H Torque reference U1-09
0029H Not used
002AH Not used
6-93
Register Address. Contents
Control terminals input status
Bit 0 Input terminal S1 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 1 Input terminal S2 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 2 Multi-function input terminal S3 1: ON 0: OFF
002BH Bit 3 Multi-function input terminal S4 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 4 Multi-function input terminal S5 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 5 Multi-function input terminal S6 1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 6 Multi-function input terminal S7 1: ON 0: OFF
Bits 7 to F Not used
Inverter status
Bit 0 Operation 1: Operating
Bit 1 Zero speed 1: Zero speed
Bit 2 Frequency agree 1: Agreement
Bit 3 User-defined speed agree 1: Agreement
Bit 4 Frequency detection 1 1: Output frequency ≤ L4-01
Bit 5 Frequency detection 2 1: Output frequency ≥ L4-01
Bit 6 Inverter startup completed 1: Startup completed
002CH Bit 7 Undervoltage detection 1: Detected
Bit 8 Baseblock 1: Inverter output baseblock
Bit 9 Frequency reference mode 1: Not communication 0: Communication option
Bit A Run command mode 1: Not communication 0: Communication option
Bit B Overtorque detection 1: Detected
Bit C Frequency reference lost 1: Lost
Bit D Restart enabled1: Restarting
Bit E Fault (including MEMOBUS communications time-out) 1:Fault occurred
Bit F MEMOBUS communications time-out 1: Timed out
Multi-function digital output status
6 002DH
Bit 0
Bit 1
Multi-function digital output 1 (terminal M1-M2)
Multi-function digital output 2 (terminal M3-M4)
1: ON 0: OFF
1: ON 0: OFF
Bit 2 Multi-function digital output 3 (terminal M5-M6) 1: ON 0: OFF
Bits 3 to F Not used
002EH - 0030H Not used
0031H Main circuit DC voltage
0032H - 0037H Not used
0038H PID feedback (max. output frequency = 100%; resolution 0.1%; without sign)
0039H PID input (max. output frequency = 100%; resolution 0.1%; with sign)
003AH PID output (max. output frequency = 100%; resolution 0.1%; with sign)
003BH CPU software number
003CH Flash software number
Communications fault details
Bit 0 CRC fault
Bit 1 Invalid data length
Bit 2 Not used
003DH Bit 3 Parity fault
Bit 4 Overrun fault
Bit 5 Framing fault
Bit 6 Time-out
Bits 7 to F Not used
003EH kVA setting
003FH Control method
Note: Communications fault details are stored until an fault reset is input (you can also reset while the Unit is operating).
6-94
Broadcast Data
Using broadcast data a command can be given to all slaves at the same time. The slave address in the com-
mand message must be set to 00H. All slaves will receive the message. They will not respond.
The following table shows the broadcast data. You can also write this data.
Register Address Contents
Operation signal
Bit 0 Forward run
Bit 1 Reverse run
Bits 2 and 3 Not used
Bit 4 External fault 1
0001H Bit 5 Fault reset 1
Bits 6 to B Not used
*1 Multi-function digital input terminal S5 input
Bit C
Bit D *1 Multi-function digital input terminal S6 input
Bit E *1 Multi-function digital input terminal S7 input
Bit F Not used.
0002H Frequency reference
* 1. A change of these bits to 1 will be accepted only, if the bits C, D and / or E in register 000FH (reference data) are set to 1 at the inverter, at
which the inputs S5, S6 and S7 shall be enabled.
Note:Bit signals not defined in the broadcast operation signals use the local inverter input/output signals.
6-95
ENTER Command
When writing parameters to the Inverter from the PLC using MEMOBUS communications, the parameters are
temporarily stored in the parameter data area of the Inverter. To enable these parameters in the parameter data
area the ENTER command must be used.
There are two types of ENTER commands:
• ENTER commands that enable parameter data in RAM only (changes will be lost after power loss)
• ENTER commands that write data into the EEPROM (non-volatile memory) of the Inverter and enable the
data in RAM at the same time.
The following table shows the ENTER command data. ENTER command data can only be written.
The ENTER command is enabled by writing 0 to register number 0900H or 0910H.
Register Address. Contents
0900H Write parameter data to EEPROM, RAM is refreshed
0910H Parameter data are not written to EEPROM, but refreshed in RAM only.
• The maximum number of times you can write to EEPROM is 100,000. Do not frequently execute ENTER com-
mands (0900H) that write into EEPROM.
• The ENTER command registers are write-only. Consequently, if these registers should be read out, the register
INFO address will become invalid (Fault code: 02H).
• An ENTER command is not required if reference or broadcast data are sent to the inverter.
Fault Codes
The following table shows MEMOBUS communications fault codes.
Fault Code Contents
Function code fault
01H
A function code other than 03H, 08H, or 10H has been set by the PLC.
6 02H
Invalid register number fault
• The register address you are attempting to access is not recorded anywhere.
• With broadcast sending, a start address other than 0001H, or 0002H has been set.
6-96
Slave Not Responding
In the following cases, the slave will ignore the write function.
• When a communications fault (overrun, framing, parity, or CRC-16) is detected in the command message.
• When the slave address in the command message and the slave address in the Inverter do not agree.
• When the gap between two blocks (8 bit) of a message exceeds 24 bits.
• When the command message data length is invalid.
If the slave address specified in the command message is 0, all slaves execute the write function,
INFO but do not return response messages to the master.
Self-Diagnosis
The Inverter has a built-in function for self-diagnosing the serial communication interface circuits. This func-
tion is called the self-diagnosis function. It uses the connected communications parts of the send and receive
terminals to receive data sent by the Inverter and thereby to check if communication is performed normally.
To perform the self-diagnosis function use the following procedure.
1. Turn ON the inverter power supply, and set 67 (communications test mode) in parameter H1-05 (Terminal
S7 Function Selection).
2. Turn OFF the inverter power supply.
3. Perform the wiring according to Fig 6.78.
4. Turn ON the terminating resistance. (Turn ON pin 1 on DIP switch 1.)
5. Turn ON the inverter power supply.
During normal operation, the Digital Operator displays “PASS” on the display.
If a fault occurs, a “CE” (MEMOBUS communications fault) alarm will be displayed on the Digital Operator,
the fault output will be turned ON, and the Inverter operation ready signal will be turned OFF.
6-97
Using the Timer Function
The multi-function digital input terminals S3 to S7 can be used as timer function input terminals, and multi-
function output terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, and M5-M6 can be used as timer function output terminals. By
setting the delay time, you can prevent chattering of the sensors and switches.
• Set one of the parameters H1-01 to H1-05 (digital input terminal S3 to S7) to 18 (timer function input).
• Set H2-01 to H2-03 (multi-function output terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, and M5-M6 function selection) to
12 (timer function output).
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b4-01 Timer function ON-delay time 0.0 s No A A A A
b4-02 Timer function OFF-delay time 0.0 s No A A A A
6
Function
Value V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
12 Timer function output Yes Yes Yes Yes
Setting Example
When the timer function input ON time is longer than the value set in b4-01, the timer output function is
turned ON. When the timer function input OFF time is longer than the value set in b4-02, the timer output
function is turned OFF. An example of timer function operation is given in the following diagram.
6-98
Using PID Control
PID control is a method of making the feedback value (detection value) matching the set target value. By com-
bining proportional control (P), integral control (I), and differential control (D), you can even control system
with load fluctuation.
The characteristics of the PID control operations are given below.
The output of a P-element is proportional to the input (deviation). With using a P-element alone it is
P element
not possible to eliminate the deviation completely.
The output of an I-element is the time-integral of the input (deviation). With using a P-element and
I element
an I-element together the deviation can be eliminated completely.
The output of a D-element is the derivative of the input (deviation). By adding a D-element the
D element
response can be improved rapidly but the system can also become unstable.
Time
PID control
I control
Output of P-, I-
and D-element D control
P control
6
Time
6-99
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b5-01 PID control mode selection 0 No A A A A
b5-02 Proportional gain (P) 1.00 Yes A A A A
b5-03 Integral (I) time 1.0 s Yes A A A A
b5-04 Integral (I) limit 100.0% Yes A A A A
b5-05 Differential (D) time 0.00 s Yes A A A A
b5-06 PID limit 100.0% Yes A A A A
b5-07 PID offset adjustment 0.0% Yes A A A A
b5-08 PID delay time constant 0.00 s Yes A A A A
b5-09 PID output characteristics selection 0 No A A A A
b5-10 PID output gain 1.0 No A A A A
b5-11 PID reverse output selection 0 No A A A A
b5-12 Selection of PID feedback loss detection 0 No A A A A
b5-13 PID feedback loss detection level 0% No A A A A
b5-14 PID feedback loss detection time 1.0 s No A A A A
b5-15 PID sleep function operation level 0.0 Hz No A A A A
b5-16 PID sleep operation delay time 0.0 s No A A A A
b5-17 Accel/decel time for PID reference 0.0 s No A A A A
b5-18 PID Setpoint Selection 0 No A A A A
b5-19 PID set point 0 No A A A A
b5-28 PID square root feedback selection 0 No A A A A
b5-29 Square root feedback gain 1.00 No A A A A
b5-31 PID monitor feedback selection 0 No A A A A
b5-32 PID monitor feedback gain 100.0% No A A A A
6
b5-33 PID monitor feedback bias 0.0% No A A A A
6-100
Multi-Function Digital Inputs (H1-01 to H1-05)
Control Methods
Set V/f Open Closed
Function
Value V/f with loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
19 PID control disable (ON: PID control disabled) Yes Yes Yes Yes
30 PID control integral reset (reset when reset command is input or when stopped during PID control) Yes Yes Yes Yes
31 PID control integral hold (ON: Integral hold) Yes Yes Yes Yes
34 PID soft starter Yes Yes Yes Yes
35 PID input characteristics switch Yes Yes Yes Yes
6-101
PID Input Methods
Multi-Function Analog Terminal A2 Set H3-09 to C (PID target value). Either the pulse train input or the analog input A1 can be selected as PID feed-
Input back value.
Set MEMOBUS bit 1 in register address 000FH to 1 (enable/disable PID target value from communications) to be
MEMOBUS register 0006H
able to use register number 0006H as the PID target value.
Pulse train input Set H6-01 to 2 (PID target value).
Parameter setting If b5-18 is set to 1 the value in b5-19 becomes the PID target value.
If the PID function is used, the frequency reference value becomes the target value, which is set and
shown in Hz on the operator. Nevertheless, internally the PID target value is used in percent. I.e. the
INFO
following formula is used:
6 Input Method
Adjust PID target value and PID feedback value using the following items.
• Analog input: Adjust using the analog input terminal gain and bias.
INFO
• Pulse train input: Adjust using pulse train scaling, pulse train input gain, and pulse train input bias.
6-102
PID Adjustment Examples
Suppressing Overshoot
If overshoot occurs, reduce Proportional gain (P), and increase integral time (I).
Response Before adjustment
After adjustment
Time
After adjustment
Time
After adjustment
Time
After adjustment
Time
6-103
Setting Precautions
• In PID control, the b5-04 parameter is used to prevent the calculated integral control value from exceeding
a specified amount. When the load varies rapidly, the Inverter response is delayed, and the machine might
get be damaged or the motor may stall. In this case, reduce the set value to speed up Inverter response.
• The b5-06 parameter is used to prevent the output value of the PID control calculation from exceeding a
specified amount. The value is set taking the maximum output frequency as 100%.
• The b5-07 parameter is used to adjust PID control offset. The value is set in increments of 0.1%, taking the
maximum output frequency to be 100%.
• Set the filter time constant for the PID control output in b5-08. Enable this parameter to prevent machinery
resonance when machinery friction is high, or rigidity is poor. In this case, set the parameter to be higher
than the resonance frequency cycle duration. Increase this time constant to reduce Inverter responsiveness.
• Using b5-09, the PID output polarity can be inverted. If now the PID feedback value increases the output
frequency will be increased. This function is usable e.g. for vacuum pumps.
• Using b5-10, you can apply a gain to the PID control output. Enable this parameter to adjust the amount of
compensation if adding PID control output to the frequency reference as compensation (b5-01 = 3/4).
• When PID control output is negative, you can use parameter b5-11 to determine what happens to the
inverter output. When b1-04 (Prohibition of Reverse Operation) is set to 1 (enabled), however, the PID
output is limited to 0.
• Using the b5-17 parameter the PID target value can be raised or lowered with an accel./decel. ramp func-
tion (PID soft starter).
The normally used accel./decel. function (C1- parameters) is allocated after PID control so that,
depending on the settings, resonance with the PID control and hunting in the machinery may occur. Using
b5-17 this behavior can be prevented.
The PID soft starter function can also be disabled or enabled using a multifunction digital input (H1-
has to be set to 34).
6-104
Frequency Reference / PID Target
D1-16
D1-02
+ RUN
b1-01 b5-16
- on/off
0 Delay
D1-01 b5-01=0 Timer
4 Frequency reference b5-15
Pulse Train Inp. Enable / Disable reverse operation
(U1-01) when PID output is negativ Sleep Level
PID Control Block
Option Card 3
6-105
6
PID Feedback Loss Detection
When performing PID control, be sure to use the PID feedback loss detection function. Otherwise if the PID
feedback gets lost, the Inverter output frequency may accelerate to the maximum output frequency.
Loss detection
level
(b5-13)
Time
No Fbl
detection
Fbl detection
Loss detection
level
(b5-13)
Time
No Fbl
detection
Fbl detection
Loss detection time Loss detection time
(b5-14) (b5-14)
6-106
PID Sleep
The PID sleep function stops the Inverter when the PID output value falls below the sleep operation level (b5-
15) for the sleep operation time set in parameter b5-16. The inverter operation will resume, if the PID output
value exceeds the sleep operation level for the time set in parameter b5-16 or longer.
The PID sleep function works as well when the PID control is disabled. In this case the frequency reference
value is observed by the sleep function instead of the PID output value.
The PID sleep time chart is shown below.
So linear connection between the PID target value and the feedback can be realized.
6
PID Monitor Feedback Function
Using this function an internal monitor (U1- ) can be set as PID feedback value. The monitor item can be
selected in parameter b5-31. The following set values are possible:
Control Methods
Set Value Function Open Closed
V/f with
V/f loop Loop
PG
Vector Vector
0 Disabled Yes Yes Yes Yes
3 Output current Yes Yes Yes Yes
5 Motor Speed No Yes Yes Yes
6 Output voltage Yes Yes Yes Yes
7 DC bus voltage Yes Yes Yes Yes
8 Output power Yes Yes Yes Yes
9 Torque reference No No Yes Yes
15 Terminal A1 input level Yes Yes Yes Yes
16 Terminal A2 input level Yes Yes Yes Yes
18 Motor secondary current Yes Yes Yes Yes
6-107
Multifunction Digital Input Settings: H1-01 to H1-05 (Terminal S3 to S7)
6-108
Energy-saving
To use the energy saving function, set b8-01 (Energy Saving Mode Selection) to 1. Energy-saving control can
be performed in all control methods. The parameters to be adjusted are different for each. In the V/f control
modes adjust b8-04 to b8-05. In Open Loop and Closed Loop Vector control adjust b8-02 and b8-03.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b8-01 Energy-saving mode selection 0 No A A A A
* 1. The value for Open Loop Vector Control is given. The factory setting is 1.0 in Closed Loop Vector Control.
* 2. The factory setting is 2.00 s for Inverters with a capacity of 75 kW and more.
* 3. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (the value for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4 kW is given).
6-109
Open Loop and Closed Loop Vector Control
In Open Loop and Closed Loop Vector control, the slip frequency is controlled so that motor efficiency is
maximized.
• Taking the motor rated slip for the base frequency as optimum slip, the inverter calculates the slip for the
optimal motor efficiency depending on the output frequency.
• Before using energy saving always perform autotuning.
• If hunting occurs reduce the set value in b8-02 (Energy-saving Gain), or increase the set value in b8-03
(Energy-saving Filter Time Constant).
Field Weakening
The field weakening function is used to lower the output voltage when the motor load changes to a low level
(no load). Thereby energy can be saved and motor audible noise is reduced.
Note that this function is designed for the usage with one low load condition that does not change. If the low
load condition changes, the field weakening function can not be optimized. In this case the energy saving
function should be used instead.
The function can be activated using a multi-function digital input. Therefore set one of the parameters H1-01
to H1-05 to 63.
Field weakening can be used in the V/f control modes only.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
6 d6-01
d6-02
Field weakening level
Field weakening frequency limit
80%
0.0 Hz
No
No
A
A
A
A
No
No
No
No
6-110
Field Forcing
The field forcing function controls the motor flux and compensates the flux establishment delay of the motor.
Thereby it improves the motor responsiveness on changes in the speed reference or the load.
Field forcing is applied during all operation conditions except DC Injection.
Using parameter d6-04 a field forcing limit can be applied. A setting of 100% is equal to the no-load current
set in parameter E2-03.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d6-03 Field forcing selection 0 No No No No A
d6-04 Field forcing limit 400% No No No A A
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
6
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
E2-01 Motor rated current 1.90 A * 1 No Q Q Q Q
* 1. The factory setting depends on the Inverter capacity (the values for a 200 V Class Inverter of 0.4 kW is shown).
6-111
Manual Setting of the Motor Parameters
6 • E-type insulation: [Line-to line resistance (Ω) at 75°C of test report] × 0.92 (Ω)
• B-type insulation: [Line-to line resistance (Ω) at 75°C of test repor]t × 0.92 (Ω)
• F-type insulation: [Line-to line resistance (Ω) at 115°C of test report] × 0.87 (Ω)
6-112
Setting the V/f Pattern 1
Using the E1- parameters the Inverter input voltage and the V/f pattern can be set as needed. It is not rec-
ommended to change the settings when the motor is used in Open Loop or Closed Loop vector control mode.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
E1-01 Input voltage setting 200 V * 1 No Q Q Q Q
15.0 V
E1-08 Mid. output frequency voltage (VB) *1 *2 No A A A No
9.0 V
E1-10 Min. output frequency voltage (VMIN) *1 *2 No A A A No
0.0 V
E1-13 Base voltage (VBASE) *3 * 4 No A A Q Q
* 1. The dacgadsfg values are for a 200 V class Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 2. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (V/f control factory settings are given.)
*
*
3. Parameter is disregarded when set to 0.0.
4. E1-13 is set to the same value as E1-05 after autotuning. 6
Setting Inverter Input Voltage (E1-01)
Set the Inverter input voltage correctly in E1-01 so that it matches the power supply voltage. This set value
will be the reference value for the protection functions and similar functions (overvoltage level, stall level).
6-113
Setting V/f Pattern (E1-02)
The V/f pattern can be selected using parameter E1-03. There are two methods of setting the V/f pattern:
Select one of the 15 preset pattern types (set value: 0 to E), or set a user-defined V/f pattern (set value: F).
The factory setting for E1-03 is F.
To select one of the existing patterns, refer to the following table.
Characteristic Application Set Value Specifications
0 (F) 50 Hz specifications
These patterns are used in general applications where 1 60 Hz specifications
Constant Torque Char-
the load torque is fixed, regardless of rotation speed,
acteristic 2 60 Hz specifications, voltage saturation at 50 Hz
e.g. for linear transport systems.
3 72 Hz specifications, voltage saturation at 60 Hz
6 * 1. The high start-up torque is provided by the automatic torque boost functionality (Torque compensation), so normally there is notneed to used
these patterns.
When you select these patterns, the values of parameters E1-04 to E1-10 are changed automatically. There are
three types of values for E1-04 to E1-10, depending on the Inverter capacity.
• 0.4 to 1.5 kW V/f pattern
• 2.2 to 45 kW V/f pattern
• 55 to 300 kW V/f pattern
The characteristics diagrams for each are shown in the following pages.
6-114
0.4 to 1.5 kW V/f Pattern
The diagrams show characteristics for a 200-V class motor. For a 400-V class motor, multiply all voltages
by 2.
• Constant Torque Characteristics (Set Value: 0 to 3)
Set Value 0 50 Hz Set Value 1 60 Hz Set Value 2 60 Hz Set Value 3 72 Hz
6-115
2.2 to 45 kW V/f Pattern
The diagrams show characteristics for a 200-V class motor. For a 400-V class motor, multiply all voltages
by 2.
• Constant Torque Characteristics (Set Value: 0 to 3)
Set Value 0 50 Hz Set Value 1 60 Hz Set Value 2 60 Hz Set Value 3 72 Hz
6-116
55 to 300 kW V/f Pattern
The diagrams show characteristics for a 200-V class motor. For a 400-V class motor, multiply all voltages
by 2.
• Constant Torque Characteristics (Set Value: 0 to 3)
Set Value 0 50 Hz Set Value 1 60 Hz Set Value 2 60 Hz Set Value 3 72 Hz
6-117
Setting an Individual V/f Pattern
If E1-03 is set to F the V/f pattern can be set individually using the parameters E1-04 to E1-10. See Fig 6.85
for details.
Output voltage (V)
Frequency (Hz)
• If E1-03 is set to anything other than F, only parameters E1-04 to E1-10 can be read.
• To set the V/f characteristics linear, set E1-07 and E1-09 to the same value. In this case, E1-08 will
INFO
be ignored.
Setting Precautions
6 When the setting is to user-defined V/f pattern, beware of the following points:
• When changing control method, parameters E1-07 to E1-10 will change to the factory settings for that
control method.
• Be sure to set the four frequencies as follows:
E1-04 (FMAX) ≥ E1-06 (FA) > E1-07 (FB) ≥ E1-09 (FMIN)
6-118
Setting Motor 2 Parameters
The E4- parameters are for setting the motor data for motor 2. In the Vector Control modes the motor data
are set automatically by autotuning. If the autotuning does not complete normally, set them manually (refer to
page 6-112, Manual Setting of the Motor Parameters).
To switch over between motor 1 and 2 a digital input must be set for the motor switch over command (one of
the parameters H1-01 to H1-05 must be set to 16). Motor 2 is selected when the input is switched ON. In this
case the V/f pattern settings in the parameters E3- are used.
Note:Autotuning for motor 2 can only be performed if one multifunction input H1- is set to 16 (Motor 2
selection). Otherwise motor 2 cannot be selected during autotuning (T1-00 will not be shown).
Related parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
E4-01 Motor 2 rated current 1.90 A * 1 No A A A A
* 1. The factory setting depends on the Inverter Capacity (the value for a 200 V Class Iverter of 0.4kW is given).
6-119
Setting the V/f Pattern 2
Using the E3- parameters the V/f pattern for motor 2 can be set as needed.
It is not recommended to change the settings when the motor is used in open loop vector mode.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
E3-01 Motor 2 control method selection 0 No A A A A
E3-02 Motor 2 max. output frequency (FMAX) 50.0 Hz No A A A A
9.0 V
E3-08 Motor 2 min. output frequency voltage (VMIN) No A A A No
*1 *2
* 1. These are values for a 200 Vclass Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
* 2. The factory setting will change when the control method is changed. (V/f control factory settings are given.)
6-120
Torque Control
With Closed Loop Vector control the motor's output torque can be controlled by a torque reference from an
analog input. Torque control can be enabled by setting parameter d5-01 to 1 or 2.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
d5-01 Torque control selection 0 No No No No A
d5-02 Torque reference delay time 0 ms No No No No A
d5-03 Speed limit selection 1 No No No No A
d5-04 Speed limit 0% No No No No A
d5-05 Speed limit bias 10% No No No No A
d5-06 Speed/torque control switching timer 0 ms No No No No A
Monitors
Control Methods
Parame-
Output Signal Level at Analog Min. V/f Open Closed
ter Name Description
Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Number
PG Vector Vector
Torque refer- Monitor in internal torque refer- 10 V: Motor rated torque
U1-09 0.1% No No Yes Yes
ence ence value for vector control. (0 to ± 10 V possible)
6-121
Torque Control Operation
In torque control a torque value can be given as reference for the motor output. If the torque command and the
load are not balanced, the motor accelerates or decelerates.
The speed limit circuit prevents the motor speed from rising above certain value set by an analog input or
parameter d5-04. The speed limit function mainly consists of two parts, the priority circuit and the speed
limiter circuit.
The priority circuit selects between the torque reference value from the analog input or from the speed control-
ler (ASR) output. If the output speed is below the speed limit, the analog input value is taken as torque refer-
ence. Otherwise the ASR output value is taken as torque reference.
The speed limit circuit adds a speed suppressing torque to the torque output if the speed exceeds the speed
limit. Together with the priority circuit it prevents the output speed from exceeding the speed limit.
For a further adjustment of the torque reference value a torque compensation can be input, either by a third
analog input (if the AI-14B analog option card is used) or in combination with a speed limit by parameter by
analog input terminal A1. The torque compensation can be used for a dancer control in winding application.
The torque control block diagram is shown in Fig 6.86.
d5-01 d5-03
Torque compensation from
2 2
analog input A1
0, 1 1
6 Speed
Feedback
Speed limiter
6-122
The direction of the torque output from the motor will be determined by the sign of the analog signal input or
a digital input command. It does not depend on the direction of the run command. The direction of torque will
be as follows:
• Positive analog reference: Torque reference for forward motor rotation (counterclockwise as viewed from
the motor output axis).
• Negative analog reference: Torque reference for reverse motor rotation (clockwise as viewed from the
motor output axis).
The direction in which speed is controlled is determined by the sign of the speed limit signal and the direction 6
of the run command.
• Positive voltage applied: The speed in the forward direction will be limited for forward operation.
• Negative voltage applied: The speed in the reverse direction will be limited for reverse operation.
If the direction of the motor rotation and the speed limit direction are not the same, the speed will be limited
to 0.
6-123
Torque Compensation Input Location of Refer- Parameter
Remarks
Method ence Settings
b1-01 = 1
F2-01 = 0
Option Card (AI-14B) d5-01 = 1 Channel 1 of the AI-14B card replaces
Channel 3
(0 to ±10 V) H3-05 =14 analog input A1
H3-08 = 0
H3-09 = 13
6-124
Speed Limit Bias Setting
The speed limit bias can be set to limit both the forward and reverse speed to the same value. This differs from
the operation of the speed limit setting. To use the speed limit bias, set d5-04 to 0 and set the bias in d5-05 as a
percentage of the maximum output frequency.
To set 50% forward and reverse speed limits, set the speed limit setting to 0 (d5-03 = 2, d5-04 = 0, and d5-05
= 50). The range of torque control will be from -50% to 50% of the maximum output speed.
When using both, the speed limit and the speed limit bias, the speed range of torque control will be the posi-
tive and negative speed limits with the speed limit bias added to each.
Example
The speed range of torque control when the forward speed limit is 50% and the speed limit bias is 10% is
shown in Fig 6.87. This figure does not take the priority circuit into account.
Positive torque
Reverse Forward
operation operation
Negative torque
Winding Operation
In a winding operation, the line (speed) and torque generated by the motor are in the same direction. For the
winding operation, both the speed limit and the torque reference input are positive. The motor will accelerate
when the torque reference input is larger than the load and will decelerate when it is smaller than the load. If
the motor turns faster than the speed limit, a negative compensation value is output from the speed limiter cir-
cuit. When the speed then drops below the speed limit, a positive compensation value is output. The torque
compensation is proportional to the ASR proportional gain. When the sum of the torque reference and the
torque compensation output by the speed limiter is the same as the actual load, the motor will stop accelerating
and run at a constant speed.
Rewinding Operation
In a rewinding operation, the line (speed) and torque generated by the motor are in the opposite directions. (In
this example, it is assumed that the line speed is positive and the torque reference input is negative.) For the
rewinding operation, the speed limit is positive and the torque reference input is negative. If the motor turns
faster than the speed limit, a negative compensation value is output from the speed limiter circuit. If the motor
is rotating in reverse, a positive compensation value is output. If the speed is 0 or is below the speed limit, a 0
compensation value is output. In this way, the output from the speed limiter is used to maintain the motor
speed between 0 and the speed limit. When the sum of the torque reference and the torque compensation out-
6-125
put by the speed limiter is the same as the actual load, the motor will stop accelerating and run at a constant
speed.
Winding Operation Rewinding Operation
n T T
n Line Direction
Line Direction
Configuration
M M
Normal Rotation Direc-
Forward Reverse Forward Reverse
tion
6-126
Setting the Speed/Torque Control Switching Timer (d5-06)
The delay between a change in the speed/torque control switching function input (ON to OFF or OFF to ON)
and the corresponding change in the control mode can be set in parameter d5-06. During the timer delay, the
value of the 2 analog inputs will retain the values they had when the ON/OFF status of speed/torque control
switching signal was changed. Use this delay to complete any changes required in external signals.
Fig 6.88 shows an example of speed/torque control switching.
CLOSED CLOSED
OPEN OPEN
Speed/torque change
signal
Run
Speed Speed
Terminal A1 input reference reference
1 2 3 4
6-127
Droop Control Function
Droop control is a function that allows to achieve a load sharing between two motors that drive a single load.
The Droop Control function must be enabled at one inverter only. If by this inverter the torque rises, the speed
is reduced and the other inverter takes over more load. Thereby the load is shared automatically to both
motors.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b7-01 Droop Control gain 0.0 Yes No No No A
b7-02 Droop Control delay time 0.05 s No No No No A
100%
6
Speed
0 Speed reference
6-128
Zero-Servo Function
The Zero-Servo function holds the motor when the motor is stopped in a so called Zero-Servo status. This
means, that if the frequency reference falls below the Zero-Speed level (parameter b2-01) a position loop is
activated and the motor is kept at the position, even if a load is applied.
The zero-servo function must be enabled using a digital input, which is programmed for is set to Zero-Servo
command (H1- = 72).
The actual deviation of the rotor position from the zero position can be monitored using parameter U1-35. The
shown value must be divided by to the get the displacement in encoder pulses.
A digital output (H2- = 33) can be used to signalize the completion of a Zero-Servo command. The output
is closed as long as the actual rotor position is within the zero position E Zero-Servo completion width.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b2-01 Zero speed level (DC injection braking starting frequency) 0.5 Hz No A A A A
b9-01 Zero-servo gain 5 No No No No A
b9-02 Zero-Servo completion width 10 No No No No A
Monitors
Control Methods
Parame-
Output Signal Level at Analog Min. V/f Open Closed
ter Name Description
Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
Number
PG Vector Vector
Zero-servo Shows the number of PG pulses
U1-35 movement times 4 for the movement range (Cannot be output.) 1 No No No A
pulses when stopped at zero.
6-129
Timing Chart
An example timing chart for the Zero-Servo function showing the input and output signals is given in the fig-
ure below.
Run command ON OFF
Frequency (speed)
reference
Excitation level
b2-01
Motor speed
Application Precautions
• Be sure to leave the run command input activated. If the run command is turned OFF, the output will be
interrupted and the zero-servo function will become inactive.
6 • The holding force of the Zero-Servo position loop can be adjusted in parameter b9-01. The holding force
will increase if the set value is increased. Oscillation and hunting may occur, if the setting is too large.
Adjust b9-01 after adjusting the speed controller (ASR).
• The Zero-Servo detection width is set as the allowable displacement from the Zero-Servo start position.
Set the b9-02 taking the number of displacement pulses from the PG multiplied by 4.
• The Zero-Servo completion signal will be turned OFF when the zero servo command is turned OFF.
Do not use the Zero-Servo for extended periods of time with 100% of torque. Inverter faults may
result. If the Zero Servo function shall be used continuously, make sure that the output current dur-
IMPORTANT ing the servolock is 50% of the motor current or less.
6-130
Kinetic Energy Buffering
The kinetic energy buffering function can be used to decelerate to stop after a sudden power loss using the
kinetic energy of the rotating machine to maintain the DC bus voltage. Thereby an uncontrolled coasting of a
machine can be prevented. The function can be activated using a multifunction input i.e. can be operated by a
DC bus undervoltage alarm output or by a voltage drop relay. A wiring example is shown in Fig. 6.80.
L1 Varispeed F7
L2
L3
to
Terminal S3 to S7 Motor
H1- =66
SN
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
C1-09 Fast stop time 10.0 s No A A A A
L2-01 Momentary power loss detection 0 No A A A A
* 1. The values are for a 200 V class Inverter. Values for a 400 V class Inverter are double.
No A A A A
6
Setting the Momentary Power Loss Detection (L2-01)
• L2-01 = 0
The inverter trips with undervoltage fault (UV1).
• L2-01 = 1
No UV1 is detected within the time which is set in parameter L2-02. If this time is exceeded and the power
has not returned, an UV1 fault is output.
• L2-01 = 2
No UV1 is detected. The inverter continues operation as long as the CPU is working.
To use the Kinetic Energy Buffering function in connection with the UV alarm output of the inverter, parame-
ter L2-01 must be set to 1 or 2.
6-131
Adjusting the Kinetic Energy Buffering Deceleration Time (C1-09)
The fast stop time set in parameter C1-09 is used to decelerate to stop when a Kinetic Energy Buffering com-
mand is input.
To set up this parameter do the following:
• Increase C1-09 until a UV1 fault is detected during deceleration. (If L2-01 is set to 2, no UV1 will be
detected, but the motor will start to coast when the DC bus voltage drops too much.) The highest setting
value of C1-09, at which no UV1 is detected will be the maximum deceleration time.
• Decrease C1-09 until a DC bus overvoltage (OV) is detected. The lowest setting value of C1-09, at which
no OV is detected, will be the minimal deceleration time.
• Set a value for C1-09, that is somewhere in the middle between the maximum and the minimum decelera-
tion time.
Adjusting the Frequency Reduction Gain at Kinetic Energy Buffering Start (L2-08)
When the Kinetic Energy Buffering function is enabled, the output frequency is reduced for a certain fre-
quency amount in order to prevent an UV1 fault. The amount of this frequency step can be set using parameter
L2-08. It is set in percent of the slip frequency before the Kinetic Energy Buffering signal was input. Normally
there is no need to change this setting.
• Increase the setting if an undervoltage fault occurs right after Kinetic Energy Buffering start.
• Decrease the setting if an overvoltage fault occurs right after Kinetic Energy Buffering start.
6-132
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
n3-01 High-slip braking deceleration frequency width 5% No A A No No
n3-02 High-slip braking current limit 150% No A A No No
n3-03 High-slip braking stop dwell time 1.0 s No A A No No
n3-04 High-slip braking OL time 40 s No A A No No
6-133
Speed Follower Function
The speed follower function allows a slave drive to precisely follow the speed of a master encoder or drive.
The speed ratio between the master and the follower is infinitely adjustable. In addtion, a gear ratio adjustment
can be added to the speed reference via parameter, analogue input, multi-funtion digital input (MOP) or serial
communication.
Input Channel
PG
Master Drive
Input Channel 1
PG
Input Channel 2
PG -Z 2 F7
Pulse Monitor Output
Slave Drive 1
Input Channel 1
PG
Input Channel 2
PG -Z 2 F7
6 M
Slave Drive n
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
S1-01 Follower Mode Selection 0 No Q Q Q Q
S1-02 Master Encoder PPR 1024 No Q Q Q Q
S1-03 Ratio Numerator (Upper 4 digits) 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q
S1-04 Ratio Denominator (Upper 4 digits) 1000 Yes Q Q Q Q
S1-05 Ratio Numerator (Lower 4 digits) 0 Yes A A A A
S1-06 Ratio Denominator (Lower 4 digits) 0 Yes A A A A
S2-01 Digital Ratio Adjsutment 0.00 % Yes A A A A
S2-02 MOP Adjust Time 50.0 sec Yes A A A A
S2-03 Gear Ratio Adjustment Ramp Time 10.0 sec Yes A A A A
S2-04 PG Monitor Channel Selecction 1 Yes A A A A
S2-05 Ratio Change Speed Agree Width 0.5 Hz Yes A A A A
6-134
Monitor Items (U1- )
Control Methods
Parameter Output Signal Level During Min. V/f Open Closed
Name
Number Multi-Function Analog Output Unit V/f with Loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
U1-85 Master Encoder Reference 10 V: Max. Output Freq. (E1-04) 0.1 Hz A A A A
U1-86 Follower Reference After Gear Ratio 10 V: 100% PID input 0.01% A A A A
U1-87 Gear Ratio Adjustment 10 V: Max. Output Freq. (E1-04) 0.1 Hz A A A A
Follower Reference after Gear Ratio Adjust-
U1-88 10 V: Max. Output Freq. (E1-04) 0.1 Hz A A A A
ment
Memobus Registers
Control Methods
6
Memo-
bus Function V/f Open Closed
Address V/f with loop Loop
PG Vector Vector
72AH Communication Gear Ratio Adjustment (1 = 0.01%) Yes Yes Yes Yes
6-135
Additional to that it can be adjusted in 4 different ways:
• by an anlogue signal:
By setting H3-09 = 1E an anlog signal adjusting the gear ratio can be input at terminal A2 (or, if the analog
input option card AI-14B is connected, setting H3-05 = 1E, it can be intput at channel 3 of the AI-14B
option card). 100% of this signal equal 100.00% gear ratio adjustment.
• by Memobus register:
A value for the gear ration can also be input in Memobus register 72AH with a resolution of 0.01% (i.e. 1
in register 72AH equals 0.01%)
• by multi-function digital inputs with the MOP function:
By setting two of the parameter H1-01 to H1-05 (terminal S3 to S7) to 91 and 92 gear ratio can be adjusted
using the MOP function. Whenever the multi-function digital input set to 91 is closed, the gear ratio will
be increased, whenever the multi-function digital input set to 92 is closed, the gear ratio will be decreased
continuously.
An acceleration / deceleration time for the MOP inputs can be set in parameter S2-02. It specifies the time
to change the MOP gear ratio adjustment by 100.00%.
The actual MOP content can be reset closing a multi-function digital input set to 93 (MOP Adjsut reset).
• by parameter S2-01:
Additional to the fixed gear ratio also a parameter can be used to adjust the gear ratio. It is input in param-
eter S2-01 in units of 0.01%.
All of the above mentioned gear ratios are summed up to produce the total gear ratio adjustment which is then
multiplied by the incoming speed reference. The full gear ratio adjustment will be changed using the ramp
time set in S2-03.
6-136
6
6-137
S1-01 > 0
U1-90 U1-91 U1-93 Follower disable (Multi-function Digital Input)
Master Encoder Reference Slave Reference After Slave Reference After
Gear Ratio Gear Ratio Adjustments
Standard Frequency
Reference
Motor Poles Gear Ratio
SFS ON
E2-04 (S1-03 x 10000) + S1-05 S1-01 = 1
Master speed Frequency
reference S1-02 x 2 (S1-04 x 10000) + S1-05 2 Reference
SFS OFF
Master Encoder
PPR Max. Frequency
E1-04 x 110% 3
MOP Reset U1-92
(Multi-Function Digital Input) S2-01 Gear Ratio
Digital Ratio Adjustment
MOP Adjust Increase Adjustment
(Multi-function Digital Input)
S2-03
Gear Ratio
S2-04 Upper Limit: Adjustment
MOP Change Rate 327.67% Ramp Time
+ +
+
Speed Follower Function Block Diagram
+ + +
+ + +
Lower Limit:
MOP Adjust Decrease -100.00% 100%
(Multi-function Digital Input) Z-1
Memobus Ratio
Adjustment Register
072AH
Analog Input
Analog Ration Adjustment
H3-05/09 = 20
Digital Operator Functions
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
o1-01 Monitor selection 6 Yes A A A A
o1-02 Monitor selection after power up 1 Yes A A A A
o1-03 Frequency units of reference setting and monitor 0 No A A A A
o1-04 Setting unit for frequency reference related parameters 0 No No No No A
o1-05 LCD Display contrast 3 Yes A A A A
o2-01 LOCAL/REMOTE key enable/disable 1 No A A A A
o2-02 STOP key during control circuit terminal operation 1 No A A A A
6-138
Changing the Units for Frequency Parameters Related to V/f settings (o1-04)
Using parameter o1-04 the unit for frequency parameters related to the V/f setting can be changed. If o1-04 is
set to 0 it will be Hz. If o1-04 is set to 1 it will be rpm.
Setting the Frequency Reference using the UP and DOWN Keys without Using the
Enter Key (o2-05)
This function is active when frequency references are input from the Digital Operator. When o2-05 is set to 1,
you can increment and decrement the frequency reference using the UP and DOWN keys without using the
Enter key.
6-139
Cumulative Operation Time (o2-07 and o2-08)
The inverter has a function that counts the operation time of the inverter cumulatively.
Using parameter o2-07 the cumulative operation time can be changed, e.g. after a replacement of the control
board. If parameter o2-08 is set to 0 the inverter counts the time whenever the power supply is switched ON. If
o2-08 is set to 1 the time when a RUN command is active is counted only. The factory setting is 0.
Copying Parameters
The Digital Operator can perform the following three functions using a built-in EEPROM (non-volatile mem-
ory).
• Store Inverter parameter set values in the Digital Operator by setting o3-01 to 1 (READ)
• Write parameter set values stored in the Digital Operator to the Inverter by setting o3-01 to 2 (COPY)
6 • Compare parameter set values stored in the Digital Operator with Inverter parameters settings by setting
o3-01 to 3 (VERIFY)
The data saved in the operator can be protected from overwriting by setting parameter o3-02 to 0. In the case a
READ command can not be executed. If it is nevertheless still done, “PrE” will be displayed at the operator.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
o3-01 Copy function selection 0 No A A A A
o3-02 Read permitted selection 0 No A A A A
6-140
Storing Inverter set values in the Digital Operator (READ)
To store Inverter set values in the Digital Operator use the following method.
Step
Explanation Digital Operator Display
No.
-ADV-
** Main Menu **
1 Press the Menu Key and select advanced programming mode.
Programming
-ADV-
Initialization
2 Press the DATA/ENTER Key. A1 - 00=1
Select Language
-ADV-
Press the Increment and Decrement Key until parameter o3-01 is displayed COPY Function
3 o3 - 01=0
(Copy Function Selection).
Copy Funtion Sel
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
4 Press the DATA/ENTER Key and select the constants setting display. o3-01= 0 *0*
COPY SELECT
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
5 Change the set value to 1 using the Increment Key. o3-01= 1 *0*
INV OP READ
-ADV-
Set the changed data using the DATA/ENTER Key. The READ function will READ
6
start. INV OP READING
-ADV-
6
If the READ function ends normally, “End” is displayed on the Digital Oper- READ
7
ator. READ COMPLETE
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
8 The display returns to o3-01 when a key is pressed. o3 - 01=0 *0*
COPY SELECT
If a fault is displayed, press any key to cancel the fault display and return to the o3-01 display. Refer to
page 7-18, Digital Operator Copy Function Faults for corrective actions.
6-141
Writing Parameter Set Values Stored in the Digital Operator to the Inverter (COPY)
To write parameter set values stored in the Digital Operator to the Inverter, use the following method.
Step
Explanation Digital Operator Display
No.
-ADV-
** Main Menu **
1 Press the MENU Key and select advanced programming mode.
Programming
-ADV-
Initialization
2 Press the DATA/ENTER Key.
A1 - 00 = 1
Select Language
-ADV-
Press the Increment and Decrement Key until parameter o3-01 is displayed COPY Function
3 o3 - 01 = 0
(Copy Function Selection).
Copy Funtion Sel
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
4 Press the DATA/ENTER Key and select the constants setting display. o3-01= 0 *0*
COPY SELECT
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
5 Change the set value to 2 using the Increment Key. o3-01= 2 *0*
OP INV WRITE
-ADV-
Set the changed data using the DATA/ENTER Key. The COPY function will COPY
6
start. OP INV COPYING
6 -ADV-
COPY
If the COPY function ends normally, “End” is displayed on the Digital Opera-
7
tor. COPY COMPLETE
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
8 The display returns to o3-01 when a key is pressed.
o3 - 01 =0 *0*
COPY SELECT
If an fault is displayed, set the parameters again. Refer to page 7-18, Digital Operator Copy Function Faults
for corrective actions.
6-142
Comparing Inverter Parameters and Digital Operator Parameter Set Values (VERIFY)
To compare Inverter parameters and Digital Operator parameter set values, use the following method.
Step
Explanation Digital Operator Display
No.
-ADV-
** Main Menu **
1 Press the MENU Key. and select advanced programming mode.
Programming
-ADV-
Initialization
2 Press the DATA/ENTER Key.
A1 - 00 = 1
Select Language
-ADV-
Press the Increment and Decrement Key until the parameter o3-01 is dis- COPY Function
3
played (Copy Function Selection). o3 - 01=0
Copy Funtion Sel
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
4 Press the DATA/ENTER Key and select the function setting display. o3-01= 0 *0*
COPY SELECT
-ADV-
Copy Funtion Sel
5 Change the set value to 3 using the Increment Key. o3-01= 3 *0*
OP INV VERIFY
-ADV-
Set the changed data using the DATA/ENTER Key. The VERIFY function VERIFY
6
will start. DATA VERIFYING
-ADV-
6
If the VERIFY function ends normally, “End” is displayed on the Digital VERIFY
7
Operator. VERIFY COMPLETE
-ADV-
Copy Function Sel
8 The display returns to o3-01 when a key is pressed.
o3 - 01 = 0 *0*
COPY SELECT
If an fault is displayed, press any key to cancel the fault display and return to the o3-01 display. Refer to
page 7-18, Digital Operator Copy Function Faults for corrective actions.
When using the copy function, check that the following settings are the same between the Inverter data
and the Digital Operator data.
• Inverter product and type
INFO
• Software number
• Inverter capacity and voltage class
• Control method
6-143
Prohibiting Overwriting of Parameters
If A1-01 is set to 0, all parameters except A1-01 and A1-04 are write protected, U1- , U2- and U3-
will be displayed. If A1-01 is set to 1, only the parameters A1-01, A1-04 and A2- can be read or
written, U1- , U2- and U3- will be displayed. All other parameters will not be displayed.
If you set one of the parameters H1-01 to H1-05 (digital input terminal S3 to S7 function selection) to 1B
(write parameters permitted), parameters can be written from the digital operator when the terminal that has
been set is ON. When the set terminal is OFF, writing parameters other than the frequency reference is prohib-
ited. However, the parameters can be read.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
A1-01 Parameter access level 2 Yes A A A A
Setting a Password
When a password is set in A1-05 and if the set values in A1-04 and A1-05 do not match, only the settings of
parameters A1-01 to A1-03, or A2-01 to A2-32 can be modified.
The setting of all parameters except A1-00 can be prohibited using the password function in combination with
setting parameter A1-01 to 0 (Monitor only).
Related Parameters
6 Parameter Factory
Change
during
Control Methods
Name Open Closed
No. Setting Opera- V/f with
V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
A1-01 Parameter access level 2 No A A A A
A1-04 Password 0 No A A A A
A1-05 Password setting 0 No A A A A
Setting a Password
The password can be set in parameter A1-05. Normally A1-05 is not displayed. To display and modify A1-05
the MENU and Reset key must be pressed together in the A1-04 display.
6-144
Displaying User-set Parameters Only
The A2 parameters (user-set parameters) and A1-01 (parameter access level) can be used to establish a param-
eter set that contains only the most important parameters.
Set the number of the parameter to which you want to refer in A2-01 to A2-32, and then set A1-01 to 1. Using
the advanced programming mode you can read and modify A1-01 to A1-03 and the parameters set in A2-01 to
A2-32 only.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
A2-01
to User setting parameters - No A A A A
A2-32
6-145
Option Cards
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
F1-01 PG constant 1024 No No Q Q Q
F1-02 Operation selection at PG open circuit (PGO) 1 No No A No A
F1-03 Operation selection at overspeed (OS) 1 No No A No A
F1-04 Operation selection at deviation (DEV) 3 No No A No A
F1-05 PG rotation 0 No No A A A
F1-06 PG division rate (PG pulse monitor) 1 No No A A A
F1-07 Integral value during accel/decel enable/disable 0 No No A No A
F1-08 Overspeed (OS) detection level 115% No No A No A
F1-09 Overspeed detection delay time (OS) 1.0 s No No A No A
F1-10 Excessive speed deviation (DEV) detection level 10% No No A No A
F1-11 Excessive speed deviation detection delay time (DEV) 0.5 s No No A No A
F1-12 Number of PG gear teeth 1 0 No No A No A
F1-13 Number of PG gear teeth 2 0 No No A No A
F1-14 PG open-circuit detection delay time 2.0 s No No A No A
If Open Loop Vector control is used and a PG card is installed, the speed detected by the PG card is dis-
played in the monitor parameter U1-05. Therefore the PG constant has to be set in parameter F1-01. The
direction of the speed detection can be changed by parameter F1-05.
IMPORTANT
To change the U1-05 value to the internally calculated value remove the PG card.
6-146
Suit the PG Rotation Direction and Motor Rotation Direction (F1-05)
Parameter F1-05 suits the PG rotation direction to the motor rotation direction. If the motor is rotating for-
wards, set whether it is A-phase leads or B-phase leads.
Inverter
Motor PG (encoder)
Forward
command
Pulse output
A-phase leads when set value = 0 B-phase leads when set value = 1
A-phase A-phase
B-phase B-phase
With the used PG the A-phase leads (CCW) when motor rotation is forward.
Generally, the A-phase leads when the rotation direction is counter-clockwise (CCW) seen from the shaft side
(FWD command is input).
Setting Number of Gear Teeth Between PG and Motor (F1-12 and F1-13) 6
If there are gears between the motor and PG, the gear ratio can be set using F1-12 and F1-13.
When the number of gear teeth has been set, the number of motor rotations within the Inverter is calculated
using the following formula.
No. of motor rotations (r/min.) = No. of input pulses from PG × 60 / F1-01 × F1-13 (No. of gear teeth on PG
side) / F1-12 (No. of gear teeth on motor side)
If F1-07 is set to 1, overshoot or undershoot may occur easily immediately after acceleration and decel-
eration. To minimize the possibility of overshoot or undershoot occurring, set F1-07 to 0.
IMPORTANT
6-147
Setting PG Pulse Monitor Output Dividing Ratio (F1-06)
This function is enabled only when using PG speed control card PG-B2. Set the dividing ratio for the PG pulse
monitor output. The set value is expressed as n for the higher place digit, and m for the two lower place digits.
The dividing ratio is calculated as follows:
Dividing ratio = (1 + n)/m (Setting range) n: 0 or 1, m: 1 to 32
F1-06 = n m
The dividing ratio can be set within the following range: 1/32 ≤ F1-06 ≤ 1. For example, if the dividing ratio is
1/2 (set value 2), half of the number of pulses from the PG are output at the pulse monitor.
Detecting Speed Difference between the Motor and Speed Reference (F1-04, F1-10
and F1-11)
6 Speed deviation is detected when the speed deviation (i.e., the difference between the speed reference and the
actual motor speed) is too large. Speed deviation (DEV) is detected only after a speed agreement (speed refer-
ence and actual motor speed are within the setting range of L4-02) and if a speed deviation higher than the set
value in F1-10 continues for longer than the time set in F1-11. After a speed deviation is detected, the Inverter
stops according to the setting in F1-04.
6-148
Analog Reference Cards
When using a AI-14B or A1-14U analog reference card, set parameter b1-01 (Reference selection) to 3
(Option Card).
The AI-14B provides 3 bi-polar input channels with 14-bit (plus sign) A/D conversion.
If b1-01 is set to 1 and F2-01 is set to 0, the channel 1 and 2 replace the analog inputs A1 and A2. A1 becomes
the frequency reference input and the function of A2 can be selected using parameter H3-09. In this case no
digital input can be set for the Option/Inverter selection function (H1- = 2).
If b1-02 is set to 3 and F2-01 is set to 1, the sum of three input channels becomes the frequency reference
value.
The AI-14U provides 2 unipolar inputs channels with 14-bit A/D conversion. Channel 1 is a voltage input and
channel 2 is a current input. The sum of the channels 1 and 2 is the frequency reference. F2-01 does not need
to be set for the AI-14U option card.
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
b1-01 Frequency reference source selection 1 No Q Q Q Q
F2-01 Bi-polar or uni-polar input selection 0 No A A A A
Related Parameters
Change Control Methods
Parameter Factory during Open Closed
Name V/f with
No. Setting Opera- V/f Loop Loop
tion PG
Vector Vector
F3-01 Digital input selection 0 No A A A A
o1-03 Frequency units of reference setting and monitor 0 No A A A A
6-149
Selecting Input Terminal Functions for the DI-16H2 Digital Reference Card
The frequency reference from the DI-16H2 Card is determined by the setting of F3-01 and the 12/16-bit
switch on the Option card. The possible settings are listed in the table below.
12-bit Binary 16-bit Binary 3-digit BCD with 4-digit BCD with 5-digit BCD with-
with Sign with Sign Sign Sign out Sign
Terminal Pin No.
F3-01 = 7 F3-01 = 7 F3-01 = 0 to 5 F3-01 = 0 to 5 F3-01 = 6
S1: 12 bit S1: 16 bit S1: 12 bit S1: 16 bit S1: 16 bit
1 Bit 0 (20) Bit 0 (20) 1 1 2
BDC digit 1
2 Bit 1 (21) Bit 1 (21) 2 BDC digit 1 2 BDC digit 1 4
(2 to 9)
3 Bit 2 (22 ) Bit 2 (2 ) 2 4 (0 to 9) 4 (0 to 9) 8
4 Bit 3 (23) Bit 3 (23) 8 8 1
5 Bit 4 (24 ) Bit 4 (2 ) 4 1 1 2 BDC digit 2
TC1
6 Bit 5 (25) Bit 5 (25) 2 BDC digit 2 2 BDC digit 2 4 (0 to 9)
7 Bit 6 (26) Bit 6 (26) 4 (0 to 9) 4 (0 to 9) 8
7)
8 Bit 7 (2 Bit 7 (27) 8 8 1
9 Bit 8 (28 ) Bit 8 (2 ) 8 1 1 2 BDC digit 3
10 Bit 9 (29) Bit 9 (29) 2 BDC digit 3 2 BDC digit 3 4 (0 to 9)
1 Bit A (210) Bit A (210) 4 (0 to 9) 4 (0 to 9) 8
2 Bit B (211) Bit B (211) 8 8 1
3 - Bit C (212) - 1 2 BDC digit 4
4 - Bit D (213) - 2 BDC digit 4 4 (0 to 9)
TC2 5 - 14) - 4 (0 to 9) 8
Bit E (2
6 - Bit F (215) - 8 1 BDC digit 5
7 Sign signal (0: Forward, 1: Reverse) 2 (0 to 3)
6
8 SET (read) signal (1: Read)
9 Input signal common (0 V)
TC3 Shield wire connection terminal
Application Precautions
• The maximum frequency (100% speed) reference will be used when the binary input is set (setting: 6 or 7)
and all bits are 1.
• Setting F3-01 to 6 is valid only when the D1-16H2 is used. Using this setting a frequency from 0.00 to
399.8 Hz can be set in BCD. The sign bit is used as a data bit, i.e. only positive data can be set. Also, the
digit starts from 0, i.e. the minimum setting is 0.02 Hz.
6-150
Selecting the Input Terminal Function for a DI-08 Digital Reference Card
The frequency reference from a DI-08 Card is determined by the setting of F3-01, as shown in the following
table.
8-bit Binary with Sign 2-digit BCD with Sign
Terminal Pin No.
F3-01 = 7 F3-01 = 0 to 5
1 Bit 0 (20) 1
2 Bit 1 (21) 2 BDC digit 1
3 Bit 2 (2 )2 4 (0 to 9)
4 Bit 3 (23
) 8
5 Bit 4 (24
) 1
TC 6 Bit 5 (25) 2 BDC digit 2
7 Bit 6 (26) 4 (0 to 15)
8 Bit 7 (27) 8
9 Sign signal
10 SET (read) signal
11 Reference common signal (0 V)
Application Precautions
The DI-08 will not function if F3-01 is set to 6.
6-151
Selecting the Digital Reference
The setting range of the digital references is determined by the combination of the settings of o1-03 and F3-01.
The information monitored in U1-01 (Frequency reference) will also change.
6
5th digit of o1-03 setting:
39999 - 16 bits 4-digit BCD with sign, 100%/(1- to 4-digit setting -10999 to 10999
X = 0, unit: 1
of o1-03) (when o1-03 = 9999)
X = 1, unit: 0.1
10000 X = 2, unit: 0.01
x=1 - 16 bits 4-digit BCD with sign, 100%/10000 -11000 to 11000 X = 3, unit: 0.001
to 3
6-152
7
Troubleshooting
This chapter describes the fault displays and countermeasures for Inverter and motor problems.
This section describes the fault and alarm functions of the Inverter. These functions include fault detection,
alarm detection, operator programming fault detection and auto-tuning fault detection.
Fault Detection
When the Inverter detects a fault, the fault contact output operates and the Inverter output is switched OFF
causing the motor to coast to stop. (The stopping method can be selected for some faults.) A fault code is dis-
played on the Digital Operator.
When a fault has occurred refer to the following table to identify the fault and to correct the causes.
Use one of the following methods to reset the fault before restarting the Inverter:
• Set a multi-function digital input (H1-01 to H1-05) to 14 (Fault Reset) and turn ON the fault reset signal.
• Press the RESET key on the Digital Operator.
• Turn the main circuit power supply OFF and then ON again.
To reset a fault it is necessary to remove the cause of the fault and the RUN signal. Only then a Reset signal is
accepted.
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Remove the motor and run the
Ground Fault Inverter without the motor.
The ground current at the Inverter One Inverter output was shorted Check the motor for a phase to
GF
output exceeded 50% of the to ground and/or a DCCT is ground short.
Ground Fault
Inverter rated output current and defective. Check the output current with
L8-09=1 (Enabled). a clampmeter to verify the
DCCT reading.
Remove the motor and run the
Shorted Inverter output phase-to- Inverter without the motor.
phase, shorted motor, locked Check the motor for a phase-
Overcurrent rotor, load too heavy, accel/decel to-phase short.
OC The Inverter’s output current time too short, contactor on the
7 Over Current exceeded the overcurrent detec-
tion level.
Inverter output has opened or
closed, a special motor or a motor
Verify the accel/decel times
(C1- ).
with a rated current larger than the Check the Inverter for a
Inverter’s output current is used. phase-to-phase short at the
output.
DC Bus Fuse Check the motor and the
The fuse in the main circuit is motor cables for short circuits
open. or insulation failures (phase-
PUF Shorted output or terminals or
Warning: to-phase).
DC Bus Fuse Open damaged IGBT’s.
Never run the Inverter after
replacing the DC bus fuse without Replace the inverter after cor-
checking for shorted components. recting the fault.
DC Bus Overvoltage The deceleration time is set too Increase the deceleration time
The DC bus voltage has exceeded short and the regenerative energy (C1-02/04/06/08) or connect a
OV the overvoltage detection level. from the motor is too large. braking option.
DC Bus Overvolt Default detection levels are: Check the power supply and
200 V class: 410 VDC The power supply voltage is too
decrease the voltage to meet
400 V class: 820 VDC high.
the inverter’s specifications.
7-2
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
The voltage fluctuations of the
power supply are too high.
Check the input voltage.
DC Bus Undervoltage A momentary power loss
The DC bus voltage is below the occurred.
Undervoltage Detection Level The terminal screws of the input Check the wiring of the input
(L2-05). The default settings are: power supply are loose. terminals.
200V class: 190 VDC Check the input voltage and
400 V class: 380 VDC An open-phase fault occurred at
the wiring of the input termi-
UV1 the input terminals.
nals.
DC Bus Undervolt
The acceleration time is set too Extend the settings in
short. C1-01/03/05/07
Main Circuit MC
Operation Failure
The MC stopped responding dur- An fault occurred in the inrush
ing Inverter operation. (Applica- current prevention circuit while Replace the Inverter.
ble Inverter Capacities the Inverter was running.
200 V class: 37 to 110 kW
400 V class: 75 to 300 kW)
Control Power Supply Remove all connection to the
External load was pulling down
Undervoltage control terminals and cycle the
UV2 the Inverter’s power supplies or
Undervoltage of the control cir- power to the Inverter.
CTL PS Undervolt there was an internal short in the
cuit while the Inverter was run-
power/gate drive board. Replace the Inverter.
ning.
Inrush Current Prevention Circuit Cycle the power to the
Fault Inverter.
An overheating of the charging
resistor for the DC bus capacitors
occurred.
The contactor of the inrush cur-
UV3
rent prevention circuit is defec-
MC Answerback The MC of the charging circuit Replace the Inverter if the
tive.
did not respond 10 sec. after the fault continues to occur.
MC ON signal has been output.
7
(Applicable Inverter Capacities
200 V class: 37 to 110 kW
400 V class: 75 to 300 kW)
The wiring terminals for the input Tighten the input terminal
power supply are loose. screws
A phase loss occurred in the input
Main Circuit Voltage Fault power supply.
An unusual big ripple on the DC
PF A momentary power loss
bus voltage has been detected.
Input Phase Loss occurred Check the power supply volt-
Only detected when L8-05=1
(enabled) The voltage fluctuations in the age
input power supply are too high.
The voltage balance between the
input phases is bad.
There is a broken wire in the out-
Output Open-phase put cable.
Reset the fault after correct-
An open-phase occurred at the There is a broken wire in the
ing its cause.
Inverter output. motor winding.
LF The output terminals are loose.
The fault is detected when the
Output Phase Loss
output current falls below 5% of The motor being used has a
the inverter rated current and L8- capacity less than 5% of the Check the motor and Inverter
07=1 (enabled) Inverter's maximum motor capac- capacity.
ity.
7-3
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
The ambient temperature is too Check for dirt build-up on the
Heatsink Overheat high. fans or heatsink.
The temperature of the Inverter's Reduce the ambient tempera-
There is a heat source nearby.
cooling fin exceeded the setting in ture around the drive.
L8-02 and L8-03 = 0 to 2. The Inverter's cooling fan(s)
OH
Heatsink Overtemp stopped.
Inverter's Cooling Fan Fault Replace the cooling fan(s).
(11kW and higher capacity) The Inverter's internal cooling fan
This fault is detected when L8-32 has stopped
is set to 1.
The ambient temperature is too Check for dirt build-up on the
high. fans or heatsink.
Heatsink Overheat
Reduce the ambient tempera-
The temperature of the Inverter’s There is a heat source nearby.
ture around the drive.
OH1 heatsink exceeded 105 °C.
Heatsink Max The Inverter’s cooling fan(s)
Temp stopped.
Inverter's Cooling Fan Fault Replace the cooling fan(s).
(11kW and higher capacity) The Inverter’s internal cooling fan
This fault is detected when L8-32 has stopped
is set to 1.
Recheck the cycle time and
the size of the load.
Motor Overheating
Detected when the level at A2, Recheck the accel and decel
OH3 programmed for motor tempera- Overheating of the motor was times (C1- ).
Motor Overheat 1 ture (Thermistor input, H3-09=E), measured by the motor thermistor. Recheck the V/f pattern
exceeds 1.17 V for the time L1-05 (E1- ).
and L1-03 = 0 to 2.
Recheck the motor rated cur-
rent value (E2-01).
Recheck the cycle time and
the size of the load.
Motor Overheating
7 OH4
Detected when the level at A2,
programmed for motor tempera- Overheating of the motor was
Recheck the accel and decel
times (C1- ).
Motor Overheat 2 ture (Thermistor input, H3-09=E), measured by the motor thermistor. Recheck the V/f pattern
exceeds 2.34 V for the time L1-05 (E1- ).
and L1-03 = 0 to 2.
Recheck the motor rated cur-
rent value (E2-01).
Dynamic Braking Resistor Verify dynamic braking duty
The protection of the heatsink cycle (load, decel times, motor
mounted resistor is activated speed).
Overhauling load, extended
when L8-01=1. Monitor DC bus voltage.
RH dynamic braking duty cycle,
This fault is only applicable when
DynBrk Transistr defective dynamic braking resis-
using the 3% duty cycle resistor,
tor. Replace dynamic braking
which is mounted on the
Inverter’s heatsink. For all other resistor.
resistors, set L8-01=0.
Dynamic Braking Transistor Defective or failed dynamic brak- Cycle power to the Inverter.
RR
The built-in dynamic braking ing resistor caused braking tran-
DynBrk Transistr Replace the Inverter.
transistor failed. sistor damage.
7-4
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Motor Overload Recheck the cycle time and
The load is too large. The acceler-
Detected when L1-01 = 1 to 3 and the size of the load as well as
ation time, deceleration time or
the Inverter’s output current the accel/decel times
cycle time are too short.
exceeded the motor overload (C1- ).
OL1 curve. The voltage settings of the V/f
Motor Overload The overload curve is adjustable Check the V/f characteristics
pattern is incorrect for the appli-
using parameter E2-01 (Motor (E1- ).
cation.
Rated Current), L1-01(Motor Pro-
tection Selection) and L2-02 The setting of Motor Rated Cur- Check the setting of Motor
(Motor Protection Time Constant) rent (E2-01) is incorrect. Rated Current Setting (E2-01).
Recheck the cycle time and
The load is too large. The acceler-
the size of the load as well as
ation time or deceleration times
the accel/decel times
Inverter Overload are too short.
(C1- ).
OL2 The Inverter output current
The voltage settings of the V/f
Inv Overload exceeded the Inverter’s overload Check the V/f characteristics
pattern is incorrect for the appli-
curve. (E1- ).
cation.
The size of the Inverter is too Check the setting of Motor
small. Rated Current Setting (E2-01).
Overtorque Detection 1 Ensure the values in L6-02
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-03 are appropriate.
OL3 control) or the output torque (Vec-
Motor was overloaded.
Overtorque Det 1 tor Control) exceeded L6-02 for Check application/machine
longer then the time set in status to eliminate fault.
L6-03 and L6-01 = 3 or 4.
Overtorque Detection 2 Ensure the values in L6-05
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-06 are appropriate.
OL4
control) or the output torque (Vec-
Overtorque Det 2 Motor was overloaded.
tor Control) exceeded L6-05 for Check application/machine
longer then the time set in status to eliminate fault.
L6-06 and L6-04 = 3 or 4.
High Slip Braking OL Make sure the load is an iner-
The output frequency stayed con- tial load.
OL7
HSB OL
stant for longer than the time set The inertia of the load is too large.
in n3-04 during High Slip Brak- If possible, reduce the load 7
ing. inertia.
7-5
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Fix the broken/disconnected
There is a break in the PG wiring.
wiring.
PG Disconnection
Detected when F1-02 = 0 to 2 and The PG is wired incorrectly. Fix the wiring.
PGO A1-02 = 1 or 3 Power is not being supplied to Supply power to the PG
PG Open Detected when no PG (encoder) the PG. properly.
pulses are received for a time
Check if the brake is opened
longer than the setting in F1-14. Wrong brake control sequence
when the RUN command is
when a brake is used.
applied.
The load is too large. Reduce the load.
The acceleration time and decel- Lengthen the acceleration
Excessive Speed Deviation eration time are too short. time and deceleration time.
Detected when F1-04 = 0 to 2 and
The load is locked. Check the mechanical system.
DEV A1-02 = 1 or 3
Speed Deviation The speed deviation is greater The settings in F1-10 and F1-11 Check the settings in F1-10
than the setting in F1-10 for a are not appropriate. and F1-11.
time longer than the setting F1-11 Check if the brake is opened
Wrong brake control sequence
when the RUN command is
when a brake is used.
applied.
Zero Servo Fault The torque limit is too small. Increase the torque limit.
SVE
The motor position moved during The load torque is too large. Decrease the load torque.
Zero Servo Fault
Zero Servo Operation. - Check for signal noise.
Control Fault
A torque limit was reached con-
CF Motor parameters were not set
tinuously for 3 seconds or longer Check the motor parameters.
Out of Control properly.
during a deceleration stop in Open
Loop Vector control.
PID Feedback Lost Verify Inverter is pro-
This fault occurs when PID feed- grammed to receive the PID
back loss detection is pro- PID feedback source (e.g. trans- feedback source signal.
FBL grammed to fault (b5-12 = 2) and ducer, sensor, building automa-
Feedback Loss the PID feedback fell below the tion signal) is not installed Check to ensure the PID feed-
7-6
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
MEMOBUS Communication
Fault
CE Connection is broken and/or the Check the connections and all
Detected when control data was
Memobus Com master has stopped the communi- user-side software configura-
not received correctly for two sec-
Err cation. tions.
onds and H5-04 = 0 to 2 and
H5-05=1.
Option Communication Fault
Connection is broken and/or the Check the connections and all
BUS After initial communication was
master has stopped the communi- user-side software configura-
Option Com Err established, the connection was
cation. tions.
lost.
Inverter’s Cooling Fan Fault
An Inverter’s cooling fan fault
was detected and the Inverter
The Inverter continued running
FAN overload protection was activated
with an overload after the cooling Replace the cooling can.
Cooling FAN Err based on the internal electric ther-
fan stopped
mal value.
This fault is detected when L8-32
is set to 0.
Check the communications
timing such as communica-
SI-T Watchdog Error Synchronization error between
E5 tions cycle.
Consistency error of received master controller and Inverter for
SI-T WDT Err Refer to the instruction man-
control data. control data.
ual for SI-T option card for
details.
Exceeded Allowable Number of
speed search retrials
Make sure that the settings in
SER The speed search has been retried The settings b3-17 and b3-18 are
b3-17 and b3-18 are appropri-
Search Retry Err more than the number of times set not appropriate.
ate.
in b3-19 (Number speed search
retreials).
Digital Operator Communication Disconnect the Digital Opera-
Fault 1 Digital operator cable was not tor and then connect it again.
Communication with the digital securely connected or digital
CPF00
COM-
ERR(OP&INV)
operator could not be established
within 5 seconds after the power
operator is defective and/or con-
trol board is defective Replace the Inverter. 7
was supplied to the Inverter.
Cycle the inverter power sup-
CPU External RAM Fault The control board is damaged. ply,
Replace the Inverter.
7-7
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Perform an initialization to
Noise or spike was on the control factory defaults.
CPF04 CPU Internal A/D Converter
circuit input terminals or the con- Cycle the power to the
Internal A/D Err Fault
trol board is damaged. Inverter.
Replace the Inverter.
Perform an initialization to
Noise or spike was on the control factory defaults.
CPF05 CPU External A/D Converter
circuit input terminals or the con- Cycle the power to the
External A/D Err Fault
trol board is damaged. Inverter.
Replace the Inverter.
The Option Card is not connected Turn off the power and re-
CPF06 properly. install the Option Card again.
Option Card Connection Fault
Option Error The Inverter or Option Card is Replace the Option Card or
damaged the Inverter.
Cycle the power to the
CPF07 -
ASIC Internal RAM fault Inverter
RAM-Err
The control circuit is damaged. Replace the Inverter.
Cycle the power to the
CPF08 -
Watchdog Timer Fault Inverter
WAT-Err
The control circuit is damaged. Replace the Inverter.
Cycle the power to the
CPF09 CPU-ASIC Mutual -
Inverter
CPU-Err Diagnosis Fault
The control circuit is damaged. Replace the Inverter.
CPF10
ASIC version fault The control circuit is damaged. Replace the Inverter.
ASIC-Err
Turn off the power and re-
Option board connection is not install the option board again
correct. Remove all inputs to the
option board
7 CPF20
Option A/D Error
Communication Option Card A/D
Converter Fault
Perform an initialization to
factory defaults.
Option card A/D converter is Cycle the power to the
faulty. Inverter
Replace the option board
Replace the inverter
Perform an initialization to
factory defaults.
Noise or spike was on the com- Cycle the power to the
CPF21 Self-diagnosis Fault of
munication line and/or defective Inverter
Option CPU Down Option Board
option board.
Replace the option board
Replace the Inverter
Remove any option boards
Perform an initialization to
factory defaults
CPF22 Unrecognizable option board is
Option Board Code Number Fault Cycle the power to the
Option Type Err connected to the control board.
Inverter
Replace the option board
Replace the Inverter
7-8
Table 7.1 Fault Detection
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Turn off the power and rein-
stall the option board again
An option board was not correctly Perform an initialization to
CPF23 connected to the control board, or factory defaults
Option Board
Option DPRAM an option board that was not made
Interconnection Fault Cycle the power to the
Err for the Inverter is attached to the
Inverter
control board.
Replace the option board
Replace the Inverter
7-9
Alarm Detection
Alarms are Inverter protection function that do not operate the fault contact output. The system will automati-
cally return to its original status when the cause of the alarm has been removed.
During an alarm condition, the Digital Operator display flashes and an alarm output is generated at the multi-
function outputs (H2-01 to H2-03) if programmed
When an alarm occurs, take appropriate countermeasures according to the table below.
Table 7.2 Alarm Detection
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
Forward/Reverse Run Commands
Input Together
EF The external forward and reverse Check external sequence
Both the forward and the reverse
External Fault command were input simulta- logic, so only one input is
run commands are input simulta-
(flashing) neously. received at a time.
neously for 500ms or more. This
alarm stops the motor.
DC Bus Undervoltage
The following conditions
occurred
The DC bus voltage was below
the Undervoltage Detection Level
UV For the probable causes please For the corrective actions
Setting (L2-05).
DC Bus Undervolt have a look at UV1, UV2 and please have a look at UV1,
The MC of the inrush current pre-
(flashing) UV3 in table 7.1. UV2 and UV3 in table 7.1
vention circuit opened.
The control power supply voltage
was below the CUV level.
UV Alarm is only detected when
the drive is in a stopped condition
DC Bus Overvoltage
The DC bus voltage exceeded the
OV overvoltage detection level. Check the power supply and
The power supply voltage is too
DC Bus Overvolt 200 V class: 410 VDC decrease the voltage to meet
high.
(flashing) 400 V class: 820 VDC the Inverter’s specifications
OV Alarm is only detected when
7-10
Table 7.2 Alarm Detection
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
Overtorque Detection 1 Ensure the values in L6-02
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-03 are appropriate.
OL3
control) or the output torque (Vec-
Overtorque Det 1 Motor was overloaded
tor control) exceeded L6-02 for Check application/machine
(flashing)
longer than the time set in status to eliminate fault.
L6-03 and L6-01 = 1 or 2
Overtorque Detection 1 Ensure the values in L6-05
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-06 are appropriate.
OL4
control) or the output torque (Vec-
Overtorque Det 1 Motor was overloaded
tor control) exceeded L6-02 for Check application/machine
(flashing)
longer then the time set in status to eliminate fault.
L6-03 and L6-01 = 1 or 2
Undertorque Detection 1 Ensure the values in L6-02
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-03 are appropriate.
UL3
control) or the output torque (Vec-
Undertorque Det 1 Motor was underloaded
tor control) fell below L6-02 for Check application/machine
(flashing)
longer then the time set in L6-03 status to eliminate fault.
and L6-01 = 5 or 6.
Undertorque Detection 2 Ensure the values in L6-05
The Inverter’s output current (V/f and L6-06 are appropriate.
UL4
control) or the output torque (Vec-
Undertorque Det 2 Motor was underloaded
tor control) fell below L6-05 for Check application/machine
(flashing)
longer then the time set in L6-06 status to eliminate fault.
and L6-04 = 5 or 6.
Overspeed Alarm Overshooting/undershooting are Adjust the ASR settings in the
Detected when A1-02 = 1 or 3 occurring. C5 parameter group.
OS and F1-03 = 3. Check the reference circuit
Overspeed Det The motor speed feedback The reference was too high.
and reference gain.
(flashing) (U1-05) exceeded the value set in
F1-08 for a time longer than the The settings in F1-08 and F1-09 Check the settings in F1-08
setting in F1-09. are not appropriate. and F1-09
PG Disconnection Fix the broken/disconnected
There is break in the PG wiring.
Detected when F1-02 = 3 and A1- wiring.
PGO
PG Open
(flashing)
02 = 1 or 3.
Detected when no PG (encoder)
The PG is wired incorrectly.
Power isn't being supplied to the
Fix the wiring
Supply power to the PG prop-
7
pulses are received for a time
longer than the setting in F1-14 PG. erly.
The load is too large. Reduce the load.
Excessive Speed Deviation
Detected when F1-04 = 3 and The acceleration time and decel- Lengthen the acceleration time
DEV eration time are too short. and deceleration time.
A1-02 = 1 or 3.
Speed Deviation
The speed deviation is greater The load is locked. Check the mechanical system.
(flashing)
than the setting in F1-10 for
The settings in F1-10 and F1-11 Check the settings in F1-10
longer than the setting in F1-11.
are not appropriate. and F1-11.
Check for an external fault
EF0 An external fault condition was condition.
Communication Option Card
Opt External Flt present, input from a communica-
External Fault Verify the parameters.
(flashing) tion option card.
Verify communication signals
7-11
Table 7.2 Alarm Detection
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
EF3
Ext Fault S3 External fault at terminal S3
(flashing)
EF4
Ext Fault S4 External fault at terminal S4
(flashing) An external fault was input from a
multi-function input terminal
EF5
(S3 to S7) that is programmed for Eliminate the cause of the
Ext Fault S5 External fault at terminal S5
external fault function that alarms external fault condition
(flashing)
only and continues to run the
EF6 Inverter.
Ext Fault S6 External fault at terminal S6
(flashing)
EF7
Ext Fault S7 External fault at terminal S7
(flashing)
PID Feedback Lost Verify Inverter is pro-
This fault occurs when PID feed- grammed to receive the PID
back loss detection is pro- feedback source signal.
PID feedback source (e.g. trans-
FBL grammed to alarm (b5-12 = 1)
ducer, sensor, building automa-
Feedback Loss and the PID feedback fell below
tion signal) is not installed Check to ensure the PID feed-
(flashing) the PID Feedback Loss Detection
correctly or is not working back source is installed and
Level (b5-13) for the PID Feed-
back Loss Detection Time working properly.
(b5-14)
MEMOBUS Communications
CE Alarm
Connection is broken and/or the Check the connections and all
MEMOBUS Com Detected when control data was
master has stopped the communi- user-side software configura-
Err not received correctly for two sec-
cation. tions.
(flashing) onds and H5-04 = 3 and
H5-05 = 1.
Option Communications Alarm
BUS Connection is broken and/or the Check the connections and all
After initial communication was
Option Com Err master has stopped the communi- user-side software configura-
7
established, the connection was
(flashing) cation. tions.
lost.
Detected when a multi-function Check the wiring of the input
Enable command was lost while
digital input (H1-01 to H1-05) is terminal and the external
the Inverter was running.
programmed for 6A: Drive sequence of the enable signal.
DNE
Enable.
Drive Not Enable
The Inverter does not have the Apply and maintain the enable
(flashing) The RUN command was applied
enable command when the RUN command before applying the
command is applied. This alarm prior to the enable signal.
RUN command.
stops the motor.
The RUN command has not been
Detected when a RESET com- removed and a RESET command
Ext Run Active Remove the RUN signal first
mand is input while the RUN is input by digital input or by the
Cannot Reset and reset the fault.
command is still active RESET button on the digital oper-
ator.
Connection was not made prop-
CALL Communications on Standby Check the connections and all
erly or user software was not con-
ComCall Communication has not yet been user-side software configura-
figured to the proper baud rate or
(flashing) established. tions.
configuration (e.g. Parity).
Inverter’s Cooling Fan Alarm
FAN An Inverter’s cooling fan fault
The Inverter’s cooling fan has
Cooling FAN Err was detected. Replace the cooling fan.
stopped
(flashing) This alarm is detected when
L8-32 is set to 0.
7-12
Table 7.2 Alarm Detection
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
Check the communications
timing such as communica-
E5 SI-T Watchdog Error Synchronization fault between
tions cycle.
SI-T WDT Err Consistency fault of received con- master controller and Inverter for
Refer to the instruction man-
(flashing) trol data. control data.
ual for SI-T option card for
details.
Check the setting of the station
number.Refer to the instruc-
Station number setting fault.
tion manual for SI-T option
SI-T Station Number Setting card for details.
Aer
Error
SI-T Address Err Check the communication
Station number of SI-T option
(flashing) devices and signals.
card is out of setting range. Circuit of SI-T option board is
Refer to the instruction man-
faulty.
ual for SI-T option card for
details.
Check the communication
SI-T Communication Cycle Set- cycle of SE-T option card set
CyC Communication cycle of SI-T
ting Error in master controller.
SI-T Cycle Err option board set in master con-
Communications cycle of SI-T Refer to the instruction man-
(flashing) troller is out of range.
option board was out of range. ual for SI-T option card for
details.
7-13
Operator Programming Errors
An Operator Programming Error (OPE) occurs when an inapplicable parameter is set or an individual param-
eter setting is inappropriate. The Inverter will not operate until the parameter is set correctly; however, no
alarm or fault outputs will occur. If an OPE occurs, change the appropriate parameter by checking the cause
shown in Table 7.3. When OPE fault is displayed, press the ENTER key to display U1-34 (OPE Detected).
This monitor will display the parameter that is causing the OPE fault.
Table 7.3 Operator Programming Errors
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Enter the correct kVA setting
The control board was replaced (o2-04) by referring to the
OPE01
Inverter kVA Setting Error and the kVA parameter (o2-04) is table “Factory settings that
kVA Selection
set incorrectly change with the Inverter kVA
setting“ on page 5-60.
OPE02 Parameter Setting Parameter setting was outside of
Verify the parameter settings.
Limit Out of Range the allowable range.
One of the following errors has
been made in the multi-function
input (H1-01 to H1-05) settings:
• Duplicate functions were
selected.
• UP/DOWN Command(10 and
11) were not selected simulta-
neously.
• The up/down commands (10
and 11) and Accel/Decel Ramp
Hold (A) were selected at the
same time.
• More than one of the Speed
Search inputs (61, 62, 64) were
OPE03 Multi-function Input set simultaneously. Verify the parameter settings
Terminal Selection Error • External Baseblock NO (8) and in H1-
External Baseblock NC (9)
were selected at the same time.
7-14
Table 7.3 Operator Programming Errors
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
• One of the control methods
needing a PG feedback was
selected (A1-02 = 1 or 3), but a
PG option board is not
installed.
• S1-01 = 1, 2, 3 (Speed Follower
Mode) and control mode is V/F
Verify the control method
with PG or Closed Loop Vector
OPE06 selection in parameter A1-02
Control method selection fault (A1-02=1 or 3) and the PG
PG Opt Missing and/or the installation of the
option card PG-Z2 is not
PG option board.
installed.
• S1-01 = 1, 2, 3 (Speed Follower
Mode) and control mode is V/F
control or Open Loop Vector
(A1-02=0 or 2) and none of the
PG option cards PG-B2 or PG-
X2 is not installed.
The same function has been
selected for the analog input
selection and the pulse train input
selection.
• H3-09 = B and H6-01 = 1
OPE07 Multi-function Analog Input/ • H3-09 = C and H6-01 = 2 Check the parameters b1-01,
Analog Selection Pulse Train Input Error b1-01 (Reference Source Selec- H3-09 and H6-01.
tion) is set to 4 (pulse train) and
H6-01 (Pulse Train Input Func-
tion Selection) is set to a value
other than 0 (frequency refer-
ence).
A setting has been made that is
applicable with the current con-
OPE08 trol method. Verify the control method and
Function Selection Error
Constant Selection Example: A function used only the function.
with open loop vector control was
selected for V/f control.
The following settings have been 7
made at the same time.
• b5-01 (PID Control Mode
Selection) has been set to a
OPE09 value other than 0. Check parameters b5-01,
PID Control Setup Error
PID Selection • b5-15 (PID Sleep Function b5-15 and b1-03.
Operation Level) has been set
to a value other than 0.
• b1-03 (Stopping Method Selec-
tion) has been set to 2 or 3.
Check parameters (E1- ,
E3- ). A frequency/volt-
OPE10 V/f parameter settings were out of
V/f Parameter Setting Error age value may be set higher
V/f Ptrn Setting range.
than the maximum frequency/
voltage.
7-15
Table 7.3 Operator Programming Errors
Display Meaning Probable Causes Corrective Actions
One of the following parameter
setting errors exists.
• Carrier frequency Gain
C6-05 > 6 and C6-03 (Carrier
Frequency Upper Limit) <
OPE11 Carrier Frequency Parameter Set-
C6-04 (Carrier Frequency Check the parameter settings.
CarrFrq/On-Delay ting Error
Lower Limit)
• Upper/lower limit fault in C6-
03 and 04.
• C6-01 = 0 and C6-02 = 2 to 6.
• C6-01 = 1 and C6-02 = 7 to E.
7-16
Auto-tuning Fault
Auto-tuning faults are shown below. When the following faults are detected, the fault is displayed on the digi-
tal operator and the motor coasts to stop. No fault or alarm outputs will be operated.
Table 7.4 Auto-tuning Faults
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
There is an fault in the data input
Check the input data.
for autotuning.
There is an fault in the relation-
Check the Inverter and motor
ship between the motor output
capacity.
Er - 01 and the motor rated current.
Motor data fault
Fault There is an fault between the no-
load current setting and the input
Check the motor rated current
motor rated current (when auto-
and no-load current.
tuning for line-to-line resistance
is performed for vector control)
Check the input data.
7-17
Table 7.4 Auto-tuning Faults
Display Meaning Probable causes Corrective Actions
Auto-tuning was not completed in
Er - 13 the specified time.
Leakage Induc- Leakage Inductance Fault Check motor wiring.
tance Fault Auto-tuning result is outside the
parameter setting range.
Check and correct the motor
The torque reference exceeded settings
V/f Settings Alarm
End - 1 100% and the no-load current
Displayed after auto-tuning is If the motor and the machine
V/f Over Setting exceeded 70% during auto-tun-
complete are connected, disconnect the
ing.
motor from the machine.
7-18
Table 7.5 Digital Operator Copy Function Faults
Digital Operator
Function Probable Causes Corrective Actions
Display
The Inverter type or software number was
CPE Use stored data of the same product (F7)
different from the stored data in the digital
ID UNMATCHED and software number (U1-14) only.
operator
The capacity of the Inverter and the capac-
VAE Use stored data for the same Inverter
ity of the stored data in the Digital Operator
INV. KVA UNMATCH capacity only (o2-04).
are different.
CRE The control method of the Inverter and the
COPY Use stored data for the same control
CONTROL control method of the stored data in the
Function method (A1-02).
UNMATCHED Digital Operator are different.
A parameter setting written to the Inverter
CYE
was different from the setting stored in the Retry the COPY function (o3-01 = 2)
COPY ERROR
Digital Operator.
Upon completion of the COPY function,
CSE
the Inverter’s data checksum was different Retry the COPY function (o3-01 = 2)
SUM CHECK ERROR
than the digital operator’s data checksum.
Verify VYE The set value of the digital operator and the
Retry the Verify function (o3-01 = 3)
Function VERIFY ERROR Inverter do not match
7-19
Troubleshooting
Due to parameter setting faults, faulty wiring, and so on, the Inverter and motor may not operate as expected
when the system is started. If that occurs, use this section as a reference and perform the appropriate counter-
measures.
If the contents of the fault are displayed, refer to page -2, Protective and Diagnostic Functions.
The display does not change when the Increment and Decrement keys are pressed.
The following causes are possible:
7-20
If the Motor Does Not Operate Properly
The following causes are possible:
The motor does not operate when the RUN key on the Digital Operator is pressed.
The following causes are possible:
The motor does not operate when an external operation signal is input.
The following causes are possible: 7
The Inverter is not in drive mode.
If the Inverter is not in Drive mode, it will not start. Press the MENU key once and then press the DATA/
ENTER key. The Inverter is now in drive mode.
7-21
The motor only rotates in one direction.
"Reverse run disabled" may be selected. If b1-04 (Prohibition of Reverse Operation) is set to 1 (reverse run
prohibited), the Inverter will not accept any reverse run commands.
7-22
If the Motor Operates at Higher Speed than the Frequency Reference
If There is Low Speed Control Accuracy Above Base Speed in Open Loop
Vector Control Mode
The Inverter’s maximum output voltage is determined by its input voltage. (For example, if 400 VAC is input,
then the maximum output voltage will be 400 VAC). Vector control uses voltage to control the currents within
the motor. If the vector control voltage reference value exceeds the Inverter output voltage capability, the
speed control accuracy will decrease because the motor currents cannot be properly controlled. Use a motor
with a low rated voltage compared to the input voltage, or change to Closed Loop Vector control.
7-23
If the Motor Overheats
The following causes are possible:
7-24
If There is Mechanical Oscillation
Use the following information when there is mechanical vibration:
There may be resonance between the mechanical system's natural frequency and the carrier
frequency.
This is characterized by the motor running with no noise generation, but the machinery vibrates with a high-
pitched whine. To prevent this type of resonance, adjust the carrier frequency with parameters C6-02 to
C6-05.
There may be resonance between a mechanical system’s natural frequency and the output fre-
quency of the Inverter.
To prevent this resonance frequency use the Jump Frequency Function in parameters d3- , or have the
driven motor and load balanced to reduce vibration.
7-25
If auto-tuning has not been performed, proper performance may not be achieved for Closed Loop Vector Con-
trol. Perform auto-tuning or set the motor parameters through hand calculations. Alternatively, change the
Control Mode Selection to V/f Control (A1-02 = 0 or 1).
7 Check to be sure that the parameter E1-04 and d2-01 settings are suitable.
7-26
8
Maintenance and
Inspection
This chapter describes basic maintenance and inspection for the Inverter.
Periodic Inspection
Check the following items during periodic maintenance.
• The motor should not vibrate or make unusual noises.
• There should be no abnormal heat generation from the Inverter or motor.
• The ambient temperature should be within the Inverter’s specifications.
• The output current value shown in U1-30 should not be higher than the motor or the Inverter rated current
for extended period of time.
• The cooling fan in the Inverter should be operating normally.
Before attempting any maintenance checks, make sure that the three-phase power is disconnected. With power
removed from the unit, the DC bus capacitors will stay charged for several minutes. The Charge LED in the
Inverter will glow red until the DC bus voltage is below 10VDC. To ensure that the DC bus is completely dis-
charged, measure between the positive and negative bus with a DC voltmeter set to the highest scale. Be sure
not to touch terminals immediately after the power has been turned off. Doing so can result in electric shock.
Item Inspection Corrective Procedure
External terminals Are all screws and bolts tight? Tighten loose screws and bolts firmly.
Mounting bolts
Connectors Are connectors tight? Reconnect the loose connectors.
Clean off any dirt and dust with an air gun using
Cooling fins Are the fins dirty or dusty? dry air at a pressure of 4 x 105 to 6 x 105 Pa
(4 to 6 bar, 55 to 85 psi).
Clean off any dirt and dust with an air gun using
All PCBs
Is there any conductive dirt or oil mist on dry air at a pressure of 4 x 105 to 6 x 105 Pa
the PCBs? (4 to 6 bar, 55 to 85 psi).
Replace the boards if they cannot be made clean.
Input Diodes Clean off any dirt and dust with an air gun using
Is there any conductive dirt or oil mist on
Output Transistors
the modules or components? dry air at a pressure of 4 x 105 to 6 x 105 Pa
Power Modules (4 to 6 bar, 55 to 85 psi).
Are there any irregularities, such as dis-
DC bus capacitors Replace the capacitor or Inverter.
coloration or odor?
8-2
Periodic Maintenance of Parts
In order to keep the Inverter operating normally over a long period of time, and to prevent down time due to an
unexpected failure, it is necessary to perform periodic inspections and replace parts according to their service
life.
The data indicated in the following table is to be used as a general guideline only. Periodic inspection stan-
dards vary depending on the Inverter’s installation environment conditions and usage. The Inverter’s sug-
gested maintenance periods are noted below.
Part Standard Replacement Period Replacement Method
Cooling fan(s) 2 to 3 years (20,000 hours) Replace with new part.
Replace with new part.
DC bus capacitor 5 years
(Determine need by inspection.)
Soft charge contactor – Determine need by inspection.
DC bus fuse
10 years Replace with new part.
Control power fuse
Replace with new board.
PCB capacitors 5 years
(Determine need by inspection.)
Note:The standard replacement period is based on the following usage conditions:
Ambient temperature:Yearly average of 30°C/86°F
Load factor: 80% maximum
Operating rate: 12 hours maximum per day
8-3
Cooling Fan Replacement
1
3
8-4
200 V and 400 V Class Inverters of 22 kW or More
The heatsink cooling fan is attached to the top of the heatsink inside the Inverter. The cooling fan(s) can be
replaced without removing the Inverter from the installation panel.
Control card
8
Connector
Gate driver
8-5
Removing and Mounting the Terminal Card
The Terminal Card can be removed and mounted without disconnecting the control wiring.
8-6
9
Specifications
This chapter describes the basic specifications of the Inverter
and specifications for options and peripheral devices.
The standard Inverter specifications are listed by capacity in the following tables.
Specifications by Model
Specifications are given by model in the following tables.
200V Class
Model Number CIMR-F7Z 20P4 20P7 21P5 22P2 23P7 25P5 27P5 2011 2015 2018 2022 2030 2037 2045 2055 2075 2090 2110
Max. applicable motor out-
0.55 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90 110
put (kW)*1
Rated output capacity
1.2 1.6 2.7 3.7 5.7 8.8 12 17 22 27 32 44 55 69 82 110 130 160
(kVA)
Output ratings
Rated output current 3.2 4.1 7.0 9.6 15 23 31 45 58 71 85 115 145 180 215 283 346 415
3-phase; 200, 220, 230, or 240 VAC
Max. output voltage (V)
(Proportional to input voltage.)
Max. output frequency Heavy Duty (low carrier, constant torque applications): 150 Hz max
(Hz) Normal Duty 1 or 2 (high/reduced carrier, variable torque applications): 400 Hz max.
Rated voltage (V)
3-phase, 200/220/230/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz
Power supply characteristics
Allowable frequency
±5%
fluctuation
Control characteristics
* 1. The maximum applicable motor output is given for a standard 4-pole Yaskawa motor. When selecting the actual motor and Inverter, be sure that the
Inverter's rated current is applicable for the motor's rated current.
* 2. A transformer with dual star-delta secondary is required on the power supply for 12-pulse rectification.
9-2
400 V Class
Model Number CIMR-F7Z 40P4 40P7 41P5 42P2 43P7 44P0 45P5 47P5 4011 4015 4018
Max. applicable motor output
0.55 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 4.0 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5
(kW) *1
Rated output capacity
1.4 1.6 2.8 4.0 5.8 6.6 9.5 13 18 24 30
(kVA)
Output ratings
Rated output current (A) 1.8 2.1 3.7 5.3 7.6 8.7 12.5 17 24 31 39
Max. output voltage (V) 3-phase; 380, 400, 415, 440, 460, or 480 VAC (Proportional to input voltage.)
Max. output frequency Heavy Duty (low carrier, constant torque applications): 150 Hz max.
(Hz) Normal Duty 1 or 2 (high/reduced carrier, variable torque applications): 400 Hz max.
Rated input current (A) 2.2 2.5 4.4 6.4 9.0 10.4 15 20 29 37 47
DC reactor Optional
Measures
for power
supply
harmonics 12-phase rec-
Not possible
tification
Model Number CIMR-F7Z 4022 4030 4037 4045 4055 4075 4090 4110 4132 4160 4185 4220 4300
Max. applicable motor output
22 30 37 45 55 75 90 110 132 160 185 220 300
(kW)*1
Rated output capacity
34 46 57 69 85 110 140 160 200 230 280 390 510
(kVA)
Output ratings
Rated output current (A) 45 60 75 91 112 150 180 216 260 304 370 506 675
Max. output voltage (V) 3-phase, 380, 400, 415, 440, 460, or 480 VAC (Proportional to input voltage.)
Max. output frequency Heavy Duty (low carrier, constant torque applications): 150 Hz max.
(Hz) Normal Duty 1 or 2 (high/reduced carrier, variable torque applications): 400 Hz max.
Rated input current (A) 50 66 83 100 120 165 198 238 286 334 407 537 743
Allowable voltage fluctua-
+ 10%, - 15%
tion
DC reactor Built in
Measures
for power
supply
harmonics 12-phase rec-
9
tification Possible*2
* 1. The maximum applicable motor output is given for a standard 4-pole Yaskawa standard motor. When selecting the actual motor and Inverter, be sure
that the Inverter's rated current is higher than the motor's rated current.
* 2. A transformer with dual star-delta secondary is required on the power supply for 12-pulse-rectification.
9-3
Common Specifications
The following specifications apply to both 200 V and 400 V class Inverters.
Model Number
Specification
CIMR-F7Z
Sine wave PWM
Control method
Closed Loop Vector control, Open Loop Vector control, V/f control, V/f with PG control
Heavy Duty (low carrier, constant torque applications): 2 kHz carrier frequency, 150% overload for 1 minute,
higher carrier frequency possible with current derating.
Torque characteristics Normal Duty 1 (high carrier, variable torque applications): maximum carrier frequency, depending on inverter capacity,
120% overload for 1 minute.
Normal Duty 2 (variable torque applications): carrier frequency reduced, continuous overload capability increased
1:40 (V/f control)
Speed control range 1:100 (Open Loop Vector control)
1:1000 (Closed Loop Vector control)
± 3% (V/f control)
± 0.03% (V/f control with PG)
Speed control accuracy ± 0.2% (Open Loop Vector control)
± 0.02% (Closed Loop Vector control)
(25°C ± 10°C)
5 Hz (control without PG)
Speed control response
30 Hz (control with PG)
Torque limits Provided (4 quadrant steps can be changed by parameter settings.) (Vector control)
Control characteristics
Torque accuracy ± 5%
Frequency range 0.01 to 150 Hz (Heavy Duty), 0.01 to 400 Hz (Normal Duty 1 or 2)
9 Overload protection
Normal Duty 1 (high carrier, variable torque applications): 120% of rated output current for 1 minute
Normal Duty 2 (high carrier, variable torque applications): 120% of rated output current for 1 minute,
increased continuous output current.
Protective functions
9-4
Model Number
Specification
CIMR-F7Z
Ambient operating tem- -10°C to 40°C (Enclosed wall-mounted type)
perature –10°C to 45°C (Open chassis type)
Ambient operating humid-
95% max. (with no condensation)
ity
Environment
9-5
9
9-6
10
Appendix
This chapter provides precautions for the Inverter, motor, and
peripheral devices and also provides lists of parameters.
Selection
Observe the following precautions when selecting an Inverter.
Installing Reactors
A large peak current will flow in the power input circuit when the Inverter is connected to a large-capacity
power transformer (600 kVA or higher) or when switching a compensating capacitor. Excessive peak current
can destroy the rectifier section. To prevent this, install a DC or AC reactor to improve the power supply
power factor.
DC reactors are built into Inverters of 22kW and more.
If a thyristor converter, such as a DC drive, is connected in the same power supply system, connect a DC or
AC reactor regardless of the power supply conditions shown in the following diagram.
DC or AC reactor re-
Power supply quired
(kVA)
DC or AC reactor not re-
quired
Initial Torque
The startup and acceleration characteristics of the motor are restricted by the overload current ratings of the
Inverter that is driving the motor. The torque characteristic generally is different from those when starting a
motor on the power supply directly. If a large initial torque is required, select an Inverter one size bigger or
increase the capacity of both, the motor and the Inverter.
10
10-2
Installation
Observe the following precautions when installing an Inverter.
Installation in Enclosures
Install the Inverter in a clean location where it is not subjected to oil mist, dust, and other contaminants, or
install the Inverter in a completely enclosed panel. Provide cooling measures and sufficient panel space so that
the temperature surrounding the Inverter does not exceed the allowable temperature. Do not install the Inverter
on wood or other combustible materials.
Installation Direction
Mount the Inverter vertically to a wall or other vertical surface.
Settings
Observe the following precautions when making settings for an Inverter.
Upper Limits
The maximum output frequency can be set up to 400Hz. Setting the output frequency too high can damage the
machine. So pay attention to the mechanical system and observe required limits for the output frequency.
DC Injection Braking
If the DC Injection Braking Current or the Braking Time are set too high the motor can overheat what can
damage the motor
Acceleration/Deceleration Times
The motor's acceleration and deceleration times are determined by the torque generated by the motor, the load
torque, and the load's inertial moment (GD2/4). If the stall prevention functions are activated during accelera-
tion or deceleration, it might be necessary to increase the acceleration or deceleration time.
To reduce the acceleration or deceleration times, increase the capacity of the motor and Inverter.
10
10-3
Handling
Observe the following precautions when wiring or performing maintenance for an Inverter.
Wiring Check
The Inverter will be internally damaged if the power supply voltage is applied to output terminal U, V, or W.
Check wiring for any mistakes before supplying power. Check all wiring and control sequences carefully.
10
10-4
Motor Application Precautions
High-speed Operation
When using the motor at a speed higher than the motor rated frequency (usually 50 Hz), problems may arise in
dynamic balance and bearing durability.
Acoustic Noise
The noise generated in the motor depends on the carrier frequency. The higher the setting the less the gener-
ated noise is.
Pole-changing Motor
The rated input current of pole-changing motors differs from that of standard motors. Select an appropriate
Inverter according to the maximum current of the motor.
Submersible Motor
The rated input current of submersible motors is higher than that of standard motors. Therefore, always select
an appropriate Inverter according to the maximum current of the motor.
Explosion-proof Motor
10
When an explosion-proof motor is used, it must be subjected to an explosion-proof test in conjunction with the
Inverter. This is also applicable when an existing explosion-proof motor is to be operated with the Inverter.
Since the Inverter itself is, however, not explosion-proof, always install it in a safe place.
Gear motor
The speed range for continuous operation differs according to the lubrication method and motor manufacturer.
In particular, continuous operation of an oil-lubricated motor in the low speed range may result in damaging.
If the motor is to be operated at a speed higher than 50 Hz, consult the manufacturer.
10-5
Synchronous Motor
A synchronous motor is not suitable for Inverter control.
Single-phase Motor
Do not use an Inverter for a single-phase capacitor motor. Any capacitors directly connected to the inverter
output may damage the Inverter.
10
10-6
User Parameters
Factory settings are given in the following table. These are factory settings for a 200 V Class Inverter with 0.4
kW (open loop vector control).
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
A1-00 Language selection for Digital Operator display 0
A1-01 Parameter access level 2
A1-02 Control method selection 2
A1-03 Initialize 0
A1-04 Password 0
A1-05 Password setting 0
A2-01 to
User specified parameters –
A2-32
b1-01 Reference source selection 1
b1-02 RUN command source selection 1
b1-03 Stopping method selection 0
b1-04 Prohibition of reverse operation 0
b1-05 Operation selection for setting frequencies equal or lower than E1-09 0
b1-06 Control input scan 1
b1-07 Operation selection after switching to remote mode 0
b1-08 Run command selection in programming modes 0
b2-01 Zero speed level (DC injection braking starting frequency) 0.5 Hz
b2-02 DC injection braking current 50%
b2-03 DC injection braking time at start 0.00 s
b2-04 DC injection braking time at stop 0.50 s
b3-01 Speed search selection (current detection or speed calculation) *1
b3-02 Speed search operating current (current detection) *1
b3-03 Speed search deceleration time (current detection) 2.0 s
b3-05 Speed search wait time (current detection or speed calculation) 0.2 s
b3-10 Speed Search Compensation Gain (speed calculation only) 1.10
b3-14 Speed Search Rotating Selection Direction 1
b3-17 Speed search retrial current level 150%
b3-18 Speed search retrial detection time 0.01s
b3-19 Number of speed search retrials 0
b4-01 Timer function ON-delay time 0.0 s
b4-02 Timer function OFF-delay time 0.0 s
b5-01 PID control mode selection 0
b5-02 Proportional gain (P) 1.00
b5-03 Integral (I) time 1.0 s
b5-04 Integral (I) limit 100.0%
b5-05
b5-06
Differential (D) time
PID limit
0.00 s
100.0%
10
b5-07 PID offset adjustment 0.0%
b5-08 PID delay time constant 0.00 s
b5-09 PID output characteristics selection 0
b5-10 PID output gain 1.0
b5-11 PID reverse output selection 0
10-7
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
b5-12 Selection of PID feedback signal loss detection 0
b5-13 PID feedback loss detection level 0%
b5-14 PID feedback loss detection time 1.0 s
b5-15 PID Sleep function operation level 0.0 Hz
b5-16 PID Sleep operation delay time 0.0 s
b5-17 Accel/decel time for PID reference 0.0 s
b5-18 PID Setpoint Selection 0
b5-19 PID Setpoint 0
b5-28 PID Square Root Feedback Sel 0
b5-29 Square root Feedback Gain 1.00
b5-31 PID monitor feedback selection 0
b5-32 PID monitor feedback gain 100.0%
b5-33 PID monitor feedback bias 0.0%
b6-01 Dwell frequency at start 0.0 Hz
b6-02 Dwell time at start 0.0 s
b6-03 Dwell frequency at stop 0.0 Hz
b6-04 Dwell time at stop 0.0 s
b7-01 Droop Control Gain 0.0%
b7-02 Droop Control Delay Time 0.05 s
b8-01 Energy-saving mode selection 0
b8-02 Energy-saving gain *1
b8-03 Energy-saving filter time constant *1
b8-04 Energy-saving coefficient *1
b8-05 Power detection filter time constant 20 ms
b8-06 Search operation voltage limiter 0%
b9-01 Zero Servo Gain 5
b9-02 Zero Servo completion bandwidth 10
C1-01 Acceleration time 1 10.0 s
C1-02 Deceleration time 1
C1-03 Acceleration time 2
C1-04 Deceleration time 2
C1-05 Acceleration time 3
10.0 s
C1-06 Deceleration time 3
C1-07 Acceleration time 4
C1-08 Deceleration time 4
C1-09 Fast stop time
C1-10 Accel/decel time setting unit 1
10
C1-11 Accel/decel time switching frequency 0.0 Hz
C2-01 S-curve characteristic time at acceleration start 0.20 s
C2-02 S-curve characteristic time at acceleration end 0.20 s
C2-03 S-curve characteristic time at deceleration start 0.20 s
C2-04 S-curve characteristic time at deceleration end 0.00 s
C3-01 Slip compensation gain *1
C3-02 Slip compensation delay time *1
C3-03 Slip compensation limit 200%
10-8
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
C3-04 Slip compensation selection during regeneration 0
C3-05 Output voltage limit operation selection 0
C4-01 Torque compensation gain 1.00
C4-02 Torque compensation delay time constant *1
C4-03 Starting torque compensation (FWD) 0.0%
C4-04 Starting torque compensation (REV) 0.0%
C4-05 Starting torque compensation time constant 10 ms
C5-01 ASR proportional (P) gain 1 *1
C5-02 ASR integral (I) time 1 *1
C5-03 ASR proportional (P) gain 2 *1
C5-04 ASR integral (I) time 2 *1
C5-05 ASR limit 5.0%
C5-06 ASR delay time 0.004 ms
C5-07 ASR switching frequency 0.0 Hz
C5-08 ASR integral (I) limit 400%
C6-01 Heavy/Normal Duty selection 0
C6-02 Carrier frequency selection 1
C6-03 Carrier frequency upper limit 2.0 kHz
C6-04 Carrier frequency lower limit 2.0 kHz
C6-05 Carrier frequency proportional gain 00
d1-01 Frequency reference 1 0.00 Hz
d1-02 Frequency reference 2 0.00 Hz
d1-03 Frequency reference 3 0.00 Hz
d1-04 Frequency reference 4 0.00 Hz
d1-05 Frequency reference 5 0.00 Hz
d1-06 Frequency reference 6 0.00 Hz
d1-07 Frequency reference 7 0.00 Hz
d1-08 Frequency reference 8 0.00 Hz
d1-09 Frequency reference 9 0.00 Hz
d1-10 Frequency reference 10 0.00 Hz
d1-11 Frequency reference 11 0.00 Hz
d1-12 Frequency reference 12 0.00 Hz
d1-13 Frequency reference 13 0.00 Hz
d1-14 Frequency reference 14 0.00 Hz
d1-15 Frequency reference 15 0.00 Hz
d1-16 Frequency reference 16 0.00 Hz
d1-17 Jog frequency reference 6.00 Hz
10
d2-01 Frequency reference upper limit 100.0%
d2-02 Frequency reference lower limit 0.0%
d2-03 Master speed reference lower limit 0.0%
d3-01 Jump frequency 1 0.0 Hz
d3-02 Jump frequency 2 0.0 Hz
d3-03 Jump frequency 3 0.0 Hz
d3-04 Jump frequency width 1.0 Hz
d4-01 Frequency reference hold function selection 0
10-9
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
d4-02 + - Speed limits 10%
d5-01 Torque control selection 0
d5-02 Torque reference delay time 0 ms
d5-03 Speed limit selection 1
d5-04 Speed limit 0%
d5-05 Speed limit bias 10%
d5-06 Speed/torque control switching timer 0 ms
d6-01 Field weakening level 80%
d6-02 Field weakening frequency limit 0.0 Hz
d6-03 Field forcing function selection 0
d6-06 Field forcing function Limit 400%
E1-01 Input voltage setting *1
E1-03 V/f pattern selection F
E1-04 Max. output frequency (FMAX) 50.0 Hz
E1-05 Max. output voltage (VMAX) *1
E1-06 Base frequency (FA) 50.0 Hz
E1-07 Mid. output frequency (FB) *1
E1-08 Mid. output frequency voltage (VB) *1
E1-09 Min. output frequency (FMIN) *1
E1-10 Min. output frequency voltage (VMIN) *1
E1-11 Mid. output frequency 2 0.0 Hz
E1-12 Mid. output frequency voltage 2 0.0 V
E1-13 Base voltage (VBASE) 0.0 V
E2-01 Motor rated current *1
E2-02 Motor rated slip *1
E2-03 Motor no-load current *1
E2-04 Number of motor poles 4 poles
E2-05 Motor line-to-line resistance *1
E2-06 Motor leak inductance *1
E2-07 Motor iron saturation coefficient 1 0.50
E2-08 Motor iron saturation coefficient 2 0.75
E2-09 Monitor mechanical losses 0.0%
E2-10 Motor iron loss for torque compensation *1
E2-11 Motor rated output power *1
E3-01 Motor 2 control method selection 0
E3-02 Motor 2 max. output frequency (FMAX) 50.0 Hz
E3-03 Motor 2 max. output voltage (VMAX) *1
10
E3-04 Motor 2 max. output voltage frequency (FA) 50.0 Hz
E3-05 Motor 2 mid. output frequency 1 (FB) *1
E3-06 Motor 2 mid. output frequency voltage 1 (VB) *1
E3-07 Motor 2 min. output frequency (FMIN) *1
E3-08 Motor 2 min. output frequency voltage (VMIN) *1
E4-01 Motor 2 rated current *1
E4-02 Motor 2 rated slip *1
E4-03 Motor 2 no-load current *1
10-10
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
E4-04 Motor 2 number of poles (number of poles) 4 poles
E4-05 Motor 2 line-to-line resistance *1
E4-06 Motor 2 leak inductance *1
E4-07 Motor 2 rated capacity *1
F1-01 PG constant 1024
F1-02 Operation selection at PG open circuit (PGO) 1
F1-03 Operation selection at overspeed (OS) 1
F1-04 Operation selection at deviation 3
F1-05 PG rotation 0
F1-06 PG division rate (PG pulse monitor) 1
F1-07 Integral value during accel/decel enable/disable 0
F1-08 Overspeed detection level 115%
F1-09 Overspeed detection delay time 1.0 s
F1-10 Excessive speed deviation detection level 10%
F1-11 Excessive speed deviation detection delay time 0.5 s
F1-12 Number of PG gear teeth 1 0
F1-13 Number of PG gear teeth 2 0
F1-14 PG open-circuit detection delay time 2.0 s
F2-01 Bi-polar or uni-polar input selection 0
F3-01 Digital input option 0
F4-01 Channel 1 Monitor Selection 2
F4-02 Channel 1 Gain 100.0%
F4-03 Channel 2 Monitor Selection 3
F4-04 Channel 2 Gain 50.0%
F4-05 CH1 Output Bias 0.0%
F4-06 CH2 Output Bias 0.0%
F4-07 Analog Output Signal Level CH1 0
F4-08 Analog Output Signal Level CH2 0
F5-01 Channel 1 Output Selection 0
F5-02 Channel 2 Output Selection 1
F5-03 Channel 3 Output Selection 2
F5-04 Channel 4 Output Selection 4
F5-05 Channel 5 Output Selection 6
F5-06 Channel 6 Output Selection 37
F5-07 Channel 7 Output Selection 0F
F5-08 Channel 8 Output Selection 0F
F5-09 DO-08 Output Mode Selection 0
10
F6-01 Operation selection after communications fault 1
F6-02 Input level of external fault from Communications Option Card 0
F6-03 Stopping method for external fault from Communications Option Card 1
F6-04 Trace sampling from Communications Option Card 0
F6-05 Current monitor unit selection 1
F6-06 Torque reference/torque limit selection from communications option card 1
F6-08 Operation selection after SI-T WDT error 1
F6-09 Number of SI-T BUS error detection 2
10-11
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
H1-01 Terminal S3 function selection 24
H1-02 Terminal S4 function selection 14
H1-03 Terminal S5 function selection 3 (0)*2
H1-04 Terminal S6 function selection 4 (3)*2
H1-05 Terminal S7 function selection 6 (4)*2
H2-01 Terminal M1-M2 function selection 0
H2-02 Terminal M3-M4 function selection 1
H2-03 Terminal M5-M6 function selection 2
H3-01 Multi-function analog input terminal A1 signal level selection 0
H3-02 Gain (terminal A1) 100.0%
H3-03 Bias (terminal A1) 0.0%
H3-04 Signal level selction (AI-14B, channel 3) 0
H3-05 Multi-function analog input (AI-14B, channel 3) function selection 1F
H3-06 Gain (AI-14B, channel 3) 100.0%
H3-07 Bias (AI-14B, channel 3) 0.0%
H3-08 Multi-function analog input terminal A2 signal level selection 2
H3-09 Multi-function analog input terminal A2 function selection 0
H3-10 Gain (terminal A2) 100.0%
H3-11 Bias (terminal A2) 0.0%
H3-12 Analog input filter time constant 0.00 s
H3-13 Terminal A1/A2 switching 0
H4-01 Monitor selection (terminal FM) 2
H4-02 Gain (terminal FM) 100%
H4-03 Bias (terminal FM) 0.0%
H4-04 Monitor selection (terminal AM) 3
H4-05 Gain (terminal AM) 50.0%
H4-06 Bias (terminal AM) 0.0%
H4-07 Analog output 1 signal level selection 0
H4-08 Analog output 2 signal level selection 0
H5-01 Station address 1F
H5-02 Communications speed selection 3
H5-03 Communications parity selection 0
H5-04 Stopping method after communications fault 3
H5-05 Communications fault detection selection 1
H5-06 Send wait time 5 ms
H5-07 RTS control ON/OFF 1
H5-10 Unit Selection for MEMOBUS register 0025H 0
10 H6-01
H6-02
Pulse train input function selection
Pulse train input scaling
0
1440 Hz
H6-03 Pulse train input gain 100.0%
H6-04 Pulse train input bias 0.0%
H6-05 Pulse train input filter time 0.10 s
H6-06 Pulse train monitor selection 2
H6-07 Pulse train monitor scaling 1440 Hz
10-12
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
L1-01 Motor protection selection 1
L1-02 Motor protection time constant 1.0 min
L1-03 Alarm operation selection during motor overheating 3
L1-04 Motor overheating operation selection 1
L1-05 Motor temperature input filter time constant 0.20 s
L2-01 Momentary power loss detection 0
L2-02 Momentary power loss ride through time *1
L2-03 Min. baseblock time *1
L2-04 Voltage recovery time *1
L2-05 Undervoltage detection level *1
L2-06 KEB deceleration time 0.0 s
L2-07 Momentary recovery time *1
L2-08 Frequency reduction gain at KEB start 100%
L3-01 Stall prevention selection during accel 1
L3-02 Stall prevention level during accel 150%
L3-03 Stall prevention limit during accel 50%
L3-04 Stall prevention selection during decel 1
L3-05 Stall prevention selection during running 1
L3-06 Stall prevention level during run 150%
L4-01 Speed agreement detection level 0.0 Hz
L4-02 Speed agreement detection width 2.0 Hz
L4-03 Speed agreement detection level (+/-) 0.0 Hz
L4-04 Speed agreement detection width (+/-) 2.0 Hz
L4-05 Operation when frequency reference is missing 0
L4-06 Frequency reference value at frequency reference loss 80%
L4-12 Width of frequency reference loss 10%
L5-01 Number of auto restart attempts 0
L5-02 Auto restart operation selection 0
L6-01 Torque detection selection 1 0
L6-02 Torque detection level 1 150%
L6-03 Torque detection time 1 0.1 s
L6-04 Torque detection selection 2 0
L6-05 Torque detection level 2 150%
L6-06 Torque detection time 2 0.1 s
L7-01 Forward drive torque limit 200%
L7-02 Reverse drive torque limit 200%
L7-03 Forward regenerative torque limit 200%
10
L7-04 Reverse regenerative torque limit 200%
L7-06 Torque limit time constant 200 ms
L7-07 Torque Limit Operation during accel/decel 0
L8-01 Protect selection for internal DB resistor (Type ERF) 0
L8-02 Overheat pre-alarm level 95 °C*1
L8-03 Operation selection after overheat pre-alarm 3
L8-05 Input open-phase protection selection 1
L8-07 Output open-phase protection selection 0
10-13
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
L8-09 Ground protection selection 1
L8-10 Cooling fan control selection 0
L8-11 Cooling fan control delay time 60 s
L8-12 Ambient temperature 45 °C
L8-15 OL2 characteristics selection at low speeds 1
L8-18 Soft CLA selection 1
L8-32 OH1 detection of Inverter’s cooling fan 1
n1-01 Hunting-prevention function selection 1
n1-02 Hunting-prevention gain 1.00
n2-01 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) gain 1.00
n2-02 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) time constant 50 ms
n2-03 Speed feedback detection control (AFR) time constant 2 750 ms
n3-01 High-slip braking deceleration frequency width 5%
n3-02 High-slip braking current limit 150%
n3-03 High-slip braking stop dwell time 1.0 s
n3-04 High-slip braking OL time 40 s
o1-01 Monitor selection 6
o1-02 Monitor selection after power up 1
o1-03 Frequency units of reference setting and monitor 0
o1-04 Setting unit for frequency parameters related to V/f characteristics 0
o1-05 LCD Display contrast adjustment 3
o2-01 LOCAL/REMOTE key enable/disable 1
o2-02 STOP key during control circuit terminal operation 1
o2-03 User parameter initial value 0
o2-04 kVA selection 0
o2-05 Frequency reference setting method selection 0
o2-06 Operation selection when digital operator is disconnected 0
o2-07 Cumulative operation time setting 0 hr
o2-08 Cumulative operation time selection 0
o2-09 Initialize Mode 2
o2-10 Fan operation time setting 0 hr
o2-12 Fault trace initialize 0
o2-14 kWh monitor initialize 0
o3-01 Copy function selection 0
o3-02 Read permission selection 0
S1-01 Follower Mode Selection 0
S1-02 Master encoder PPR 1024
10
S1-03 Ratio Numerator (Upper 4 digits) 1000
S1-04 Ratio Numerator (Upper 4 Digits) 1000
S1-05 Ratio Numerator (Lower 4 Digits) 0
S1-06 Ratio Denominator (Lower 4 Digits) 0
S2-01 Digital Ratio Adjustments 0.00 %
S2-02 MOP Adjust Time 50.0 s
S2-03 Gear Ratio Adjustment Ramp Time 10.0 s
S2-04 PG Monitor Channel Selection 1
10-14
Factory
No. Name Setting
Setting
S2-05 Ratio Change Speed Agree Width 0.5 Hz
T1-00 Motor 1/2 selection 1
T1-01 Autotuning mode selection 0
T1-02 Motor output power *1
T1-03 Motor rated voltage *1
T1-04 Motor rated current *1
T1-05 Motor base frequency 50.0 Hz
T1-06 Number of motor poles 4 poles
T1-07 Motor base speed 1450 r/min
T1-08 Number of PG pulses 1024
T1-09 Motor no-load current *1
* 1. The factory setting depends on the inverter model and the control method.
* 2. The values in parentheses indicate initial values when initialized in 3-wire sequence.
10
10-15
10
10-16